Servicemanual25 GM v6 1998-2001 Complete
Servicemanual25 GM v6 1998-2001 Complete
Servicemanual25 GM v6 1998-2001 Complete
SERVICE MANUAL
Number 25
MARINE ENGINES
GM V-6 262 CID (4.3L)
Printed in U.S.A.
90-861328--1 1199
90-861328--1
90-861328--1
90-
Notice
Throughout this publication, Dangers, Warnings and Cautions (accompanied by the International HAZARD Symbol ) are used to alert the mechanic to special instructions concerning a particular service or operation that may be hazardous if performed incorrectly or carelessly. OBSERVE THEM CAREFULLY! These Safety Alerts alone cannot eliminate the hazards that they signal. Strict compliance to these special instructions when performing the service, plus Common Sense operation, are major accident prevention measures.
DANGER
DANGER - Immediate hazards which WILL result in severe personal injury or death.
WARNING
WARNING - Hazards or unsafe practices which COULD result in severe personal injury or death.
CAUTION
Hazards or unsafe practices which could result in minor personal injury or product or property damage.
Page i
It is important to note, during any maintenance procedure replacement fasteners must have the same measurements and strength as those removed. Numbers on the heads of the metric bolts and on the surfaces of metric nuts indicate their strength. American bolts use radial lines for this purpose, while most American nuts do not have strength markings. Mismatched or incorrect fasteners can result in damage or malfunction, or possibly personal injury. Therefore, fasteners removed should be saved for reuse in the same locations whenever possible. Where the fasteners are not satisfactory for re-use, care should be taken to select a replacement that matches the original. We reserve the right to make changes to this manual without prior notification. Refer to dealer service bulletins for other pertinent information concerning the products described in this manual.
Replacement Parts
WARNING
Electrical, ignition and fuel system components on MerCruiser Engines and Sterndrives are designed and manufactured to comply with U.S. Coast Guard Rules and Regulations to minimize risks of fire or explosion. Use of replacement electrical, ignition or fuel system components, which do not comply to these rules and regulations, could result in a fire or explosion hazard and should be avoided. When servicing the electrical, ignition and fuel systems, it is extremely important that all components are properly installed and tightened. If not, any electrical or ignition component opening would permit sparks to ignite fuel vapors from fuel system leaks, if they existed.
Page ii
Section 1 - Important Information A - General Information B - Maintenance C - Troubleshooting Section 2 - Removal and Installation A - MCM Models Section 3 - Engine A - 262 CID / 4.3L Engines Section 4 - Electrical Systems A - Starting System B - Ignition System C - Charging System D - Instrumentation E - Wiring Diagrams Section 5 - Fuel Systems A - Fuel Delivery System For Carbureted Engines B - Mercarb 2 Barrel Carburetor C - Weber 4 Barrel Carburetor D - SAV1 Emission Fuel System With Weber Carburetor E - Fuel Delivery System For Electronic Fuel Injection F - Fuel Injection Descriptions And System Operation G - Fuel Injection Disassembly And Reassembly H - Fuel Injection System Troubleshooting I - Diagnostics Section 6 - Cooling System A - Seawater Cooled Models B - Closed Cooled Models Section 7 - Exhaust System A - General B - Manifolds, Elbows and Risers C - Collectors Section 8 - Drives A - Drive Shaft Models Section 9 - Power Steering System A - Pump and Related Components
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Engine
Electrical Systems
Fuel Systems
Cooling System
Exhaust System
Drives
Page iii
Table of Contents
IMPORTANT INFORMATION
Section 1A - General Information
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . How to Use This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page Numbering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . How to Read a Parts Manual . . . . . . . . . Directional References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Serial Number Location . . . . . . . 1A-2 1A-2 1A-2 1A-3 1A-4 1A-4 1A-5 Propeller Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Testing New Engines . . . . . . . . . . Boat and Engine Performance . . . . . . . . Boat Bottom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Marine Fouling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water in Boat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Elevation and Climate . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A-5 1A-6 1A-6 1A-6 1A-7 1A-8 1A-9 1A-9
Section 1B - Maintenance
Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Maintenance Schedules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maintenance Intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gas Sterndrive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Routine Maintenance * . . . . . . . . . . . . Scheduled Maintenance * . . . . . . . . . . Engine and Tune-Up Specifications . . . . MCM (Sterndrive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fluid Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sterndrive Engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sterndrives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-Hour Break-In Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . After Break-in Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . End of First Season Checkup . . . . . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . Test For Alcohol Content In Gasoline Power Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Coolant for Closed Cooling System . . . . Crankcase Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overfilled Crankcase Oil . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Engine Oil Level / Filling . . Changing Oil and Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing Water Separating Fuel Filter . Power Steering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Fluid Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Cold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Filling and Bleeding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1B-2 1B-2 1B-3 1B-3 1B-3 1B-3 1B-4 1B-5 1B-5 1B-6 1B-6 1B-6 1B-7 1B-7 1B-7 1B-8 1B-8 1B-10 1B-10 1B-10 1B-11 1B-11 1B-12 1B-12 1B-13 1B-15 1B-15 1B-15 1B-16 Closed Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . Flushing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Throttle Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Shift Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Coupler / U-Joint Shaft Splines . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sterndrive Drive Shaft Extension Models . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning Flame Arrestor . . . . . . . . . . . . . Top Mounted Flame Arrestor . . . . . . . Serpentine Drive Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Component Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Serpentine Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S/N 0L619083 and Below . . . . . . . . . . S/N 0L619084 and Above . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing and/or Adjusting Tension . Ignition Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Thunderbolt V Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cold Weather or Extended Storage . . . . Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Package Layup . . . . . . . . . . . . Draining Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Draining Sterndrive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recommissioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1B-17 1B-17 1B-18 1B-20 1B-20 1B-20 1B-21 1B-22 1B-22 1B-23 1B-23 1B-23 1B-24 1B-24 1B-25 1B-26 1B-26 1B-27 1B-27 1B-28 1B-29 1B-29 1B-31 1B-33 1B-38 1B-39
Page iv
Section 1C - Troubleshooting
Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Used Spark Plug Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . Normal Condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chipped Insulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wet Fouling (Oil Deposits) . . . . . . . . . Cold Fouling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High Speed Glazing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Scavenger Deposits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pre-Ignition Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reversed Coil Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . Splashed Deposits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Poor Boat Performance and/or Poor Maneuverability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Improper Full Throttle Engine RPM . . . . RPM Too High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RPM Too Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Cranks Over But Will Not Start Or Starts Hard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . mportant Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Thunderbolt V Ignition (No Spark) . . . Testing Thunderbolt V Ignition System Fuel System Rich . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel System Lean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Will Not Crank Over . . . . . . . . . . . Charging System Inoperative . . . . . . . . . Noisy Alternator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Instrumentation Malfunction . . . . . . . . . . Radio Noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1C-2 1C-3 1C-3 1C-3 1C-4 1C-4 1C-4 1C-5 1C-5 1C-5 1C-6 1C-6 1C-6 1C-7 1C-8 1C-8 1C-8 1C-9I 1C-9 1C-10 1C-10 1C-11 1C-11 1C-11 1C-12 1C-12 1C-13 1C-13 1C-13 Poor Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Runs Poorly at Idle . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Runs Poorly At High RPM . . . . . Engine Acceleration Is Poor . . . . . . . . . . Troubleshooting with Vacuum Gauge . . Engine Noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Important Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . Valve Cover Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cylinder Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Camshaft Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crankshaft Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Low Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Excessive Oil Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . Water In Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Important Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water on Top of Pistons . . . . . . . . . . . Water in Crankcase Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insufficient Water Flow from Belt Driven Seawater Pickup Pump . Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Poor, Erratic or No Assist . . . . . . . . . . Noisy Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fluid Leaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1C-14 1C-14 1C-15 1C-16 1C-16 1C-17 1C-17 1C-17 1C-18 1C-18 1C-19 1C-20 1C-21 1C-21 1C-22 1C-22 1C-23 1C-24 1C-24 1C-25 1C-25 1C-26 1C-26 1C-27 1C-27 1C-28 1C-29 1C-29 1C-30 1C-30
Page v
ENGINE
Section 3A - 262 cid (4.3L) Engines
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bearing Failures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Piston Failures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pre-Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Detonation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Mounts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rocker Arm Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Intake Manifold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rocker Arm / Push Rod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hydraulic Roller Valve Lifters . . . . . . . . . Locating Noisy Lifters . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Valve Stem Oil Seal / Valve Spring . . . . Removal - Head Installed . . . . . . . . . . Valve Assembly (Exploded View) . . . Installation - Head Installed . . . . . . . . Cylinder Head . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cylinder Head and Valve Conditioning . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Valve Guide Bore Repair . . . . . . . . . . Valve Springs - Checking Tension . . . Valve Seat Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Valve Grinding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dipstick Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Torsional Damper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crankcase Front Cover Oil Seal . . . . . . . Crankcase Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3A-2 3A-4 3A-4 3A-6 3A-11 3A-14 3A-16 3A-16 3A-17 3A-19 3A-20 3A-20 3A-20 3A-21 3A-21 3A-23 3A-23 3A-27 3A-27 3A-28 3A-28 3A-29 3A-30 3A-31 3A-34 3A-34 3A-36 3A-36 3A-38 3A-39 3A-40 3A-40 3A-42 3A-43 3A-47 3A-47 3A-47 3A-48 3A-49 3A-50 3A-50 3A-51 3A-52 3A-55 3A-56 3A-56 3A-56 3A-57 3A-57 3A-58 3A-58 3A-58 3A-59 3A-59 3A-59 3A-60 3A-61 3A-62 Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flywheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear Main Oil Seal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear Main Oil Seal Retainer . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Main Bearings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connecting Rod Bearings . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection and Replacement . . . . . . . Connecting Rod / Piston Assembly . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crankshaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Timing Chain and Sprocket . . . . . . . . . . . Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation - Timing Chain . . . . . . . . . Crankshaft Sprocket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Timing Chain Deflection . . Balance Shaft / Gears . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Camshaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Measuring Lobe Lift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Camshaft Bearings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cylinder Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Filter By-Pass Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection and/or Replacement . . . . . Remote Oil Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection and/or Replacement . . . . . 3A-62 3A-63 3A-63 3A-64 3A-64 3A-64 3A-65 3A-66 3A-66 3A-67 3A-67 3A-68 3A-68 3A-68 3A-68 3A-69 3A-69 3A-71 3A-74 3A-74 3A-76 3A-76 3A-77 3A-78 3A-80 3A-82 3A-84 3A-84 3A-86 3A-87 3A-88 3A-88 3A-88 3A-89 3A-89 3A-89 3A-89 3A-89 3A-90 3A-91 3A-91 3A-94 3A-94 3A-96 3A-96 3A-97 3A-98 3A-98 3A-99 3A-99 3A-100 3A-100 3A-101 3A-101 3A-105 3A-105 3A-106 3A-106
Page vi
Page vii
Section 4D - Instrumentation
Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Special Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lighting Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil, Fuel and Temperature . . . . . . . . . Battery Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cruiselog Meter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gauge Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4D-2 4D-2 4D-2 4D-3 4D-3 4D-5 4D-5 4D-6 4D-7 4D-7 4D-7 4D-8 4D-8 Senders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Tank Sender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ignition Key Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lanyard Stop Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Start/Stop Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Audio Warning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Pressure Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Temperature Switch . . . . . . . . . 4D-9 4D-9 4D-10 4D-13 4D-16 4D-16 4D-17 4D-17 4D-19 4D-20 4D-20 4D-21 4D-21
FUEL SYSTEM
Section 5A - Fuel Delivery System For Carbureted Engines
Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacement Parts Warning . . . . . . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Supply Connections . . . . . . . . . . 5A-2 5A-2 5A-2 5A-2 5A-3 5A-3 5A-3 5A-3 Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel System Components . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Separating Fuel Filter . . . . . . . . . . Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vent Hose Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Carbureted Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-4 5A-4 5A-6 5A-7 5A-8 5A-8 5A-8
Page viii
Page ix
Page x
Section 5I - Diagnostics
Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostic Circuit Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . Scan Tool Normal Specifications . . . . Diagnostic Trouble Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . ECM Connector and EFI Symptoms Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . J-1 Circuits with MEFI 1 . . . . . . . . . . . J-2 Circuits with MEFI 1 . . . . . . . . . . . J-1 Circuits with MEFI 3 . . . . . . . . . . . J-2 Circuits with MEFI 3 . . . . . . . . . . . Wiring System Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . MEFI 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MEFI 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General Diagnostic Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chart A-1 No MIL or No DLC Data . Chart A-2 MIL ON Steady Will Not Flash DTC 12 . . . . . . . . . . . . Chart A-3 Engine Cranks But Will Not Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chart A-4 Fuel System Diagnosis . . Chart A-5 Fuel System Electrical Test Chart A-6 EFI System / Ignition Relay Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chart A-7 Ignition System Check . . . Chart A-8 Idle Air Control (IAC) Functional Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . Discrete Input Circuit Check Non-Scan Only . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5I-2 5I-4 5I-4 5I-5 5I-6 5I-6 5I-8 5I-10 5I-12 5I-14 5I-14 5I-18 5I-21 5I-21 5I-23 5I-25 5I-27 5I-29 5I-31 5I-33 5I-35 5I-41 5I-43 Clearing Trouble Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clearing Codes Using CodeMate Tester . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clearing Codes Using Scan Tool . . . . Diagnostic Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 14 Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 15 Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 21 Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 22 Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 23 Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 25 Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 33 Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 34 Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 41 Ignition Control (IC) Circuit Code 42 Ignition Control (IC) Circuit Code 43 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit Code 44 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit Code 45 Ignition Coil Driver Fault . . Code 51 Calibration Memory Failure Code 52 EEPROM Failure . . . . . . . . Code 61 Fuel Pressure (FP) Circuit . Code 62 Fuel Pressure (FP) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5I-48 5I-48 5I-48 5I-49 5I-49 5I-52 5I-54 5I-57 5I-60 5I-62 5I-64 5I-67 5I-70 5I-72 5I-74 5I-77 5I-80 5I-82 5I-83 5I-84 5I-87
Page xi
COOLING SYSTEM
Section 6A - Seawater Cooled Models
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seawater Inlet Recommendations . . . . . Transom Mounted or Through The Hull Seawater Pickups and Hose . . . . . . . Seacock (Seawater Inlet Valve) . . . . . Sea Strainer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seawater Pickups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Through The Hull Mounted . . . . . . . . . Transom Mounted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Quicksilver Sea Strainer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seawater Pickup Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6A-2 6A-2 6A-2 6A-3 6A-3 6A-4 6A-4 6A-4 6A-4 6A-5 6A-5 6A-6 6A-7 6A-7 6A-9 6A-9 6A-11 6A-11 6A-13 6A-14 Seawater Pump Bearing Housing . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Circulating Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Drive Belt Tension Adjustment . . . . . . . . Flushing Seawater Cooling System . . . . Thermostat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Auxiliary Hot Water Heater Installation Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seawater Flow Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Alpha . . . . . . . . . MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Bravo . . . . . . . . . Draining Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Alpha . . . . . . . . . MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Bravo . . . . . . . . . 6A-15 6A-15 6A-16 6A-17 6A-20 6A-20 6A-20 6A-20 6A-21 6A-21 6A-21 6A-21 6A-22 6A-23 6A-24 6A-28 6A-28 6A-29 6A-30 6A-30 6A-31
Page xii
EXHAUST SYSTEM
Section 7A - General
Exhaust System Requirements . . . . . . . . Exhaust Elbow Risers . . . . . . . . . . . . . MCM (Sterndrive) Engines With Through The Transom Exhaust 7A-2 7A-2 7A-2
Section 7C - Collectors
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Bullhorn Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Shutter Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Component Replacement . . . . . . . . . . 7C-2 7C-2 7C-3 7C-3 7C-4
DRIVES
Section 8A - Drive Shaft
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Flywheel Housing / Output Shaft Housing Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal and Installation . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Drive Shaft Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8A-2 8A-2 8A-2 8A-3 8A-3 8A-4 8A-4 8A-5 8A-5 8A-5 8A-7 Replacement Drive Shafts . . . . . . . . . Drive Shafts Modified to Shorter Lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bearing Support Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8A-7 8A-8 8A-8 8A-10 8A-10 8A-10 8A-11 8A-12
Page xiii
Page xiv
GENERAL INFORMATION
IMPORTANT INFORMATION
Section 1A - General Information
1
A
Table of Contents
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . How to Use This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . Page Numbering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . How to Read a Parts Manual . . . . . . . . . Directional References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Serial Number Location . . . . . . . 1A-2 1A-2 1A-2 1A-3 1A-4 1A-4 1A-5 Propeller Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Testing New Engines . . . . . . . . . . Boat and Engine Performance . . . . . . . . Boat Bottom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Marine Fouling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Weight Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water in Boat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Elevation and Climate . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1A-5 1A-6 1A-6 1A-6 1A-7 1A-8 1A-9 1A-9
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1A-1
GENERAL INFORMATION
Introduction
This comprehensive overhaul and repair manual is designed as a service guide for the models previously listed. It provides specific information, including procedures for disassembly, inspection, assembly and adjustment to enable dealers and service mechanics to repair and tune these engines. Before attempting repairs or tune-up, it is suggested that the procedure first be read through to gain knowledge of the methods and tools used and the cautions and warnings required for safety.
Page Numbering
Two number groups appear at the bottom of each page. Following is an example and description.
b c
a b c d e f g
- Section Number - Section Part - Page Number - Manual Part Number - Revision Number - Month Printed - Year Printed
Index
Page 1A-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
GENERAL INFORMATION
8 10 1 6 4 7
5
REF. NO. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 PART NO. 90507A12 36- 95805 73873A1 16- 41877 57- 65607T 32- 806684 25- 89879 25- 806232 13- 35048 61990 SYM. QTY. 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 DESCRIPTION PUMP ASSEMBLYPower Steering CAP PULLEY STUD V-BELT HOSEPressure (FITTINGS ON BOTH ENDS) O-RING O-RING LOCKWASHER (3/8 in.) CABLE TIE
REF. NO. : Number shown next to part on exploded view PART NO. : Mercury Part Number for ordering. If NSS (not sold separately) sometimes GM part number will be given in description column. QTY. : The quantity that must be ordered. DESCRIPTION : Description of part, what parts are included with a part (all indented items come with the main item above the indented parts), serial number information, and special information.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1A-3
GENERAL INFORMATION
Directional References
Front of boat is bow; rear is stern. Starboard side is right side; port side is left side. In this manual, all directional references are given as they appear when viewing boat from stern looking toward bow.
STARBOARD (RIGHT)
PORT (LEFT)
72000
Engine Rotation
Engine rotation is determined by observing flywheel rotation from the rear (stern end) of the engine looking forward (toward water pump end). Propeller rotation is not necessarily the same as engine rotation. When ordering replacement engine, short blocks or parts for engine, be certain to check engine rotation. Do not rely on propeller rotation in determining engine rotation.
72001
Index
Page 1A-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
GENERAL INFORMATION
b
72975
Propeller Information
Refer to the Propeller section in appropriate Mercury MerCruiser Sterndrive Service Manual, or order publication 90-8614492, What You Should Know About Quicksilver Propellers. Changing diameter, pitch or coupling of a propeller will affect engine rpm and boat performance. The blade configuration also will affect performance. Two like propellers, same pitch and diameter, from two different manufacturers also will perform differently. It is the responsibility of the boat manufacturer and/or selling dealer to equip the boat with the correct propeller to allow the engine to operate within its specified rpm range at wide open throttle (WOT). Because of the many variables of boat design and operation, only testing will determine the best propeller for the particular application. To test for correct propeller, operate boat (with an average load onboard) at WOT and check rpm with an accurate tachometer. Engine rpm should be near top of the specified range so that, under heavy load, engine speed will not fall below specifications. If engine exceeds the specified rpm, an increase in pitch and/or diameter is required. If engine is below rated rpm, a decrease in pitch and/or diameter is required. Normally, a change of approximately 200 rpm will be achieved for each one inch pitch change of a propeller.
CAUTION
If a propeller is installed that does not allow engine rpm to reach the specified full-throttle rpm range, the engine will labor and will not produce full power. Operation under this condition will cause excessive fuel consumption, engine overheating and possible piston damage (due to detonation). On the other hand, installation of a propeller, that allows engine to run above the specified rpm limit, will cause excessive wear on internal engine parts which will lead to premature engine failure.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1A-5
GENERAL INFORMATION
72002
a - Critical Bottom Area For best speed and minimum spray, the corner between the bottom and the transom should be sharp.
a
a - Bottom b - Corner c - Transom
72003
Index
Page 1A-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
GENERAL INFORMATION
The bottom is referred to as having a hook if it is concave in the fore-and-aft direction. A hook causes more lift on the bottom near the transom and forces the bow to drop. This increases wetted surface and reduces boat speed. A hook, however, aids in planing and reduces any porpoising (rhythmical bouncing) tendency. A slight hook is often built in by the manufacturer. A hook also can be caused by incorrect trailering or storing the boat with support directly under the transom.
72004
a
a - Hook A rocker is the reverse of a hook. The bottom is convex or bulged in the fore-and-aft direction. It can cause the boat to porpoise.
a
a - Rocker
72005
Any hook, rocker or surface roughness on the bottom, particularly in the all-important center-aft portion will have a negative effect on speed, often several miles per hour on a fast boat.
Marine Fouling
Fouling is an unwanted build-up (usually animal-vegetable-derived) occurring on the boats bottom and drive unit. Fouling adds up to drag, which reduces boat performance. In fresh water, fouling results from dirt, vegetable matter, algae or slime, chemicals, minerals and other pollutants. In salt water, barnacles, moss and other marine growth often produce dramatic build-up of material quickly. Therefore, it is important to keep the hull as clean as possible in all water conditions to maximize boat performance. Antifouling paint, if required, may be applied to boat hull observing the following precautions. IMPORTANT: DO NOT paint anodes or MerCathode System reference electrode and anode, as this will render them ineffective as galvanic corrosion inhibitors.
CAUTION
Avoid corrosion damage. Do not apply antifouling paint to Mercury MerCruiser drive unit or transom assembly.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1A-7
GENERAL INFORMATION
IMPORTANT: If antifouling protection is required, Tri-Butyl-Tin-Adipate (TBTA) base antifouling paints are recommended on Mercury MerCruiser boating applications. In areas where Tri-Butyl-Tin-Adipate base paints are prohibited by law, copper base paints can be used on boat hull and boat transom. Corrosion damage that results from the improper application of antifouling paint will not be covered by the limited warranty. Observe the following: Avoid an electrical interconnection between the Mercury MerCruiser Product, Anodic Blocks, or MerCathode System and the paint by allowing a minimum of 1-1/2 in. (40mm) UNPAINTED area on transom of the boat around these items.
71176
Weight Distribution
Weight distribution is extremely important; it affects a boats running angle or attitude. For best top speed, all movable weight - cargo and passengers - should be as far aft as possible to allow the bow to come up to a more efficient angle (3 to 5 degrees). On the negative side of this approach is the problem that, as weight is moved aft, some boats will begin an unacceptable porpoise. Secondly, as weight is moved aft, getting on plane becomes more difficult. Finally, the ride in choppy water becomes more uncomfortable as the weight goes aft. With these factors in mind, each boater should seek out what weight locations best suit his/her needs. Weight and passenger loading placed well forward increases the wetted area of the boat bottom and, in some cases, virtually destroys the good performance and handling characteristics of the boat. Operation in this configuration can produce an extremely wet ride, from wind-blown spray, and could even be unsafe in certain weather conditions or where bow steering may occur. Weight distribution is not confined strictly to fore and aft locations, but also applies to lateral weight distribution. Uneven weight concentration to port or starboard of the longitudinal centerline can produce a severe listing attitude that can adversely affect the boats performance, handling ability and riding comfort. In extreme rough water conditions, the safety of the boat and passengers may be in jeopardy.
Index
Page 1A-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
GENERAL INFORMATION
Water in Boat
When a boat loses performance, check bilge for water. Water can add considerable weight to the boat, thereby decreasing the performance and handling. Make certain that all drain passages are open for complete draining.
72006
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1A-9
GENERAL INFORMATION
Index
Page 1A-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
IMPORTANT INFORMATION
Section 1B - Maintenance
1
B
Table of Contents
Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Maintenance Schedules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maintenance Intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gas Sterndrive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Routine Maintenance * . . . . . . . . . . . . Scheduled Maintenance * . . . . . . . . . . Engine and Tune-Up Specifications . . . . MCM (Sterndrive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fluid Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sterndrive Engines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sterndrives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-Hour Break-In Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . After Break-in Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . End of First Season Checkup . . . . . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . Test For Alcohol Content In Gasoline Power Steering Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Coolant for Closed Cooling System . . . . Crankcase Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overfilled Crankcase Oil . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Engine Oil Level / Filling . . Changing Oil and Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing Water Separating Fuel Filter . Power Steering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Fluid Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Cold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Filling and Bleeding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1B-2 1B-2 1B-3 1B-3 1B-3 1B-3 1B-4 1B-5 1B-5 1B-6 1B-6 1B-6 1B-7 1B-7 1B-7 1B-8 1B-8 1B-10 1B-10 1B-10 1B-11 1B-11 1B-12 1B-12 1B-13 1B-15 1B-15 1B-15 1B-16 Closed Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . Flushing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Throttle Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Shift Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Coupler / U-Joint Shaft Splines . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sterndrive Drive Shaft Extension Models . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning Flame Arrestor . . . . . . . . . . . . . Top Mounted Flame Arrestor . . . . . . . Serpentine Drive Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Component Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Serpentine Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S/N 0L619083 and Below . . . . . . . . . . S/N 0L619084 and Above . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing and/or Adjusting Tension . Ignition Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Thunderbolt V Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cold Weather or Extended Storage . . . . Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Package Layup . . . . . . . . . . . . Draining Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Draining Sterndrive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recommissioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1B-17 1B-17 1B-18 1B-20 1B-20 1B-20 1B-21 1B-22 1B-22 1B-23 1B-23 1B-23 1B-24 1B-24 1B-25 1B-26 1B-26 1B-27 1B-27 1B-28 1B-29 1B-29 1B-31 1B-33 1B-38 1B-39
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-1
MAINTENANCE
Tools
Description Timing Light Quicksilver Scan Tool Part Number 91-99379 91-823686A2
Index
Page 1B-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
Maintenance Schedules
Maintenance Intervals
Maintenance intervals and the tasks to be performed, as shown in this current schedule, or as found in a previously printed schedules, are generally based on an average boating application and environment. However, individual operating habits and personal maintenance preferences can have an impact on the suggested intervals. In consideration of these factors, Mercury MerCruiser has adjusted some maintenance intervals and corresponding tasks to be performed. In some cases, this may allow for more individual tasks to be performed in a single visit to the serving dealer, rather than multiple visits. Therefore, it is very important that the boat owner and servicing dealer discuss the current Maintenance Schedule and develop appropriate maintenance intervals to coincide with the individual operating habits, environment, and maintenance requirements.
CAUTION
Always disconnect battery cables from battery BEFORE working around electrical systems components to prevent injury to yourself and damage to electrical system should a wire be accidentally shorted.
Gas Sterndrive
Routine Maintenance *
Each Day Start Check crankcase oil (interval can be extended based on experience). If operating in salt, brackish or polluted waters, flush cooling system after each use. Check drive unit oil level, trim pump oil level and power steering pump fluid level. Check water pickups for debris or marine growth. Check water strainer and clean. Check coolant level. Inspect drive unit anodes and replace if 50 percent eroded. Inspect fuel pump sight tube and have pump replaced if fuel is present. Check battery connections and fluid level. Lubricate propeller shaft and the retorque nut (if operating in only freshwater, this maintenance may be extended to every four months). Operating in Saltwater Only: treat engine surface with corrosion guard. Clean air filter every 50 hours of operation. * Only perform maintenance which applies to your particular power package D Standard Models L Horizon Models
DL DL DL DL DL DL DL DL
Weekly
DL DL
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-3
MAINTENANCE
Gas Sterndrive(Continued)
Scheduled Maintenance *
Every Every Every 200 300 Every Every 100 Annu2 5 hours hours hours or ally or 3 or 3 years years Annually years years Touch-up paint power package and spray with corrosion guard. Change crankcase oil and filter. Change drive unit oil and retorque connection of gimbal ring to steering shaft. Replace fuel filter(s). Check steering system and remote control for loose, missing or damaged parts. Lubricate cables and linkages. Inspect U-joints, splines and bellows. Check clamps. Check engine alignment. Lubricate U-joints splines. Lubricate gimbal bearing and engine coupler. Check continuity circuit for loose or damaged connections. Test MerCathodeR unit output on Bravo Models. Retorque engine mounts. Check spark plugs, wires, distributor cap and ignition timing. Check and adjust idle speed. Clean flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hoses. Replace PCV valve. Check electrical system for loose, damaged or corroded fasteners. Inspect condition and tension of belts. Check cooling system and exhaust system hose clamps for tightness. Inspect both systems for damage or leaks. Disassemble and inspect seawater pump and replace worn components. Clean seawater section of closed cooling system. Clean, inspect and test pressure cap. Replace coolant. * Only perform maintenance which applies to your particular power package D Standard Models L Horizon Models z Whichever Occurs First x Interval will be reduced if not using extended life coolant. * Lubricate engine coupler every 50 hours if operated at idle for prolonged periods of time.
DL DL DL DL DL D D* D D D D D D D D D L L L L L L L L L L L
DL
Index
Page 1B-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
MCM 4.3LH ALPHA / BRAVO 205 (190)2 153 (142)2 V-6 262 cid (4.3 l)
4.0 x 3.48 (101.6 x 88.4) 9.4:1 650 rpm5 4400-4800 rpm Minimum 30 psi (207 kPa) Minimum 4 psi (28 kPa) 3-7 psi (21-48 kPa) 55 or 65 amp 8 375 cca / 475 mca / 90 Ah 1-6-5-4-3-2 AC - MR43LTS Champion - RS12YC NGK - BPR6EFS .045 in. (1.1 mm) 10 BTDC 1 1/4 Turns 160 F (71 C) 8 BTDC DNA 30 psi ( kPa) 12 V Negative () Ground 9.4:1 600 rpm5 Minimum 100 psi (690 kPa)7
rpm)4
Power Rated in Accordance with NMMA (National Marine Manufacturers Association) rating procedures.
Power Rated in Accordance with SAV1 rating procedures. This rating procedure is used to certify that the engine complies with Stage 1 Bodensee and Swiss Regulations. Horsepower differences shown result from differences in test rpm, allowable test tolerances, and/or installation of special kit components. using an accurate service tachometer with engine at normal operating temperature. must be set using a special procedure as outlined in the appropriate section of this manual. Timing cannot be properly set using the conventional method. A special procedure must be followed to adjust idle rpm. Consult your Authorized Mercury MerCruiser Dealer before attempting this procedure. speed on EFI models is not adjustable. recorded compression in any one cylinder should not be less than 70 percent of the highest recorded
3 Measured 4 Timing 5
6 Idle
7 Minimum
cylinder.
8
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-5
MAINTENANCE
Fluid Capacities
NOTICE Unit Of Measurement: U.S. Quarts (Liters) All capacities are approximate fluid measures.
Sterndrive Engines
Model Crankcase Oil (With Filter) 1 Seawater Cooling System Closed Cooling System
1 2
Always use dipstick to determine exact quantity of oil or fluid required. Seawater Cooling System capacity information is for winterization use only.
Sterndrives
NOTICE Unit Of Measurement: U.S. Fluid Ounces (Milliliters) All capacities are approximate fluid measures. Model Drive Unit Oil Capacity (With Gear Lube Monitor) ALPHA ONE 64 (1892)
Index
Page 1B-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-7
MAINTENANCE CA261
Specifications
Fuel Recommendations
IMPORTANT: Use of improper gasoline can damage your engine seriously. Engine damage resulting from use of improper gasoline is considered misuse of engine, and damage caused thereby will not be covered under the limited warranty.
FUEL RATINGS
Mercury MerCruiser engines will operate satisfactorily when using a major brand of unleaded gasoline as follows: USA and Canada - having a posted pump Octane Rating of 87 (R+M)/2 minimum. Premium gasoline [92 (R+M)/2 Octane] is also acceptable. DO NOT use leaded gasoline. Outside USA and Canada - having a posted pump Octane Rating of 90 RON minimum. Premium gasoline (98 RON) is also acceptable. If unleaded gasoline is not available, use a major brand of leaded gasoline.
CA291
VAPOR LOCKING
Fuels containing alcohol and winter grade fuels will aggravate vapor lock problems. A vapor lock condition can be identified by the following problems: Engine starts and, upon advancing throttle, shuts off and will not restart. If engine does restart, it shuts off when advancing throttle. Engine is difficult to restart after operating the boat and then leaving the engine off for 1 to 3 hours. Other factors may combine to increase vapor locking. These factors include but are not limited to: air temperature fuel tank location fuel supply system engine coolant temperature temperature and vacuum of fuel to engine engine compartment air temperature and ventilation Other conditions should be ruled out before treating the problem as vapor locking.
Index
Page 1B-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
WARNING
FIRE AND EXPLOSION HAZARD: Fuel leakage from any part of fuel system can be a fire and explosion hazard which can cause serious bodily injury or death. Careful periodic inspection of entire fuel system is mandatory, particularly after storage. All fuel components including fuel tanks, whether plastic metal or fiberglass, fuel lines, fittings, fuel filters and carburetors/fuel injection components should be inspected for leakage, softening, hardening, swelling or corrosion. Any sign of leakage or deterioration requires replacement before further engine operation. Because of possible adverse effects of alcohol in gasoline, it is recommended that only alcohol-free gasoline be used where possible. If only fuel containing alcohol is available, or if the presence of alcohol is unknown, increased inspection frequency for leaks and abnormalities is required. IMPORTANT: When operating a Mercury MerCruiser engine on gasoline containing alcohol, storage of gasoline in the fuel tank for long periods should be avoided. Long periods of storage, common to boats, create unique problems. In cars alcohol-blend fuels normally are consumed before they can absorb enough moisture to cause trouble, but boats often sit idle long enough for phase separation to take place. In addition, internal corrosion may take place during storage if alcohol has washed protective oil films from internal components.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-9
MAINTENANCE
PROCEDURE
1. Fill the container with water to the mark. 2. Add fuel almost to fill the container, leaving some air space, then cap the container. The proportions of fuel to water are not critical, but there should be 2 to 3 times as much fuel as water. 3. Shake container vigorously and allow it to sit upright for 3 to 5 minutes. If the volume of water appears to have increased, alcohol is present. If you are not sure, there is no need for concern. If the dividing line between water and fuel becomes cloudy, use the middle of the cloudy band.
Index
Page 1B-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
Crankcase Oil
To help obtain optimum engine performance and to provide maximum protection, we strongly recommend the use of Quicksilver 4-Cycle 25W-40 Marine Engine Oil. This oil is a special blend of 25-weight and 40-weight oils for marine engines. If not available, a good grade, straight weight, detergent automotive oil of correct viscosity, with an API classification of SH,CF/CF-2, may be used. In those areas where Quicksilver 4-Cycle 25W-40 Marine Engine Oil or a recommended straight weight oil are not available, a multiviscosity 20W-40 (SH, CF/CF-2) or, as a second but less preferable choice, 20W-50, with API service ratings of SH, CF/CF-2 may be used. IMPORTANT: The use of non-detergent oils, multi-viscosity oils (other than Quicksilver 25W-40 or a good quality 20W-40 or 20W-50), synthetic oils, low quality oils or oils that contain solid additives are specifically not recommended. The chart below is a guide to crankcase oil selection. The oil filter should always be changed with oil.
Quicksilver 4-Cycle Marine Engine Oil
SAE 40W
SAE 30W
SAE 20W
32 F 0 C
50 F 10 C
70534
AIR TEMPERATURE
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-11
MAINTENANCE
Index
Page 1B-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
WARNING
Make sure no fuel leaks exist before closing engine hatch.
CAUTION
The electric fuel pump and factory installed water separating fuel filter have been carefully designed to function properly together. Do not install additional fuel filters and/or water separating fuel filters between fuel tank and engine. The installation of additional filters may cause: Fuel Vapor Locking Difficult Warm-Starting Piston Detonation Due to Lean Fuel Mixture Poor Driveability 1. Unsnap latch and slide top and bottom cover pieces, if equipped, from around the water separating fuel filter and bracket.
75034
a - Fuel Filter Cover NOTE: Top and bottom cover pieces are formed with a groove on each side that slides around the brackets outer edges.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-13
MAINTENANCE
2. Remove water separating fuel filter and sealing ring from mounting bracket and discard.
a
70573
a - Fuel Filter b - Sealing Ring 3. Coat sealing ring on new filter with motor oil. 4. Thread filter onto bracket and tighten securely by hand. Do not use a filter wrench. 5. Start and run engine. 6. Check filter connection for gasoline leaks. If leaks exist, recheck filter installation. 7. Install cover pieces around fuel filter. Be certain top part of cover latches to lower part.
Index
Page 1B-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
74908
a - Fill Cap / Dipstick b - Power Steering Pump 3. Level should be between the FULL HOT mark and ADD mark on dipstick.
a
a - Proper Fluid Level with Engine Warm
72518
4. If level is below ADD mark, but fluid is still visible in pump reservoir, add required amount of Quicksilver Power Trim and Steering Fluid or automatic transmission fluid (ATF) Dexron III through fill cap opening, to bring level up to FULL HOT mark on dipstick. DO NOT OVERFILL. 5. If fluid is not visible in reservoir, a leak exists in the power steering system. Find cause and correct.
Engine Cold
1. With engine stopped, position drive unit so that it is straight back. 2. Remove fill cap / dipstick from power steering pump and note fluid level. 3. Level should be between FULL COLD mark and bottom of dipstick.
a
a - Proper Fluid Level with Engine Cold
72519
4. If level is below bottom of dipstick, but fluid is still visible in pump reservoir, add required amount of Quicksilver Power Trim and Steering Fluid or automatic Dexron III transmission fluid (ATF), through fill cap opening, to bring level up to FULL COLD mark on dipstick. DO NOT OVERFILL.
Index
If fluid is not visible in reservoir, a leak exists in the power steering system. Find cause and correct.
Page 1B-15
MAINTENANCE
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without water being supplied to seawater pickup pump, or pump impeller may be damaged and subsequent overheating damage to engine may result. 7. Start engine and run at fast idle (1000-1500 rpm) until engine reaches normal operating temperature. During this time, turn steering wheel back and forth to end of travel in each direction several times. 8. Position drive unit so that it is straight back and stop engine. 9. Remove fill cap from pump. 10. Allow any foam in pump reservoir to disperse. 11. Check fluid level and add fluid, as required, to bring level up to FULL HOT mark on dipstick. DO NOT OVERFILL. 12. Reinstall fill cap. Tighten securely. IMPORTANT: Drive unit must be positioned straight back and power steering fluid must be hot to accurately check fluid level. 13. If fluid is still foamy (in Step 5.), repeat Steps 7. through 12. until fluid does not foam and level remains constant.
Index
Page 1B-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
CAUTION
Allow engine to cool down before removing pressure cap. Sudden loss of pressure could cause hot coolant to boil and discharge violently. After engine has cooled, turn cap 1/4 turn to allow any pressure to escape slowly, then push down and turn cap all the way off. 1. Coolant level in heat exchanger should be full (to bottom of filler neck). IMPORTANT: When reinstalling pressure cap, be sure to tighten it until it contacts on filler neck. 2. Coolant level should be between the ADD and FULL marks on coolant recovery reservoir with the engine at normal operating temperature.
72520
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-17
MAINTENANCE
Flushing System
If engine is operated in salty, polluted or mineral-laden water, flush seawater cooling system (preferably after each use) to reduce corrosion and prevent the accumulation of deposits in the system. Thoroughly flush the seawater cooling system prior to storage. NOTE: For additional protection against freezing and rust to the exhaust manifolds and other components, a 50-50 mixture of antifreeze and water can be run through the engine during Power Package Layup. 1. Install flushing attachment and water hose over the water pickup holes in gear housing.
b
a - Flushing Attachment b - Hose
72693
WARNING
When flushing, be certain the area around propeller is clear, and no one is standing nearby. To avoid possible injury, remove propeller.
CAUTION
Do not run engine above 1500 rpm when flushing. Suction created by seawater pickup pump may collapse flushing hose, causing engine to overheat.
CAUTION
Watch temperature gauge on dash to ensure that engine does not overheat. 2. Open water tap enough to cool the engine, about of its maximum capacity. Adjust as required so that the engine does not overheat. 3. With drive in neutral gear, start engine and advance the throttle until the engine reaches 1300 rpm. IMPORTANT: DO NOT run the engine at idle rpm. Watch engine temperature gauge on dash. Do not run the engine above 1500 rpm or engine overheating may occur. 4. Run engine for 10 minutes or until the discharge water is clear. 5. Slowly return the throttle to the idle position and turn engine off. IMPORTANT: DO NOT rapidly advance or return throttle as this can cause water ingestion.
Index
Page 1B-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
BOAT IN WATER
1. Raise drive unit to full UP / OUT position. 2. Install flushing attachment over water pickup holes in gear housing as shown. 3. Attach a water hose between the flushing attachment and a water tap.
b
a - Flushing Attachment b - Hose 4. Lower drive unit to full DOWN / IN position.
72693
CAUTION
Do not run engine above 1500 rpm when flushing. Suction created by seawater pickup pump may collapse flushing hose, causing engine to overheat.
CAUTION
Watch temperature gauge on dash to ensure that engine does not overheat. 5. Partially open water tap (approximately 1/2 maximum capacity). DO NOT use full water pressure. 6. Place remote control in neutral, idle speed position, and start engine. 7. Operate engine at idle speed in neutral for 10 minutes, then stop engine. 8. Shut off water tap. 9. Raise drive unit to full UP / OUT position. 10. Remove water hose and flushing attachment.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-19
MAINTENANCE
Lubrication
Throttle Cable
1. Lubricate pivot points and guide contact surfaces with SAE 30W motor oil.
a b
b a
71359
a
EFI Models
74941
Shift Cable
MCM (STERNDRIVE) MODELS
1. Lubricate pivot points and guide contact surfaces with SAE 30W motor oil.
b a
Typical Shift Cable a - Pivot Points b - Guide Contact Surface
a
72016
Index
Page 1B-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
b a
71569
72529
IMPORTANT: Later Bravo Models may be equipped with a coupler that is similar to the Alpha Coupler. a - Grease Fitting b - Quicksilver Engine Coupler Spline Grease
a
72531
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-21
MAINTENANCE
72018
a
Transom End a - Grease Fitting Engine End
72028
WARNING
Avoid gasoline fire or explosion. Gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. NEVER use gasoline as a cleaning solvent.
Index
Page 1B-22 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
76501
a - Flame Arrestor 4. Clean flame arrestor in solvent. Blow dry with compressed air. 5. Clean crankcase ventilation hose in solvent. Blow dry with compressed air. 6. Inspect crankcase ventilation hose for cracks or deterioration and replace if necessary. 7. Reinstall flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hose. 8. Reinstall flame arrestor cover.
WARNING
Avoid possible serious injury. Make sure engine is shut off and ignition key is removed before inspecting belt. NOTE: Some models will have components arranged in a different order. All configurations are not shown. Checking, replacing and adjustment procedures are the same.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-23
MAINTENANCE
Index
Page 1B-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
76503
76502
76445
76463
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-25
MAINTENANCE
Inspection
1. Inspect drive belt for the following: Excessive wear Cracks NOTE: Minor, transverse cracks (across the belt width) may be acceptable. Longitudinal cracks (in direction of belt length) that join transverse cracks are NOT acceptable. Fraying Glazed surfaces
75130
a - Fraying b - Cracks
Index
Page 1B-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
7. While holding adjustment stud at the correct belt tension, tighten 5/8 in. locking nut. 8. Run engine for a short period of time and recheck belt adjustment.
b
74908
Ignition Timing
Thunderbolt V Models
1. Connect timing light to number 1 spark plug wire. 2. Connect a shop tachometer to the engine. IMPORTANT: Before starting the engine, connect a jumper wire from the ignition timing lead to a good ground. This has to be done before the ignition key is turned ON to lock the ignition module into Base Timing Mode. 3. Before starting the engine, connect jumper wire from timing lead to a good ground. NOTE: The PUR/WHT timing lead is located towards the front of the engine near the fuel line or near the distributor, as equipped for your model. 4. Start engine and run at 1300 rpm until it reaches normal operating temperature. 5. Disconnect throttle cable from the carburetor. 6. With engine at idle rpm, adjust the carburetor idle rpm screw to the specified engine idle rpm. 7. With the engine still at idle rpm, check the ignition timing. If incorrect, rotate the distributor until timing is correct. Torque clamping screw to 18 lb-ft (25 Nm). 8. Adjust the idle mixture screw. Inward is LEAN, outward is RICH. 9. Recheck ignition timing. 10. Stop engine. Remove timing light, jumper wire and shop tachometer. IMPORTANT: Timing jumper wire has to be removed or the ignition module will stay locked in the Base Timing Mode and it will not be able to advance the ignition timing correctly when the engine rpm is increased. 11. Adjust and reinstall throttle cable. Open and close remote control throttle lever. Ensure that the carburetor throttle lever is contacting the idle rpm adjusting screw every time. 12. Restart the engine, increase rpm to 1300 then return to idle position slowly and shut the engine off. Ensure that the carburetor throttle lever is contacting the idle rpm screw.
Index
MAINTENANCE
EFI
1. Connect timing light to number 1 spark plug wire. 2. Start engine and run at 1300 rpm until it reaches normal operating temperature. 3. Stop engine and connect the scan tool or timing tool to the DLC connector on the EFI wiring harness. 4. Start engine, allow rpm to stabilize. NOTE: MEFI-1 models only, manually adjust remote control throttle lever to get 1200 engine rpm. NOTE: MEFI-3 models only, ECM will automatically adjust engine rpm to approximately 1200 rpm when put in the service mode on a scan tool or when using the timing tool. 5. Check ignition timing. If incorrect, rotate the distributor until timing is correct. Torque clamping screw to 18 lb-ft (25 Nm). 6. Recheck ignition timing. 7. Disconnect scan tool or timing tool from DLC connector. 8. If required, return remote control throttle lever to idle position and shut off engine. 9. Restart engine, increase rpm to 1300 then return to idle position slowly. Ensure that engine returns to idle rpm. Readjust throttle cable, if required. 10. Shut engine off.
Index
Page 1B-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
WARNING
Always disconnect battery cables from battery BEFORE working on fuel system to prevent fire or explosion.
WARNING
BE CAREFUL while working on fuel system; gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark and/or open flames in the area. Wipe up any spilled fuel immediately.
WARNING
Avoid Fire or Explosion: To prevent a potential fire hazard, be sure that engine compartment is well ventilated and that there are no gasoline vapors present during starting or fogging of engine.
WARNING
Avoid Fire or Explosion: Fuel injection system is pressurized during operation. Use care when removing water separating fuel filter. Fuel could spray on hot engine causing fire or explosion. Allow engine to cool down before attempting to remove the water separating fuel filter in the following procedure. Also, hold a clean shop towel over the water separating fuel filter when removing it to help avoid fuel spraying on the engine.
CAUTION
If boat is in the water, seacock (water inlet valve), if equipped, must be closed until engine is to be restarted, to prevent water from flowing back into cooling system and/or boat. If boat is not fitted with a seacock, water inlet hose must be disconnected and plugged to prevent water from flowing back into cooling system and/or boat. As a precautionary measure attach a tag to the ignition switch or steering wheel of the boat with the warning that the seacock must be opened or the water inlet hose reconnected prior to starting engine.
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without water flowing through seawater pickup pump, as pump impeller may be damaged and subsequent overheating damage to engine or sterndrive unit may result.
CAUTION
If engine is equipped with Closed Cooling System, Closed Cooling section must be kept filled with a solution of ethylene glycol antifreeze and water (mix antifreeze to manufacturer s recommended proportions to protect engine to lowest temperature to which it will be exposed). DO NOT USE PROPYLENE GLYCOL antifreeze in closed cooling section. Seawater section, however, must be drained completely.
CAUTION
A discharged battery can be damaged by freezing.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-29
MAINTENANCE
CAUTION
Seawater section of cooling system MUST BE COMPLETELY drained for winter storage, or immediately after cold weather use, if the possibility of freezing temperatures exists. Failure to comply may result in trapped water causing freeze and/or corrosion damage to engine.
WARNING
When running engine with boat out of water, be certain that area in vicinity of propeller is clear and that no person is standing nearby. As a precautionary measure, it is recommended that the propeller be removed.
CAUTION
DO NOT run engine above 1500 rpm, as suction created by seawater pickup pump may collapse water supply hose and cause engine to overheat.
WARNING
Be sure that engine compartment is well ventilated and that no gasoline vapors are present to prevent the possibility of a FIRE or EXPLOSION. IMPORTANT: Observe the following information to ensure complete draining of cooling system. Engine must be as level as possible. A wire should be repeatedly inserted into all drain holes to ensure there are no obstructions in passages. IMPORTANT: To prevent threads in manifolds, elbows and cylinder blocks from rusting during storage, reinstall drain plugs. Never leave drain plugs out during storage. NOTE: If possible, place a container under drains and hoses to prevent water from draining into boat.
Index
Page 1B-30 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
IMPORTANT: Mercury MerCruiser strongly recommends that this service be performed by an Authorized Mercury MerCruiser Dealer. Damage caused by freezing IS NOT covered by the MerCruiser Limited Warranty. 1. Fill fuel tank(s) with fresh gasoline that does not contain alcohol and a sufficient amount of Quicksilver Gasoline Stabilizer for Marine Engines to treat gasoline. Follow instructions on container. 2. If boat is to be placed in storage with fuel containing alcohol in fuel tanks (if fuel without alcohol is not available): Fuel tanks should be drained as low as possible and Quicksilver Gasoline Stabilizer for Marine Engines added to any fuel remaining in the tank. Refer to Fuel Requirements for additional information. NOTE: If desired, a portable fuel tank can be used to perform the remainder of the power package layup procedures. Be sure to add an appropriate amount of Gasoline Stabilizer to the portable tank. 3. Run engine sufficiently to bring it up to normal operating temperature and allow fuel with Quicksilver Gasoline Stabilizer to circulate through fuel system. 4. Shut off engine. 5. Change oil and oil filter. 6. Flush cooling system. Refer to Flushing Cooling System procedure. 7. Close the fuel shutoff valve, if equipped. If no fuel shutoff valve is present, a suitable method must be employed to STOP the flow of fuel from the fuel tank to the engine before proceeding.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-31
MAINTENANCE
8. Prepare EFI fuel system for extended storage as follows: a. Allow engine to cool down. b. Remove the water separating fuel filter. c. Pour out a small amount of fuel into a suitable container, then add approximately 2 fluid ounces (60 ml) of Quicksilver 2-Cycle Outboard Oil to fuel in the water separating fuel filter. d. Reinstall water separating fuel filter. e. Start and operate engine at idle speed until the water separating fuel filter and fuel injection system are empty and engine stops. f. Remove and discard water separating fuel filter. g. Install new filter.
a
a - Water Separating Fuel Filter 9. Prepare carbureted fuel system for extended storage as follows: a. Remove flame arrestor assembly and start engine.
75533
b. While operating engine at fast idle (1000-1500 rpm), fog internal surfaces of induction system and combustion chambers by squirting approximately 8 ounces (227 grams) of Quicksilver Storage Seal or SAE 20W engine oil into carburetor bores. c. Squirt the remaining 2 ounces (57 g) of Storage Seal (or oil) rapidly into carburetor, just as the engine begins to stall due to lack of fuel. Allow engine to stop. 10. Turn ignition key to OFF position. 11. Refer to Flushing Cooling System and appropriately remove water supply to the seawater pickup pump. 12. Clean flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hoses and reinstall. 13. Lubricate all items listed in Lubrication section. 14. Drain seawater section of cooling system as outlined in Draining Instructions section. 15. On Models with Closed Cooling System: Test coolant to ensure that it will withstand the lowest temperature expected during storage. 16. Service batteries per manufacturer s instructions. 17. Clean outside of engine and repaint any areas required with Quicksilver Primer and Spray Paint. After paint has dried, spray Quicksilver Corrosion and Rust Preventive Type II or wipe down with Quicksilver Storage Seal or SAE 20W engine oil. 18. For sterndrive unit layup, refer to appropriate sterndrive service manual. NOTE: For additional protection against freezing and rust to the exhaust manifolds and other components, a 50-50 mixture of antifreeze and water can be run through the engine during Power Package Layup.
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
Page 1B-32
MAINTENANCE
Draining Instructions
DRAINING SEAWATER (RAW-WATER) COOLED MODELS
NOTICE Refer to Precautions in this section BEFORE proceeding. IMPORTANT: Engine must be as level as possible to ensure complete draining of cooling system. 1. Remove drain plugs from bottom of port and starboard manifold fittings. 2. Remove drain plugs (port and starboard) from cylinder block or cylinder block Y-fitting.
CAUTION
Avoid product damage. Do not disturb the Y-fitting when removing the drain plug. There is an ignition control Knock Sensor in the upper hole of the fitting. This sensor must not be loosened or removed. It is tightened to a critical specification at the factory.
c a b e
74073
Starboard Side Shown (Port Similar) a - Exhaust Elbow Drain Plug b - Cylinder Block Drain Plug c - Y-Fitting (Fuel Injected Only) d - Cylinder Block Drain Plug (Fuel Injected Only) e - Knock Sensor
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-33
MAINTENANCE
3. Repeatedly clean out drain holes using a stiff piece of wire. Do this until entire system is drained. NOTE: It may be necessary to lift, bend or lower hoses to allow water to drain completely when hoses are disconnected. 4. Remove the engine water circulating pump hose or drain plug, as equipped.
b
72587 76038
a - Hose, Water Circulating Pump To Thermostat Housing b - Water Circulating Pump Hose Drain Plug 5. Remove the drain plug from the water tube or Cool Fuel System cooler, as equipped.
a
Some Carbureted Models a - Drain Plug
75018
a
Fuel Injected Models
75081
a
a - Seawater Inlet Hose b - Hose To Cooler
75533
7. Crank engine over slightly with starter motor to purge any water trapped in seawater pickup pump. DO NOT ALLOW ENGINE TO START.
Index
Page 1B-34 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
8. After seawater section of cooling system has been drained completely: a. Install all drain plugs and tighten securely. b. Reconnect hoses and tighten all hose clamps securely. c. If NOT equipped with seacock: Seawater inlet hose must remain disconnected and plugged until engine is to be restarted. IMPORTANT: Mercury MerCruiser recommends that propylene glycol antifreeze (nontoxic and biodegradable) be used in seawater section of the cooling system for cold weather or extended storage. Make sure that the propylene glycol antifreeze contains a rust inhibitor and is recommended for use in marine engines. Be certain to follow the propylene glycol manufacturer s recommendations. 9. For additional assurance against freezing and corrosion in the internal water passages: a. Remove the thermostat cover and thermostat. b. Fill the engine seawater cooling system with a mixture of antifreeze and tap water mixed to manufacturer s recommendation to protect engine to the lowest temperature to which it will be exposed during cold weather or extended storage. c. Using a new gasket, reinstall thermostat and cover. Tighten cover bolts to 30 lb-ft (41 Nm). NOTE: Hoses shown removed for visual clarity. Do not remove hoses.
b c d
e
74493
a b c d e
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-35
MAINTENANCE
a
74073
a - Drain Plug 2. Remove the drain plug from the water tube or Cool Fuel System cooler, as equipped.
a
Some Carbureted Models a - Drain Plug
75018
a
Fuel Injected Models
75081
NOTE: It may be necessary to lift, bend or lower hoses to allow water to drain completely when hoses are disconnected.
Index
Page 1B-36 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
75533
a
a - Seawater Inlet Hose b - Hose To Cooler 4. Remove end caps, sealing washers and gaskets from the heat exchanger. Allow tubes to drain.
c
71515
d
a b c d - Heat Exchanger - Sealing Washer - End Cap - Gasket
IMPORTANT: Use compressed air to blow any remaining water from the tubes in the heat exchanger. 5. Repeatedly clean out drain holes using a stiff piece of wire. Do this until entire system is drained. 6. After seawater section of cooling system has been drained completely: a. Install all drain plugs and tighten securely. b. Reconnect hoses and tighten all hose clamps securely. c. Apply Quicksilver Perfect Seal to both sides of new end plate gaskets. d. Assemble new gaskets, new sealing washers and end plates onto heat exchanger. Torque end plate screws to 36-72 lb-in. (4-8 Nm). e. If NOT equipped with seacock: Seawater inlet hose must remain disconnected and plugged until engine is to be restarted.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-37
MAINTENANCE
Draining Sterndrive
NOTICE Predelivery Preparation Instructions Must Be Performed Before Delivering Boat To The Product Owner. 1. On Bravo Drive Equipped Models: Insert a small wire (repeatedly) to make sure that speedometer pitot tube, anode cavity vent hole and anode cavity drain passage are unobstructed and drained.
e d a
c f
71217
Typical a - Speedometer Pitot Tube b - Anode Cavity Vent Hole c - Anode Cavity Drain Passage d - Gear Housing Water Drain Hole (One Each - Port and Starboard) e - Gear Housing Cavity Vent Hole f - Gear Housing Cavity Drain Hole 2. On Alpha Drive Equipped Models: Insert a small wire (repeatedly) to make sure that speedometer pitot tube, trim tab cavity vent hole and trim tab cavity drain passage are unobstructed and drained.
e b d a f
71216
Index
Page 1B-38
a b c d e f
- Speedometer Pitot Tube - Trim Tab Cavity Vent Hole - Trim Tab Cavity Drain Passage - Gear Housing Water Drain Hole (One Each - Port and Starboard) - Gear Housing Cavity Vent Hole - Gear Housing Cavity Drain Hole
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MAINTENANCE
Recommissioning
NOTICE Refer to Precautions in this section BEFORE proceeding. 1. Ensure that all cooling system hoses are connected and tight. 2. Ensure all petcocks and drain plugs are installed and tight. 3. Inspect serpentine drive belt for condition and proper tension. 4. Perform all lubrication and maintenance specified for completion Annually and Every 100 hours or Annually in maintenance schedule, except items which were performed at time of engine layup. 5. For sterndrive unit recommissioning, refer to appropriate Sterndrive Service Manual.
CAUTION
When installing battery (in next step), be sure to connect positive battery cable to positive (+) terminal and negative (grounded) battery cable to negative () battery terminal. If battery cables are reversed, damage to electrical system WILL result. 6. Install fully charged battery. Clean battery cable clamps and terminals to help retard corrosion.
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without cooling water being supplied to seawater pickup pump or water pump impeller will be damaged and subsequent overheating damage to engine may result. 7. Start engine and closely observe instrumentation to ensure that all systems are functioning properly. 8. Carefully inspect entire engine for fuel, oil, water and exhaust leaks. 9. Check steering system, shift and throttle controls for proper operation.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1B-39
MAINTENANCE
Index
Page 1B-40 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
IMPORTANT INFORMATION
Section 1C - Troubleshooting
1
C
Table of Contents
Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Used Spark Plug Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . Normal Condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chipped Insulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Wet Fouling (Oil Deposits) . . . . . . . . . Cold Fouling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High Speed Glazing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Scavenger Deposits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pre-Ignition Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reversed Coil Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . Splashed Deposits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Poor Boat Performance and/or Poor Maneuverability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Improper Full Throttle Engine RPM . . . . RPM Too High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . RPM Too Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Cranks Over But Will Not Start Or Starts Hard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . mportant Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Thunderbolt V Ignition (No Spark) . . . Testing Thunderbolt V Ignition System Fuel System Rich . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel System Lean . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Will Not Crank Over . . . . . . . . . . . Charging System Inoperative . . . . . . . . . Noisy Alternator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Instrumentation Malfunction . . . . . . . . . . Radio Noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1C-2 1C-3 1C-3 1C-3 1C-4 1C-4 1C-4 1C-5 1C-5 1C-5 1C-6 1C-6 1C-6 1C-7 1C-8 1C-8 1C-8 1C-9I 1C-9 1C-10 1C-10 1C-11 1C-11 1C-11 1C-12 1C-12 1C-13 1C-13 1C-13 Poor Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Runs Poorly at Idle . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Runs Poorly At High RPM . . . . . Engine Acceleration Is Poor . . . . . . . . . . Troubleshooting with Vacuum Gauge . . Engine Noise . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Important Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . Valve Cover Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cylinder Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Camshaft Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crankshaft Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Low Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Excessive Oil Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . Water In Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Important Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water on Top of Pistons . . . . . . . . . . . Water in Crankcase Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Insufficient Water Flow from Belt Driven Seawater Pickup Pump . Power Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Poor, Erratic or No Assist . . . . . . . . . . Noisy Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fluid Leaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1C-14 1C-14 1C-15 1C-16 1C-16 1C-17 1C-17 1C-17 1C-18 1C-18 1C-19 1C-20 1C-21 1C-21 1C-22 1C-22 1C-23 1C-24 1C-24 1C-25 1C-25 1C-26 1C-26 1C-27 1C-27 1C-28 1C-29 1C-29 1C-30 1C-30
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-1
TROUBLESHOOTING
Precautions
WARNING
Always disconnect battery cables from battery BEFORE working on fuel system to prevent fire or explosion.
WARNING
Avoid gasoline fire or explosion. Improper installation of brass fittings or plugs into fuel pump or fuel filter base can crack casting and/or cause a fuel leak. Follow specific procedures given in this manual for all fuel line connections.
WARNING
Make sure no fuel leaks exist before closing engine hatch.
WARNING
When running engine with boat out of water, be certain that area in vicinity of propeller is clear and that no person is standing nearby. As a precautionary measure, it is recommended that the propeller be removed.
WARNING
BE CAREFUL while working on fuel system; gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark and/or open flames in the area. Wipe up any spilled fuel immediately.
WARNING
Avoid Fire or Explosion: Fuel injection system is pressurized during operation. Use care when removing water separating fuel filter. Fuel could spray on hot engine causing fire or explosion. Allow engine to cool down before attempting to remove the water separating fuel filter in the following procedure. Also, hold a clean shop towel over the water separating fuel filter when removing it to help avoid fuel spraying on the engine.
WARNING
Be sure that engine compartment is well ventilated and that no gasoline vapors are present to prevent the possibility of a FIRE or EXPLOSION.
WARNING
DO NOT leave helm unattended while performing idle speed adjustment.
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without water flowing through seawater pickup pump, as pump impeller may be damaged and subsequent overheating damage to engine or sterndrive unit may result.
CAUTION
DO NOT run engine above 1500 rpm, as suction created by seawater pickup pump may collapse water supply hose and cause engine to overheat.
Index
Page 1C-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Normal Condition
Few deposits are present and probably will be light tan or gray in color. This plug shows that plug heat range is compatible with engine, and engine is electrically and mechanically in good running condition. With proper plug servicing (clean, file and re-gap), this plug can be reinstalled with good results.
72420
Chipped Insulator
Chipped insulator usually results from careless plug re-gapping. Under certain conditions, severe detonation also can split insulator firing ends. Replace spark plug.
72420
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-3
TROUBLESHOOTING
72420
Cold Fouling
Dry, black deposits indicate rich fuel mixture or weak ignition. Clogged flame arrestor, flooding carburetor, sticky choke or weak ignition components all are probable causes. If, however, only one or two plugs in set are fouled, check for sticking valves or bad ignition leads. After correcting cause, service (clean, file and re-gap) plugs and reinstall.
72421
Overheating
Insulator is dull white or gray and appears blistered. Electrodes are eroded and there is an absence of deposits. Check that correct plug heat range is being used. Also check for over-advanced ignition timing, cooling system malfunction, lean fuel/air mixtures, leaking intake manifold or sticking valves. Replace spark plugs.
72421
Index
Page 1C-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
72421
Scavenger Deposits
Powdery white or yellow deposits are built up on shell, insulator and electrodes. This is normal appearance with certain branded fuels. Accumulation on ground electrodes and shell areas may be unusually heavy, but may be easily chipped off. Plugs may be serviced (clean, file and re-gap) and reinstalled.
72422
Pre-Ignition Damage
Pre-ignition damage is caused by excessive high temperatures. Center electrode melts first, followed by ground electrode. Normally, insulators are white but may be dirty if plug has been misfiring. Check for correct plug heat range, advanced ignition timing, lean fuel mixture, incorrect fuel used, malfunctioning cooling system, leaking intake manifold or lack of lubrication. Replace spark plugs.
72422
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-5
TROUBLESHOOTING
72422
Splashed Deposits
Spotted deposits, which sometimes occur after long delayed tune-up, accumulate after a long period of misfiring. When normal combustion temperatures are restored, upon installation of new plugs, deposits loosen from top of piston and head and are thrown against hot insulator. Plugs may be serviced (clean, file and re-gap) and reinstalled.
72423
Mechanical Damage
Mechanical damage to spark plug firing end is caused by foreign object in combustion chamber. Because of valve overlap, small objects can travel from one cylinder to another. Check all cylinders, intake manifold and exhaust material to prevent further damage. Replace spark plugs.
72423
IMPORTANT: When working on engine, spark plug holes and carburetor throat should be kept covered to prevent foreign objects from entering combustion chamber.
Index
Page 1C-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-7
TROUBLESHOOTING
Boat
Boat
Operation
Index
Page 1C-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-9
TROUBLESHOOTING
With key in RUN position, check for 12 volts at positive (+) terminal on ignition coil.
0 Volts
0 Volts
Unplug WHT/RED bullet connector from distributor. Check for 12 volts on lead coming from module.
12 Volts
Reconnect WHT/RED bullet connectors. Remove high-tension lead from distributor to coil. Insert a spark gap tester from coil tower to ground. Disconnect WHT/GRN lead from distributor. Place ignition key in RUN position. Rapidly strike the terminal of the WHT/GRN lead that comes from module, against ground (-).
Spark at coil.
No spark at coil.
Substitute a new ignition coil. Repeat above test. No spark at coil. Replace ignition module.
Spark at coil.
IMPORTANT: The WHT/GRN lead must be touched against ground () 2-3 times per second to simulate a running engine. Repeat this test several times to ensure that spark is present.
Index
Page 1C-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Miscellaneous
Cause Low grade or stale fuel Water in fuel Special Information
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-11
TROUBLESHOOTING
Index
Page 1C-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Noisy Alternator
Cause Loose mounting bolts Drive belt Loose drive pulley Worn or dirty bearings Faulty diode trio or stator Worn, frayed, loose Special Information
Instrumentation Malfunction
Cause Faulty wiring, loose or corroded terminals Faulty key switch Faulty gauge Faulty sender Test, as outlined in SECTION 4D Test, as outlined in SECTION 4D Test, as outlined in SECTION 4D Special Information
Radio Noise
Cause Special Information
A popping noise that will increase with Ignition System - wrong spark plugs; engine rpm. Noise will stop as soon as en- cracked distributor cap; cracked coil tower; gine is turned off. leaking spark plug wires; moisture on ignition components High pitched whine in the radio A hissing or crackling noise when instruments are jarred with ignition on Alternator - poor brush contact on the slip rings Instrumentation - loose connections, or antennae wire routed too close to instruments Accessories - bilge pump, bilge blower; fish finder, depth locator; cabin heater motor, etc. Disconnect one at a time until noise disappears.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-13
TROUBLESHOOTING
Operator habits
Engine laboring Clogged flame arrestor Engine compartment sealed too tight Boat bottom Improper fuel Crankcase ventilation system not working Engine running too cold or too hot Plugged or restricted exhaust Engine
Not enough air for engine to run properly Dirty (marine growth), hook, rocker
Low compression
Index
Page 1C-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Also refer to Poor Boat Performance Crankcase overfilled with oil Anti-siphon valve (if equipped) Plugged fuel tank vent Fuel supply Ignition timing Low grade of fuel or water in the fuel Spark plugs Spark plug wires Distributor cap or rotor Coil Distributor Engine overheating Low compression Restricted exhaust Excessive play in shaft Refer to Engine Overheats Worn valves, rings, cylinders, etc. Fouled, burned, cracked porcelain, incorrect heat range Poor insulation, broken wires Dirty or cracked Refer to Fuel Injection System Troubleshooting, SECTION 5H Check oil level with boat at rest in the water. Restricting fuel supply
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-15
TROUBLESHOOTING
Also refer to Poor Boat Performance Idle mixture screws Incorrect ignition timing Incorrect distributor or amplifier advance curve Cracked or dirty distributor cap or rotor Vacuum leak Spark plugs Low compression Intake manifold Fouled, burned; wrong heat range; cracked porcelain Refer to SECTION 4B
Fluctuates 4 or 5 inches very slowly at idle Spark plug gap too narrow, valves are rpm sticking Fluctuates rapidly at idle, steadies as rpm is increased Continuously fluctuates between low and normal reading at regular intervals at idle rpm Valve guides are worn
Index
Page 1C-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Engine Noise
Important Information
No definite rule or test will positively determine source of engine noise; therefore, use the following information only as a general guide to engine noise diagnosis. 1. Use a timing light to determine if noise is timed with engine speed or one-half engine speed. Noises timed with engine speed are related to crankshaft, rods, pistons, piston pins and flywheel. Noises timed to one-half engine speed are valve train related. 2. The use of a stethoscope can aid in locating a noise source. However, because noise will travel to other metal parts not involved in the problem, caution must be exercised. 3. If you believe noise is confined to one particular cylinder, ground spark plug leads, one at a time. If noise lessens noticeably or disappears, it is isolated to that particular cylinder. 4. Try to isolate the noise to location in engine: front to back, top to bottom. This can help determine which components are at fault. 5. Sometimes noises can be caused by moving parts coming in contact with other components. Examples are: flywheel or coupler; exhaust flappers rattling against exhaust pipe; crankshaft striking (pan, pan baffle, or dipstick tube); rocker arm striking valve cover; and loose flywheel cover. In many cases if this is found to be the problem, a complete engine teardown is not necessary. 6. When noise is isolated to a certain area and component, removal and inspection will be required. Refer to proper sections of service manual for information required for service. 7. If noise cannot be distinguished between engine and drive unit, remove drive from boat. Run a water supply directly to engine. Run engine without the drive to determine if noise is still there.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-17
TROUBLESHOOTING
Cylinder Area
Location Possible Causes Sticking valve Carbon build-up Connecting rod installed wrong Cylinder area, may be confined to one cylinder or found in more than one cylinder, timed to engine speed Bent connecting rod Piston Piston rings Piston pin Cylinder worn
Camshaft Area
Location Possible Causes Crankshaft timing sprocket Camshaft area, front of engine, timed to one half engine speed Timing chain Valve Lifter Cam Bearings Fuel Pump Camshaft area, center of engine, timed to one half engine speed Valve Lifter Cam bearing Distributor gear Camshaft area, rear of engine, timed to one half engine speed Valve lifter Cam bearings Loss of oil pressure Camshaft area, throughout engine, timed to one half engine speed Valve lifters Cam bearings
Index
Page 1C-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Crankshaft Area
Location Possible Causes Crankshaft timing sprocket Crankshaft area, front of engine, timed to engine speed Timing chain Main bearing Rod bearing Crankshaft striking pan or pan baffle Crankshaft area, center of engine, timed to engine speed Main bearing Rod bearing Loose flywheel cover Loose coupler Crankshaft area, rear of engine, timed to engine speed Loose flywheel Main bearing Rod bearing Loss of oil pressure Crankshaft area, throughout engine, timed Main bearings to engine speed Rod bearings
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-19
TROUBLESHOOTING
Miscellaneous
Noise Possible Cause Advanced timing Low octane fuel Engine spark knock Engine running hot Carbon deposits in engine Vacuum leak Leaking exhaust (manifolds or pipes) Hissing Loose cylinder heads Blown head gasket Vacuum leak Whistle Dry or tight bearing in an accessory Leaking high tension lead Sparks jumping Cracked coil tower Cracked distributor cap Serpentine drive belt slipping Squeaks or squeals Dry or tight bearing in an accessory Parts rubbing together Rattling in exhaust pipe area Exhaust shutters
Index
Page 1C-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Oil Pressure
Miscellaneous
Cause Measuring oil pressure Check engine oil level with boat at rest in the water Special Information Use a good automotive oil pressure test gauge. Do not rely on the oil pressure gauge in the boat. Oil level should be between the ADD and FULL / OP RANGE / OK marks May cause loss of engine rpm, oil pressure gauge fluctuation, drop in oil pressure, and hydraulic valve lifter noise at high rpm Low oil pressure; oil pressure gauge fluctuation; internal engine noise and/or damage This may be a normal condition. Oil pressure may read high in the cooler times of the day, and when engine is not up to operating temperature. As the air temperature warms up and engine is running at normal opening temperature, it is normal for oil pressure to drop. With modern engines and engine oils, low oil pressure readings at idle do not necessarily mean there is a problem. If valve lifters do not clatter (at idle), there is a sufficient volume of oil to lubricate all internal moving parts properly. The reason for the drop in oil pressure is that engine heat causes an expansion of the internal tolerances in the engine and, also, the oil will get thin somewhat from heat. Refer to the two preceding steps It is not uncommon to see different oil pressure readings between the two engines, as long as both engines fall within specifications. Differences in oil pressure can be attributed to differences in engine tolerances, gauges, wiring, senders, etc.
Low engine oil pressure at idle after running at a high rpm Boats with dual engines
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-21
TROUBLESHOOTING
Oil pump
Index
Page 1C-22 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Oil leaks Oil too thin Oil level too high Drain holes in cylinder head plugged Defective valve seals Intake manifold gasket leaking Worn valve stems or valve guides Defective oil cooler (if equipped) Defective piston rings
Crack in cooler tubes Glazed, scuffed, worn, stuck, improperly installed; ring grooves worn; improper break-in; wrong end gap Out of round, scored, tapered, glazed; excessive piston to cylinder clearance; cracked piston
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-23
TROUBLESHOOTING
Water In Engine
Important Information
IMPORTANT: First determine location of water in engine. This information can help determine where the water came from and how it got into the engine. The three most common problems are water on top of pistons, water in crankcase oil or water in crankcase oil and on top of pistons. After locating water remove all the water from the engine by removing all spark plugs and pumping cylinders out by cranking engine over. Change oil and filter. Replace spark plugs. Start engine and see if problem can be duplicated. If problem can be duplicated, there is a mechanical problem. If the problem cannot be duplicated, the problem is either an operator error or a problem that exists only under certain environmental conditions. If water is contained to cylinder(s) only, it is usually entering through the intake system, exhaust system, or head gasket. If the water is contained to crankcase only, it is usually caused by a cracked or porous block, a flooded bilge or condensation. If the water is located in both the cylinder(s) and the crankcase, it is usually caused by water in the cylinders getting past the rings and valves, or complete submersion. Checking for rust in the intake manifold or exhaust manifolds is a good idea. Rust in these areas will give clues if the water entered these areas.
Index
Page 1C-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Water seeping past piston rings or valves Engine running cold Intake manifold leaking near a water passage Cracked or porous casting
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-25
TROUBLESHOOTING
Engine Overheats
Mechanical
Cause Engine rpm below specifications at wideopen-throttle (engine laboring) Wrong ignition timing Sticking distributor advance weights Spark plug wires crossed (wrong firing order) Lean fuel mixture Wrong heat range spark plugs Exhaust restriction Valve timing off Jumped timing chain, or improperly installed A blown head gasket(s) normally cannot be detected by a compression check. Normally the engine will run at normal temperature at low rpm, but will overheat at speeds above 3000 rpm. Engines that are seawater cooled: Using a clear plastic hose, look for air bubbles between seawater pump and engine. If there are no bubbles present, install clear plastic hose between thermostat housing and manifold(s). If air bubbles are present at a higher rpm, it is a good indication there is a blown head gasket. Defective oil pump, plugged oil passage, low oil level Special Information Damaged or wrong propeller; growth on boat bottom; false bottom full of water Timing too far advanced or retarded
Index
Page 1C-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Engine Overheats
Cooling System
Cause Special Information
IMPORTANT: The first step is to verify if the engine is actually overheating or the temperature gauge or sender is faulty. IMPORTANT: Best way to test gauge or sender is to replace them. Loose or broken drive belt Seawater shutoff valve partially or fully closed (if equipped) Clogged or improperly installed sea strainer Loose hose connections between seawater pickup and seawater pump inlet (models with belt driven seawater pump only) Seawater inlet hose kinked or collapsed Seawater pickup clogged Obstruction on boat bottom causing water turbulence Defective thermostat Exhaust elbow water outlet holes plugged Insufficient seawater pump operation Obstruction in cooling system such as casting flash, sand, rust, salt, etc. Engine circulating pump defective Also refer to Engine Overheats Mechanical IMPORTANT: In addition to previous checks, make the following checks if engine is equipped with closed cooling. Low coolant level Antifreeze not mixed properly Heat exchanger cores plugged Water hoses reversed at the water distribution block Refer to water flow diagram in SECTION 6 Antifreeze should be mixed 50/50 or maximum 60/40 (60% antifreeze, 40% water) Worn pump impeller Refer to water flow diagram for engine type being serviced Obstruction will be in front of seawater pickup, causing air bubbles to be forced into cooling system Pump will suck air. Pump may fail to prime or will force air bubbles into cooling system.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-27
TROUBLESHOOTING
Index
Page 1C-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Power Steering
Poor, Erratic or No Assist
Cause Drive belt Low fluid level Air in system Air leak in lines, pump or air from installation. Refer to SECTION 9A for bleeding procedure. Refer to SECTION 9A for bleeding procedure. Cable or helm partially frozen from rust or corrosion; cable over-lubricated; improper cable installation. Refer to appropriate Sterndrive Service Manual Causes a loss of pressure Special Information Worn, broken or out of adjustment
Leaking hoses
Binding in sterndrive unit Restriction in hydraulic hoses Control valve not positioned properly, not balanced properly, or the mounting nut is loose Mounting bracket adjusting screw loose or mounting tube is loose Faulty pump
Worn piston ring or scored housing bore in Causes loss of pressure cylinder. Leaking valve body or loose fitting spool
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-29
TROUBLESHOOTING
Noisy Pump
Cause Drive belt Low fluid level Air in fluid Faulty pump Restricted fluid passages Stop nut adjusted improperly Steering cables installed that do not meet BIA standards Air leak in lines, pump or air from installation Use stethoscope to listen for noise in pump Kinks or debris in hoses or debris in passages Refer to appropriate Sterndrive Service Manual Refer to appropriate Sterndrive Service Manual Special Information Check belt tension
Fluid Leaks
Cause Loose hose connections Damaged hose Oil leaking from top of pump Cylinder piston rod seal Faulty seals in valve Faulty seals in o-rings in pump Cracked or porous metal parts System overfilled; fluid contains water; fluid contains air Special Information Refer to SECTION 9A for bleeding instructions
Index
Page 1C-30 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
TROUBLESHOOTING
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 1C-31
TROUBLESHOOTING
Index
Page 1C-32 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MCM MODELS
Table of Contents
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation and Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electrical Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mercathode Connections . . . . . . . . . . Shift Cable Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Steering Connections . . . . . . . Fuel Supply Connections . . . . . . . . . . Throttle Cable Installation and Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2A-2 2A-2 2A-2 2A-3 2A-5 2A-10 2A-11 2A-12 2A-12 2A-12 2A-13 2A-14
2
A
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 2A-1
MCM MODELS
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Drive Unit Shift Cable Hose Clamps Rear Engine Mounts Power Steering Fluid Hose Fitting Remote Control Shift Cables Cable Barrel Cable End Guide Cable Barrel Cable End Guide lb-in. lb-ft See Note Securely 35-40 23 Securely See Note 47-54 31 Nm Spread Cotter Key
Tools
Description Engine Alignment Tool Part Number 91-805475A1
Index
Page 2A-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MCM MODELS
Removal
IMPORTANT: Sterndrive unit must be removed prior to engine removal. Refer to Sterndrive Service Manual. 1. Disconnect battery cables from battery. 2. Remove instrument harness connector plug from engine harness receptacle after loosening clamp.
WARNING
Be careful when working on fuel system. Gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Do not smoke or allow spark or open flame in area. Wipe up any spilled fuel immediately. 3. Using wrench to stabilize brass filter nut at fuel inlet, loosen fuel line fitting. Disconnect and suitably plug fuel line to prevent fuel in tank from leaking into bilge. 4. Disconnect throttle cable from carburetor or throttle body and retain locknuts and hardware. 5. Disconnect trim sender bullet connectors from transom assembly from engine harness. NOTE: After wires are disconnected be sure to loosen them from clamps or sta-straps retaining them to engine or hoses. 6. Alpha Models: Slide sleeves back on BLK and WHT/GRN or GRY wires and disconnect engine harness wires from shift cut-out switch harness. 7. Disconnect MerCathode wires from MerCathode controller if mounted on engine, if equipped. 8. Disconnect seawater inlet hose from gimbal housing. 9. Disconnect exhaust elbow hoses (bellows). 10. Remove both shift cables from shift plate. Retain locknuts and hardware. 11. Disconnect any grounding wires and accessories connected to engine. 12. Disconnect and plug fluid hoses from power steering control valve on transom.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 2A-3
MCM MODELS
CAUTION
Center lifting eye (located on top of thermostat housing) is used for engine alignment only. DO NOT use to lift entire engine.
CAUTION
DO NOT allow lifting sling to hook or compress engine components or damage will occur. 13. Support engine with suitable sling through lifting eyes on engine and remove front and rear engine mounting bolts. Retain hardware.
a a
75847
a - Engine Lifting Eyes 14. Carefully remove engine. DO NOT hit power steering control valve.
Index
Page 2A-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MCM MODELS
a b c d
a b c d - Double Wound Lockwasher - Fiber Wound Lockwasher (Cemented In Place) - Inner Transom Plate Mount (Engine Support) - Locknuts (Engine Mounting Bolts)
72023
CAUTION
Center lifting eye (located on top of thermostat housing) is used for engine alignment only. DO NOT use to lift entire engine.
CAUTION
DO NOT allow lifting sling to hook or compress engine components or damage will occur. 6. Attach a suitable sling to lifting eyes on engine and adjust so that engine is level when suspended. 7. Lift engine into position (in boat), using an overhead hoist. 8. Align rear engine mounts with inner transom plate mounts while simultaneously aligning exhaust tubes with exhaust pipe hoses (bellows).
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 2A-5
MCM MODELS
IMPORTANT: Engine attaching hardware must be installed in sequence shown. 9. Install both rear engine mounting bolts and hardware as shown. Torque to 37 lb-ft (50 Nm).
a c d e g h
f
72535
a b c d e f g h
- Rear Engine Mounting Bolt - Large Steel Washer - Metal Spacer - Rear Engine Mount - Double Wound Lockwasher - Fiber Washer (Cemented in Place) - Inner Transom Plate Mounts - Locknut (Hidden In This View)
CAUTION
When lowering engine into position DO NOT set engine on shift cable. Shift cable outer casing can be crushed causing difficult or improper shifting. 10. Set engine down on stringers and relieve hoist tension. Disconnect sling from engine lifting eyes and switch sling to center lifting eye.
b a
75847
Index
Page 2A-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MCM MODELS
CAUTION
DO NOT use an alignment tool from another manufacturer. Alignment tools other than Quicksilver Alignment Tool 91-805475A1, may cause improper alignment and damage to gimbal bearing and/or engine coupler.
CAUTION
To avoid damage to gimbal bearing, engine coupler, or alignment tool: w DO NOT attempt to force alignment tool! w DO NOT raise or lower engine with alignment tool inserted (or partially inserted) in gimbal bearing or engine coupler.
CAUTION
Avoid damage to exhaust system. On engines with single piece manifolds, stress can be placed on the lower exhaust pipe if front of engine is raised too high while performing engine alignment procedure. Ensure that engine is not raised higher than the top of engine mount adjusting stud.
a b c d
Engine Mount a - Nut and Lockwasher b - Adjustment Nut c - Turn Adjustment Nut in This Direction (Counterclockwise) d - Slotted Hole Toward Front of Engine e - Tab Washer
72536
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 2A-7
MCM MODELS
11. Align engine as follows: a. Attempt to insert solid end of Quicksilver Alignment Tool through gimbal bearing and into engine coupler splines. If it will not insert easily proceed to following. b. While observing the above precautions, CAREFULLY raise and lower front of engine with hoist, as required, until tool will SLIDE FREELY all the way in and out of engine coupler splines.
b a
70013
a - Quicksilver Alignment Tool (91-805475A1) b - Insert This End of Alignment Tool through Gimbal Housing Assembly
72585
a - Alignment Tool (91-80547A1) b - Gimbal Bearing c - Engine Coupler IMPORTANT: Turn both front engine mount adjustment nuts an equal amount in direction required to align engine. c. Adjust front engine mounts until they rest on boat stringers. d. Relieve hoist tension entirely and fasten both front mounts to boat stringer using appropriate hardware (lag bolts or through-bolts, etc.). e. Recheck alignment with alignment tool. Tool must enter coupler splines freely. If not, readjust front mounts. f. When alignment is correct, tighten locknut or nut with lockwasher on each mount securely.
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
Page 2A-8
MCM MODELS
a b c d e
72536
a - Locknut b - Adjustment Nut c - Turn Adjustment Nut In This Direction (Counterclockwise) To Raise Front Of Engine d - Slotted Hole To Front Of Engine e - Tab Washer h. Remove alignment tool if not already removed. 12. Tighten all exhaust system hose clamps securely (use two hose clamps on each connection): a. On Engines with Thru-Prop Exhaust:
a a
72537
Thru Prop Exhaust Shown a - Hose Clamps b - Exhaust Tube - Long Tube, Port Side - Short Tube, Starboard Side
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 2A-9
MCM MODELS
Engine Connections
IMPORTANT: When routing all wire harnesses and hoses, be sure they are routed and secured to avoid coming in contact with hot spots on engine and avoid contact with moving parts. 1. Connect seawater hose to water tube at gimbal housing with hose clamp. Tighten clamp securely. NOTE: For visual clarity the engine is not shown in position.
c b
72590
b b
a
Alpha Models a - Water Inlet Tube b - Hose Clamp c - Seawater Inlet
72614
Index
Page 2A-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MCM MODELS
Electrical Connections
1. Connect instrument harness to engine harness with hose clamp. Tighten clamp securely. 2. Connect trim position sender leads from gimbal housing to leads from engine harness.
b a
c
a b c d - BRN/WHT (From Engine Harness) - BLK (From Engine Harness) - BLK (From Transom) - BLK (From Transom Assembly)
72582
IMPORTANT: Do not attach any accessory ground () wires to transom plate ground point. Accessory ground wires should only be attached to ground stud on engine. 3. Connect any grounding wires or accessories that may have been disconnected.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 2A-11
MCM MODELS
a
a b c d
22232
- ORG Wire - From Electrode on Transom Assembly - RED/PUR Wire - To Positive (+) Battery Terminal - BLK Wire - From Engine Harness - BRN Wire - From Electrode on Transom Assembly
CAUTION
Route hoses exactly as shown below. This will help avoid stress on the hose fittings and will help avoid kinks in the hose. IMPORTANT: Make hydraulic connections as quickly as possible to prevent fluid leakage. IMPORTANT: DO NOT cross-thread or overtighten fittings. 2. Torque both fittings to 23 lb-ft (31 Nm).
73786
Index
Page 2A-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MCM MODELS
3. Connect battery cables to battery by FIRST connecting POSITIVE (+) battery cable (usually RED) to POSITIVE (+) battery terminal. Tighten clamp securely. Then, connect NEGATIVE () battery cable (usually BLK) to NEGATIVE () battery terminal. Tighten clamp securely. NOTE: Spray terminals with a battery connection sealant to help retard corrosion.
WARNING
Avoid gasoline fire or explosion. Improper installation of brass fittings or plugs into fuel pump or fuel filter base can crack casting and/or cause a fuel leak. w w w w w Apply #592 Loctite Pipe Sealant with Teflon to threads of brass fitting or plug. DO NOT USE TEFLON TAPE. Thread brass fitting or plug into fuel pump or fuel filter base until finger tight. Tighten fitting or plug an additional 1-3/4 to 2-1/4 turns using a wrench. DO NOT OVER TIGHTEN. Install fuel line. To prevent over tightening, hold brass fitting with suitable wrench and tighten fuel line connectors securely. Check for fuel leaks.
WARNING
Be careful when working on fuel system. Gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Do not smoke or allow spark or open flame in area. Wipe up any spilled fuel immediately. 1. Connect fuel line from fuel tank(s) to engine. Tighten connections securely. 2. Check for leaks.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 2A-13
MCM MODELS
b d
MerCarb 2 Barrel Carburetor a - Cable End Guide b - Attaching Hardware c - Cable Barrel d - Anchor Studs
b d
72013
b c d
a d b
72014
Weber 4 Barrel Carburetor a - Cable End Guide b - Attaching Hardware (DO NOT Overtighten) c - Cable Barrel d - Anchor Studs 1. Place remote control handle(s) in neutral, idle position. IMPORTANT: Be sure that cable is routed in such a way as to avoid sharp bends and/ or contact with moving parts. DO NOT fasten any items to throttle cable. Outer cable must be free to move when cable is actuated. 2. Install cable end guide on throttle lever, then push cable barrel lightly toward throttle lever end. (This will place a slight preload on cable to avoid slack in cable when moving remote control lever.) Adjust barrel on throttle cable to align with anchor stud. 3. Secure throttle cable with hardware (retained). Tighten cable end guide nut until it contracts and then loosen 1/2 turn. Tighten cable barrel securely. DO NOT OVERTIGHTEN, as cable must pivot freely.
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
Page 2A-14
MCM MODELS
4. Place remote control throttle lever in the wide-open-throttle (WOT) position. Ensure that throttle shutters (valves) are completely open and throttle shaft lever contacts carburetor body casting. 5. Return remote control throttle lever to idle position and check to ensure that throttle lever contacts idle speed adjustment screw.
74104
Weber 4 Barrel Carburetor Wide-Open-Throttle a - Throttle Shaft Lever b - Carburetor Body Casting
a b
70392
Weber 4 Barrel Carburetor Idle Position a - Throttle Lever b - Idle Speed Adjustment Screw
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 2A-15
MCM MODELS
EFI ENGINES
1. Install cable end guide on throttle lever, then push cable barrel end lightly toward throttle lever end. (This will place a slight preload on shift cable to avoid slack in cable when moving remote control lever). Adjust barrel on throttle cable to align with hole in anchor plate. 2. Secure throttle cable with hardware as shown and tighten securely. Tighten locknut until it contacts, then loosen one-half turn. 3. Place remote control throttle level in the wide open throttle (WOT) position. Ensure that throttle plates are completely open. 4. Return remote control throttle lever to idle position.
d
75867
a b c d
- Cable End Guide - Flat Washer and Locknut - Cable Barrel - Flat Washer and Locknut
Index
Page 2A-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
MCM MODELS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 2A-17
MCM MODELS
Index
Page 2A-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
ENGINE
Section 3A - 262 cid (4.3L) Engines
Table of Contents
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bearing Failures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Piston Failures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pre-Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Detonation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Mounts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rocker Arm Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Intake Manifold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rocker Arm / Push Rod . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hydraulic Roller Valve Lifters . . . . . . . . . Locating Noisy Lifters . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Valve Stem Oil Seal / Valve Spring . . . . Removal - Head Installed . . . . . . . . . . Valve Assembly (Exploded View) . . . Installation - Head Installed . . . . . . . . Cylinder Head . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cylinder Head and Valve Conditioning . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Valve Guide Bore Repair . . . . . . . . . . Valve Springs - Checking Tension . . . Valve Seat Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Valve Grinding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dipstick Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Pan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Torsional Damper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crankcase Front Cover Oil Seal . . . . . . . Crankcase Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3A-2 3A-4 3A-4 3A-6 3A-11 3A-14 3A-16 3A-16 3A-17 3A-19 3A-20 3A-20 3A-20 3A-21 3A-21 3A-23 3A-24 3A-27 3A-27 3A-28 3A-28 3A-29 3A-30 3A-31 3A-34 3A-34 3A-36 3A-36 3A-38 3A-39 3A-40 3A-40 3A-42 3A-43 3A-47 3A-47 3A-47 3A-48 3A-49 3A-50 3A-50 3A-51 3A-52 3A-55 3A-56 3A-56 3A-56 3A-57 3A-57 3A-58 3A-58 3A-58 3A-59 3A-59 3A-59 3A-60 3A-61 3A-62 Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flywheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear Main Oil Seal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rear Main Oil Seal Retainer . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Main Bearings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Connecting Rod Bearings . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection and Replacement . . . . . . . Connecting Rod / Piston Assembly . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Crankshaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Timing Chain and Sprocket . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation - Timing Chain . . . . . . . . . Crankshaft Sprocket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Timing Chain Deflection . . Balance Shaft / Gears . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Camshaft . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Measuring Lobe Lift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Camshaft Bearings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cylinder Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Filter By-Pass Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection and/or Replacement . . . . . Remote Oil Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection and/or Replacement . . . . . 3A-62 3A-63 3A-63 3A-64 3A-64 3A-64 3A-65 3A-66 3A-66 3A-67 3A-67 3A-68 3A-68 3A-68 3A-68 3A-69 3A-69 3A-71 3A-74 3A-74 3A-76 3A-76 3A-77 3A-78 3A-80 3A-82 3A-84 3A-84 3A-86 3A-87 3A-88 3A-88 3A-88 3A-89 3A-89 3A-89 3A-89 3A-90 3A-91 3A-91 3A-93 3A-94 3A-96 3A-96 3A-97 3A-98 3A-98 3A-99 3A-99 3A-100 3A-100 3A-101 3A-101 3A-105 3A-105 3A-106 3A-106
3
A
Index
Page 3A-1
NOTE: Hold fuel pump using flat surface at outlet before tightening brass fitting.
Index
Page 3A-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-3
Tools
Mercury Marine Special Tools Description Piston Ring Expander Engine Coupler Wrench Part Number 91-24697 91-35547
Special Tools
Snap-On Special Tools (see note) Description Torque Angle Gauge (Degree Wheel Torquing) Part Number TA 360
NOTE: Snap-On Tools can be ordered from your nearest Snap-On branch sales office or distributor.
Index
Page 3A-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Kent-Moore Special Tools Kent-Moore Special Tools 29784 Little Mack Roseville, MI 48066 (800) 345-2233 Description Valve Spring Compressor Valve Spring Compressor Valve Spring Tester Valve Guide Cleaner Valve Guide Reamer Carbon Remover Brush Piston Pin Remover Kit Piston Ring Groove Cleaner Piston Ring Compressor Connecting Rod Bolt Guide Set (3/8-24) Oil Pump Suction Pipe Installer Camshaft Bearing Remover and Installer Set Ball Socket Adaptor Tool Kit (Lift Indicator) Torsional Damper Remover and Installer Crankcase Front Cover Seal Installer Crankshaft Gear and Sprocket Puller Crankshaft Gear and Sprocket Installer Air Adaptor Main Bearing Remover/Installer Rear Main Seal Installer Balance Shaft Rear Bearing Remover Balance Shaft Bearing Remover/Installer Part Number J5892 J8062 J8056 J8101 J5830-2 J8089 J24086-B J3936-03 J8037 J5239 J21882 J6098-01 J8520-1 J23523-E J35468 J5825-A J5590 J23590 J8080 J26817-A J26941 J33834
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-5
Specifications
262 CID / 4.3L Engine Specifications
NOTICE Unit Of Measurement: Inches (Millimeters) Displacement Bore Stroke Compression Ratio Heads Intake manifold Block Rods Pistons Crankshaft Camshaft
CYLINDER BORE
262 cid (4.3 L) 4.00 (101.6) 3.48 (88.39) 9.2:1 Cast Iron Cast Iron Cast Iron (2 Bolt Main Bearing Caps) Forged Steel Cast Aluminum Cast Iron Steel
4.0007-4.0017 (101.6178-1016431) Production Service Thrust Side Relief Side .0005 (0.0127) Maximum .002 (0.05) Maximum .0005 (0.0127) Maximum .001 (0.02) Maximum .001 (0.02) Over Production
Taper
Clearance
Production Service
Index
Page 3A-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
.02-.06 (0.508-1.524) .04-.08 (1.016-2.032) .004 (0.10) Maximum .010-.016 (0.25-0.40) .018-.026 (0.46-0.66) Maximum .06-.035 (1.52-0.88) Maximum .02-.07 (0.508-0.177) .02-.08 (0.50-2.03) Maximum .015-.050 (0.381-1.27) .009-.065 (0.23-1.65) Maximum
Oil
PISTON PIN
.9267-.9271 (23.545-23.548) .0002-.0007 (0.0051-0.0177) .001 (0.02) Maximum .0008-.0016 (0.021-0.040) Interference
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-7
NOTICE Unit Of Measurement: Inches (Millimeters) No. 1 Diameter Main Journal No. 2, 3 No. 4 Taper Out-ofRound Production Main Bearing Clearance Service Crankshaft End Play Crankshaft Runout Diameter Connecting Rod Journal Taper Out-ofRound Rod Bearing Clearance Rod Side Clearance Production Service Production Service Production Service Production Service Production Service No. 1 No. 2, 3, 4 No. 1 No. 2, 3, 4 2.4488-2.4495 (62.199-62.217) 2.4485-2.4494 (62.191-62.215) 2.4479-2.4489 (62.179-62.203) .0003 (0.007) Maximum .001 (0.02) Maximum .0002 (0.005) Maximum .001 (0.02) Maximum .0008-.0020 (0.0203-0.0508) .0011-.0023 (0.0279-0.0584) .001-.002 (0.03-0.05) .001-.002 (0.25-0.06) .002-.008 (0.05-0.20) .001 (0.025) Maximum 2.2487-2.2497 (57.1170-57.1423) .0003 (0.00508) Maximum .001 (0.02) Maximum .0002 (0.007) Maximum .001 (0.02) Maximum .0013-.0035 (0.0330-0.0889) .001-.003 (0.02-0.07) Maximum .006-.017 (0.152-0.44)
Index
Page 3A-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Hydraulic Roller 1.50:1 .414 (10.52) .428 (10.87) Net Lash No Adjustment 45 46 .002 (0.05) Maximum .035-.060 (0.89-1.52) .062-.093 (1.58-2.38) .0011-.0027 (0.0279-0.069) .001 (0.025) Maximum .002 (0.51) Maximum .341 (8.64) .031 (0.79)
Valve Lash (Intake and Exhaust) Face Angle (Intake & Exhaust) Seat Angle (Intake & Exhaust) Seat Runout (Intake & Exhaust) Seat Width Production Stem Clearance Service Stem Diameter Intake Exhaust Intake Exhaust Intake Exhaust Intake Exhaust
2.03 (51.6) 76-84 Lb. (338-374 N) at 1.7 in (43.16 mm) 187-203 Lb. (832-903 N) at 1.27 in (32.25 mm) 1.78 in (45.2 mm) 1.69-1.71 in. (42.9-43.43)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-9
Lobe Lift . 002(0.051) Journal Diameter Journal Out of Round Camshaft Runout Camshaft End Play Timing Chain Deflection
FLYWHEEL
Intake Exhaust
.286-.290 (7.26-7.36) .292-.296 (7.42-7.52) 1.8682-1.8692 (47.452-47.478) .001 (0.025) Maximum .002 (0.051) Maximum .001-.009 (0..0254-0.2286) .375 (9.5) from taut position [total .75 (19)]
Runout
CYLINDER HEAD
Front Bearing Journal Rear Bearing Journal Rear Bearing Inside Diameter Assembled Rear Bearing Outside Diameter Rear Cylinder Block Housing Bore Production Production Production
2.1648-2.1654 (55.985-55.001) 1.4994-1.500 (38.084-38.100) 1.5014-1.503 (37.525-37.575) 1.875-1.876 (46.875-46.900) 1.873-1.874 (46.825-46.850) .001-.0036 (.025-.091)
Index
Page 3A-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
General
Some of the repairs in this section must be completed with engine removed from boat. Engine removal depends upon type of repair and boat design. Place engine on repair stand for major repairs. When engine removal is not required, make certain that battery cables are disconnected at the battery prior to performing any on-board engine repair procedure. Lubricate all moving parts (during reassembly) with engine oil. Apply Quicksilver Perfect Seal on threads of and under heads of cylinder head bolts and on threads of all cylinder block external bolts, screws and studs.
Engine Identification
The Mercury MerCruiser Model can be determined by looking at the last two letters of the engine code stamped into the cylinder block. This code number is stamped on all Mercury MerCruiser power packages and replacement partial engines, but not replacement cylinder block assemblies. If the engine serial number and/or model decals are missing, the engine code letters may help in determining the engine models.
a
72873
a - Location of GM Engine Code (Front Starboard Side, Near Cylinder Head Mating Surface) MCM (Sterndrive) 4.3L 4.3LH 4.3L EFI Code LJ LK LK LH Rotation
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-11
4.3
72875
Crankshaft
The crankshaft is supported in the block by four insert type bearings. Crankshaft end thrust is controlled by flanges on the No. 4 bearing. A torsional damper on the forward end of the crankshaft serves to help dampen any engine torsional vibration.
Balance Shaft
The balance shaft is located in the engine block valley directly above and parallel to the camshaft. The balance shaft extends the entire length of the engine and is supported on each end by a bearing. It is also driven by the camshaft through a helical gear set. The function of the balance shaft is to equalize the dynamic forces inherent in particular engine designs, thus minimizing engine vibration.
Index
Page 3A-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Cylinder Head
The cylinder heads are made of cast iron and have individual intake and exhaust ports for each cylinder. Stainless steel or graphite composition head gaskets are used to retard corrosion.
Valve Train
The valves and valve springs are of a heavy-duty design to withstand the high engine speeds encountered. Valve tips have been hardened to extend valve life. Exhaust valve rotators are used to help extend valve life. Hydraulic valve roller lifters ride directly on the camshaft lobes and transmit the thrust of the lobes to the push rods which in turn actuate the valves through the rocker arm. In addition to transmitting thrust of the cam lobes, the hydraulic lifters also serve to remove any clearance (lash) from the valve train to keep all parts in constant contact. The roller lifters are restrained from rotating by two retainers (restrictors) located in the valley. The valve lifters also are used to lubricate the valve train bearing surfaces.
Intake Manifold
The manifold is of the single level design for efficient fuel distribution. All passages are of approximately equal length to assure more even fuel-air mixture to the cylinders.
Lubrication System
The engine lubrication system is of the force-feed type in which oil is supplied under full pressure to the crankshaft, connecting rods, camshaft bearings and valve lifters, and is supplied under controlled volume to the push rods and rocker arms. All other moving parts are lubricated by gravity flow or splash. A positive displacement gear-type oil pump is mounted on the rear main bearing cap and is driven by an extension shaft from the distributor (which is driven by the camshaft). Oil from the bottom of the pump in the rear of the oil pan is drawn into the oil pump through an oil pickup screen and pipe assembly. If the screen should become clogged, a relief valve in the screen will open and continue to allow oil to be drawn into the system. Once the oil reaches the pump, the pump forces the oil through the lubrication system. A spring-loaded relief valve in the pump limits the maximum pump output pressure. After leaving the pump, the pressurized oil flows through a full-flow oil filter. On engines with an engine oil cooler, the oil also flows through the cooler before returning to the block. A bypass valve allows oil to bypass the filter and oil cooler should they become restricted. Some of the oil, after leaving the oil cooler and/or filter, is routed to the No. 4 crankshaft main bearing. The remainder of the oil is routed to the main oil gallery, which is located directly above the camshaft and runs the entire length of the block. From the main oil gallery, the oil is routed through individual oil passages to an annular groove in each camshaft bearing bore. Some of the oil is then used to lubricate camshaft bearings. The remainder of the oil is routed to the valve lifter oil galleries and No. 1, 2 and 3 crankshaft main bearings by means of individual oil passages which intersect with the annular grooves. The camshaft bearings have holes which align with the oil passages or annular grooves in the block and allow oil to flow in-between the bearings and the camshaft journals. The oil that is forced out the front end of the No. 1 camshaft bearing drains down onto the camshaft drive and keeps it lubricated.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-13
The oil which reaches the crankshaft main bearings is forced through a hole in the upper half of each bearing and flows in-between the bearings and the crankshaft journals. Some of the oil is then routed to the connecting rod bearings through grooves in the upper half of the crankshaft main bearings and oil passages in the crankshaft. Oil which is forced out the ends of the connecting rod bearings and crankshaft main bearings is splashed onto the camshaft, cylinder walls, pistons and piston pins, keeping them lubricated. Oil which is forced out the front end of the No. 1 crankshaft main bearing also assists in lubricating the camshaft drive. Oil which reaches the valve lifter oil galleries is forced into each hydraulic valve lifter through holes in the side of the lifter. From here, the oil is forced through the metering valve in each of the lifters (which controls the volume of oil flow) and then up through the push rods to the rocker arms. A hole in each rocker arm push rod seat allows the oil to pass through the rocker arm and lubricate the valve train bearing surfaces. After lubricating the valve train, oil drains back to the oil pan through oil return holes in the cylinder head and block. The distributor shaft and gear also is lubricated by the oil flowing through the right valve lifter oil gallery.
Bearing Failures
a
Scratched By Dirt a - Scratches b - Dirt Imbedded In Bearing Material
70436
a
70436
Index
Page 3A-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
a
Lack Of Oil a - Overlay Worn Off
70436
a
Radius Ride a - Worn Area
70436
70436
a
Improper Seating a - Bright Or Polished Sections
a
Fatigue Failure a - Craters or Pockets
70436
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-15
Piston Failures
NOTE: Engine failure due to pre ignition or detonation are beyond the control of Mercury MerCruiser. No warranty will apply to failures that occur under these conditions.
Pre-Ignition
Pre-ignition is abnormal fuel ignition, caused by combustion chamber hot spots. Control of the start of ignition is lost, as combustion pressure rises too early, causing power loss and rough running. The upward motion on the piston is opposed by the pressure rise. This can result in extensive damage to the internal parts from the high increase in combustion chamber temperature.
72424
Pre-Ignition Damage
72314
Combustion Differences a - Ignited By Hot Deposits b - Regular Ignition Spark c - Ignites Remaining Fuel d - Flame Front Collide
Index
Page 3A-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
PRE-IGNITION CAUSES
1. Hot spots in the combustion chamber from glowing deposits (due in turn to the use of improper oils and/or fuels). 2. Overheated spark plug electrodes (improper heat range or defective plug). 3. Any other protuberance in the combustion chamber, such as an overhanging piece of gasket, an improperly seated valve or any other inadequately cooled section of material which can serve as a source.
Detonation
Detonation, commonly called fuel knock, spark knock or carbon knock, is abnormal combustion of the fuel which causes the fuel to explode violently. The explosion, in turn, causes overheating or damage to the spark plugs, pistons, valves and, in severe cases, results in pre-ignition. Use of low octane gasoline is one of the most common causes of detonation. Even with high octane gasoline, detonation could occur if engine maintenance is neglected.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-17
IMPORTANT: Use of improper fuels will cause engine damage and poor performance. 1. Over-advanced ignition timing. 2. Lean fuel mixture at or near full throttle (could be caused by carburetor or leaking intake manifold). 3. Cross-firing spark plugs. 4. Excess accumulation of deposits on piston and/or combustion chamber (results in higher compression ratio). 5. Inadequate cooling of engine by deterioration of cooling system.
72425
Detonation Damage
72315
Combustion Description a - Spark Occurs b - Combustion Begins c - Combustion Continues d - Detonation Occurs
Index
Page 3A-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Engine Mounts
72316
Front Mount
72318
Rear Mount/Flywheel Housing IMPORTANT: Press rear mount out with press.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-19
Installation
1. Clean sealing surfaces on cylinder head and rocker arm cover with degreaser. 2. Place new rocker arm cover gasket in position in rocker arm cover.
a
a - Rocker Arm Cover Gasket 3. Install rocker arm cover. Torque screws to 106 lb-in. (12 Nm). 4. Install exhaust manifolds, if removed. 5. Install any items which were removed to allow removal of rocker arm covers. 6. Connect crankcase ventilation hoses to rocker arm covers. 7. Start engine and check for oil leaks.
75853
Index
Page 3A-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Intake Manifold
Removal
1. Drain engine cooling system. 2. Disconnect hoses from thermostat housing.
75847
3. Disconnect electrical leads interfering with removal. 4. Disconnect crankcase ventilation hoses from rocker arm covers. 5. Disconnect throttle cable from carburetor or throttle body.
75867
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-21
6. Remove fuel line running between fuel pump and carburetor or throttle body.
76404
a - Fuel Line 7. Remove distributor cap and mark position of rotor on distributor housing. Also, mark position of distributor housing on intake manifold. 8. Remove distributor. IMPORTANT: Do not crank engine over after distributor has been removed. 9. Remove other ignition components. 10. Remove oil sending unit. 11. Disconnect any other miscellaneous items that will prevent removal of manifold. IMPORTANT: It may be necessary to pry intake manifold away from cylinder heads and block, in next step. Use extreme care to prevent damage to sealing surfaces. 12. Remove intake manifold bolts, then remove intake manifold and carburetor assembly. NOTE: If intake manifold requires replacement, transfer all remaining parts to new manifold.
Index
Page 3A-22 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
75853
IMPORTANT: When cleaning cylinder head mating surface, do not allow gasket material to enter engine crankcase or cylinder head ports. 2. Inspect manifold for cracks or scratches. Machined surfaces must be clean and free of all marks and deep scratches or leaks may result. 3. Check intake passages for varnish buildup and other foreign material. Clean as necessary.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-23
Installation
IMPORTANT: When installing intake manifold gaskets, in next step, observe the following: Be sure to install gasket with marked side up. Both gaskets are identical. On engines with 2 barrel carburetor, remove metal insert from manifold gasket to be used on starboard (right) cylinder head to provide clearance for heat pipe on intake manifold. All Mercury MerCruiser V-6 GM engines that have automatic carburetor chokes must use an intake gasket that has an opening for the exhaust crossover port in the intake manifold. Without this opening the automatic carburetor choke will not operate properly. The choke will remain ON longer causing rough engine operation and wasted fuel.
71850
a - Exhaust Crossover Port Opening 1. Apply Quicksilver Perfect Seal to intake manifold gaskets especially around coolant passages (both sides). 2. Place gaskets on cylinder heads.
71850
Index
Page 3A-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
3. Apply a 3/16 in. (5 mm) wide bead of Quicksilver RTV Sealer to engine block as shown. Extend sealer 1/2 in. (13 mm) up on intake gaskets. IMPORTANT: DO NOT get Quicksilver RTV Sealer into oil sending unit hole at rear of engine.
a a
71850
71851
b - Oil Sending Unit Hole 4. Carefully install manifold assembly and torque bolts to 35 lb-ft (48 Nm) in sequence as shown.
5 1 4 8
a
7 3 2 6 72878
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-25
75847
76404
a - Fuel Line
Index
Page 3A-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
8. Connect crankcase ventilation hoses to rocker arm covers. 9. Install distributor. Position rotor and housing to align with marks made during removal, then install distributor cap. 10. Install other ignition components and reconnect wires. 11. Coat threads of oil pressure sending unit with Quicksilver Perfect Seal and install. 12. Connect any other items which were disconnected from manifold during removal. 13. Start engine. 14. Adjust ignition timing and carburetor. 15. Check hose connections, gaskets and seals for leaks. 16. Inspect fuel line connections for fuel leaks.
75853
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-27
75674
IMPORTANT: Place rocker arm assemblies and push rods in a rack for reassembly in their original locations.
Installation
IMPORTANT: When installing rocker arms and rocker arm balls, coat bearing surfaces of rocker arms and rocker arm balls with engine oil. 1. Install push rods in their original locations. Be sure push rods seat in lifter socket. 2. Install rocker arms, rocker arm balls and rocker arm nuts in their original locations. 3. Torque rocker arm nuts to 22 lb-ft (30 Nm). No valve adjustment is required. Valve lash is automatically set when rocker arm nuts are torqued to specification.
Index
Page 3A-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
8 9
72031
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
- Push Rod Seat Retainer - Push Rod Seat - Metering Valve - Plunger - Check Ball - Check Ball Spring - Check Ball Retainer - Plunger Spring - Lifter Body
Valve lifters are retained in position and prevented from rotating by two valve retainers, one on each side of the engine beneath the intake manifold. Care should be exercised when installing the retainers to see that the flat portions of the lifters are properly positioned into the retainers.
71853
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-29
Index
Page 3A-30 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Removal
1. Remove rocker arm covers.
75853
2. Remove intake manifold. IMPORTANT: Keep valve push rod and hydraulic lifter from each valve together as a matched set and mark or store them so they can be reinstalled in the same location later.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-31
a b
75670
a - Rocker Arm Assembly b - Push Rods NOTE: Engines with roller lifters have additional valve train components shown below.
72329
a b
72340
a - Roller Lifter Restrictor b - Roller Lifter 4. Remove lifter restrictors and lifters.
Index
Page 3A-32 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
5. Remove fasteners from lifter retainers (restrictors) and remove retainers. Do not disturb lifters at this time.
b a
71852
a - Lifter Retainer (Restrictor) b - Fasteners 6. Make matching marks on all retainers and lifters as to location and orientation in bores, to allow reassembly in exact position on camshaft lobes (so that the rollers bearing and roller will roll in the same direction on the same lobe, if reused). 7. Remove valve lifters.
76586
c a
b b
a - Roller Lifter Retainer b - Roller Lifter(s) c - Matching Marks
71853
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-33
Installation
IMPORTANT: It is recommended that the engine oil be changed and a new oil filter be installed whenever servicing valve lifters or camshaft. IMPORTANT: Before installing roller lifters, coat the roller with engine oil. If new lifters or a new camshaft have been installed, an additive containing EP lube (such as General Motors Cam and Lifter Prelube or equivalent) should be poured over camshaft lobes before installing lifters. IMPORTANT: Before installation, coat entire valve lifter with engine oil. IMPORTANT: DO NOT install used valve lifters if a new camshaft has been installed. 1. Align matching marks made prior to disassembly, and install hydraulic valve lifters and components. Torque roller lifter retainer (restrictor) plate fasteners to 12 lb-ft (16 Nm).
Index
Page 3A-34 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
c a b
b b
71853 76586
b a
71852
a - Lifter Retainer (Restrictor) b - Fasteners 2. Install intake manifold. 3. Install push rods. Ensure push rods seat in lifter socket. 4. Install rocker arms and rocker arm nuts. Torque nuts to 22 lb-ft (30 Nm). 5. Install rocker arm cover. Torque fasteners to 106 lb-in. (12 Nm). 6. Start engine and check for leaks.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-35
75853
75670
Index
Page 3A-36 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
4. Install air line adaptor tool (J-23590) in spark plug hole and apply compressed air to hold valves in place.
76572
NOTE: If compressed air is not available, piston may be brought up to TDC and used to keep valves from falling out of valve guides. IMPORTANT: Do not turn crankshaft while valve springs, retainers and locks are removed or valves will fall into cylinder. 5. Using valve spring compressor as shown, compress valve spring and remove valve locks.
b
a - Valve Spring Compressor (J-5892) b - Rocker Arm Nut
72881
6. Slowly release valve spring compressor. Remove cap, retainer or rotator, and valve spring. IMPORTANT: Keep air pressure in cylinder while springs, caps and valve locks are removed or valves will fall into cylinder.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-37
72330
e f
h g
75843
a b c d e f g h
- Valve Locks - Retainer - Rotator - Cap - Outer Spring - Valve Stem Oil Seal - Intake Valve - Exhaust Valve
1. Lubricate valve guides and valve stems with engine oil. 2. Install each valve in the port from which it was removed or to which it was fitted.
Index
Page 3A-38 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
76573
4. While compressing valve spring with valve spring compressor, install oil seal in lower groove of valve stem, making sure seal is not twisted. A light coating of oil will help prevent twisting. 5. Install valve locks (Quicksilver Needle Bearing Assembly Lubricant may be used to hold them in place) and slowly release tool, making sure locks seat properly in upper grooves of valve stem.
b
a - Valve Spring Compressor (J-5892) b - Rocker Arm Nut 6. Install push rods and rocker arm assemblies.
72881
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-39
76569
8. Install rocker arm cover. Torque to 106 lb-in. (12 Nm). 9. Install spark plug torque to 15 lb-ft (20 Nm).
Cylinder Head
Removal
1. Drain engine cooling system. 2. Remove exhaust manifolds.
75052
One Piece Exhaust Manifold Shown a - Exhaust Manifold 3. Remove intake manifold.
Index
Page 3A-40 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
75853
5. Remove rocker arm assemblies and push rods (keep in order for reassembly in their original locations).
75670
6. Remove any components attached to front or rear of cylinder head. 7. Remove spark plugs.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-41
76589
CAUTION
The head gasket may be holding cylinder head to block. Use care when prying off cylinder heads. DO NOT damage gasket surfaces. DO NOT drop cylinder heads. 9. Place cylinder head on wooden blocks to prevent damage to gasket surfaces.
76576
Index
Page 3A-42 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Installation
CAUTION
When using ribbed stainless steel head gaskets, apply a thin coating of Quicksilver Perfect Seal to both sides of gasket. Too much sealer may hold gasket away from head or block causing leakage. DO NOT use sealer on graphite composition head gaskets. 1. Place head gasket in position over dowel pins.
76588
76576
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-43
3. Coat threads of head bolts with Quicksilver Perfect Seal and install finger-tight.
76589
4. Torque cylinder heads in two steps. First pass, torque all bolts to 22 lb-ft (30 Nm). Second pass is an angle torque sequence as follows: First Pass Short Bolt Medium Bolt Long Bolt Short Bolt Second Pass (Angle Torque) Medium Bolt Long Bolt 22 lb-ft (30 Nm) + 55 Degrees + 65 Degrees + 75 Degrees
a
72883
Index
Page 3A-44 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
5. Install push rods, rocker arm assemblies and lifter restrictors in their original positions.
76567
76568
6. Torque rocker arm nuts to 22 lb-ft (30 Nm). 7. Install intake manifold. 8. Install rocker arm covers.
75853
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-45
76587
11. Install any components removed from front or rear of cylinder heads. 12. Follow procedures below for your model. Refer to SECTION 6A or 6B of this manual. Seawater Cooled Models: Provide for adequate water supply to seawater pickup (see Section 6A). Closed Cooled Models: Refill closed cooling section (see Section 6B), and provide adequate water supply to seawater pickup.
CAUTION
Ensure that cooling water supply is available before starting the engine. 13. Start engine. 14. Set timing. 15. Set idle speed. 16. Check for leaks.
Index
Page 3A-46 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
72884
a - Valve Spring Compressor (J-8062) 2. Remove all valve components. 3. Remove valves from cylinder head and place in a rack, in order, for reassembly in their original locations.
Cleaning
1. Clean push rods and rocker arm assemblies. 2. Clean carbon from valves using a wire wheel. 3. Clean gasket material from cylinder head mating surfaces. 4. Clean all carbon from combustion chambers and valve ports using carbon remover brush.
72334
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-47
72335
Inspection
1. Inspect cylinder heads for cracks in exhaust ports, water jackets, and combustion chambers (especially around spark plug holes and valve seats). Replace heads if any cracks are found. 2. Inspect cylinder head gasket surface for burrs, nicks, erosion or other damage. Also, check flatness of cylinder head gasket surface, using a machinists straight edge and feeler gauges as shown. Take measurements diagonally across head (both ways) and straight down center head. Refer to Specifications.
b
72885
a - Straight Edge b - Feeler Gauge IMPORTANT: Cylinder head-to-block gasket surface should be resurfaced if warped more than specified. When head resurfacing is required, cylinder head-to-intake manifold gasket surface on head must be milled to provide proper alignment between intake manifold and head. 3. Inspect valves for burned heads, cracked faces or damaged stems.
Index
Page 3A-48 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
IMPORTANT: Excessive valve stem to bore clearance will cause excessive oil consumption and possible valve breakage. Insufficient clearance will result in noisy and sticky valves. 4. Measure valve stem clearance as follows: a. Attach a dial indicator to cylinder head, positioning it against the valve stem and close to the valve guide. b. Holding valve head off seat about 1/16 in. (2 mm), move valve stem back and forth in direction shown. Compare stem clearance with specifications. c. If clearance exceeds specifications, it will be necessary to ream valve guides for oversized valves, as outlined under Valve Guide Bore Repair.
b c
a
a - Valve Stem b - Dial Indicator c - Valve Guide
72336
72886
Index
b a
72308
a b c
50668
Typical 3-Angle Valve Seat a - Top Angle (30) b - Seat Angle (46) c - Bottom Angle (60) d - Seat Width
Index
Page 3A-50 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Regardless of type of equipment, however, it is essential that valve guide bores be free from carbon or dirt to achieve proper centering of pilot in valve guide, ensuring concentricity.
72338
Valve Grinding
Valves that are pitted must be refaced to the proper angle. Valve stems which show excessive wear, or valves that are warped excessively, must be replaced. When a valve head which is warped excessively is refaced, a knife edge will be ground on part or all of the valve head, due to the amount of metal that must be removed to completely reface. Knife edges lead to breakage, burning, or pre-ignition due to heat localizing on this knife edge. If the edge of the valve head is less than 1/32 in. (0.8 mm) after grinding, replace the valve. Several different types of equipment are available for refacing valves. The recommendation of the manufacturer of the equipment being used should be carefully followed to attain proper results.
b
50695
a - 1/3 [.341 in] (8.16 mm) b - 1/32 [.031 in] (0.79 mm) Min
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-51
Reassembly
1. Lubricate valve guides and valve stems with engine oil. 2. Install each valve in the port from which it was removed or to which it was fitted. 3. Install valve guide seal (intake valve only) over valve stem and push down until seated against head. 4. Install quad ring over exhaust valve stem until it touches cylinder head with valve closed. IMPORTANT: The exhaust valve guide seals have been removed. They are replaced with a quad ring as shown below. If repairing heads with seals, replace them with the quad ring upon reassembly.
a
a - Quad Ring b - Valve Seal
75307
5. Set valve spring (with damper installed) and cap in place. 6. Place retainer on intake valve and/or rotator on exhaust valve. 7. While compressing valve spring with valve spring compressor, install oil seal in lower groove of valve stem, making sure seal is not twisted. A light coating of oil will help prevent twisting.
72884
Index
Page 3A-52 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
8. Install valve locks (Quicksilver Needle Bearing Assembly lube may be used to hold them in place) and slowly release tool, making sure locks seat properly in upper grooves of valve stem.
a b e
76573
a c d b
e f
h g
75843
a b c d e f g h
- Valve Locks - Retainer - Rotator - Cap - Valve Stem Oil Seal - Outer Spring - Intake Valve - Exhaust Valve
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-53
9. Check installed height of valve springs using a narrow, thin scale. Measure from spring seat to top of valve spring, as shown. If measurement exceeds specified height, install a valve spring shim and recheck. DO NOT shim valve springs to give an installed height less than the minimum specified.
05037
72339
a - Valve Spring Installed Height b - Cut Away Scale (Grind Out This Portion)
Index
Page 3A-54 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Dipstick Specifications
All Engines
FULL 1-1/16
ADD
75851
76497
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-55
Oil Pan
Removal
1. Drain crankcase oil. 2. Remove dipstick and tube. 3. Remove oil pan.
Installation
1. Clean sealing surfaces of engine block and oil pan. 2. Apply a small amount of Quicksilver RTV Sealer to joints of rear seal retainer and joints of front cover. IMPORTANT: Quicksilver RTV Sealer sets up in about 15 minutes. Be sure to complete assembly promptly.
b a
72888
a - Joints of Rear Seal Retainer b - Joints of Front Cover 3. Install oil pan gasket in position. NOTE: A one-piece oil pan gasket may be reused if it is still pliable and is not cracked, torn or otherwise damaged.
72889
a - Oil Pan Gasket 4. Install oil pan. Starting from the center and working outward in each direction, torque nuts and bolts to 18 lb-ft (25 Nm). 5. Install dipstick tube and dipstick. 6. Fill crankcase with required quantity of oil of specified viscosity. Refer to SECTION 1B - Maintenance.
Index
Page 3A-56 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Oil Pump
3 5 9 8 4 1 2 10 6
72145
7 12 11
Oil Pump Assembly 1 - Extension Shaft 2 - Shaft Coupling 3 - Pump Body 4 - Drive Gear and Shaft 5 - Idler Gear 6 - Pickup Screen and Pipe 7 - Pump Cover 8 - Pressure Regulator Valve 9 - Pressure Regulator Spring 10 - Plug 11 - Retaining Pin 12 - Screws The oil pump consists of two gears and a pressure regulator valve enclosed in a two-piece housing. Oil pump is driven by distributor shaft which is driven by a helical gear on camshaft.
Removal
1. Remove oil pan. 2. Remove gasket carefully, the one-piece gasket for the oil pan may be reused if still pliable and not cracked, torn or damaged.
a
72889
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-57
Disassembly
1. Remove pump cover. IMPORTANT: Mark gear teeth for reassembly with same teeth indexing. 2. Remove idler gear and drive gear from pump body. 3. Remove retaining pin, spring, and pressure regulator valve from pump cover. IMPORTANT: Do not remove pickup screen and pipe assembly, unless replacement is necessary. Loss of press fit condition could result in an air leak and loss of oil pressure. IMPORTANT: Do not disturb pickup screen on pipe. This is serviced as an assembly. 4. If pickup screen and pipe assembly requires replacement, mount pump in a soft-jawed vise and extract pipe from pump.
Reassembly
CAUTION
Be careful of twisting, shearing or collapsing pipe while installing in pump. Pickup screen must be parallel to oil pan bottom when oil pump is installed. If pickup screen and pipe assembly was removed, mount pump in a soft-jawed vise, apply Quicksilver Perfect Seal to end of new pipe and, using oil pump suction pipe installer (J-21882), tap the pipe in place with a hammer. IMPORTANT: Oil internal parts liberally before installation. 1. Install pressure regulator valve and related parts. 2. Install drive gear in pump body. 3. Install idler gear in pump body with smooth side of gear toward pump cover opening. Align marks made in disassembly. 4. Fill gear cavity with engine oil. 5. Install pump cover and torque attaching bolts to 106 lb-in. (12 Nm). 6. Turn extension shaft by hand to check for smooth operation.
Index
Page 3A-58 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Installation
1. Install pump, with extension shaft, to rear main bearing, aligning extension shaft with distributor drive shaft. 2. Tighten oil pump bolt to 65 lb-ft (88 Nm).
a
a - Oil Pump b - Pickup Screen and Pipe
72889
3. Install oil pan. The one-piece oil pan gasket may be reused if still pliable and not damaged.
Torsional Damper
Removal
1. Remove drive belt. 2. Remove drive pulley, then remove torsional damper retaining bolt. IMPORTANT: Do not use a universal claw type puller to remove torsional damper (in next step) as outside ring of torsional damper is bonded in rubber to the hub and use of claw type puller may break the bond. 3. Remove torsional damper with torsional damper remover and installer.
72890
a
a - Torsional Damper Remover and Installer (J-23523-E)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-59
Installation
IMPORTANT: The inertia weight section of torsional damper is assembled to the hub with a rubber type material. The installation procedure (with proper tool) must be followed or movement of the inertia weight on the hub will destroy the tuning of the torsional damper. 1. Replace key in crankshaft if it is damaged. 2. Coat seal surface of torsional damper with engine oil. 3. Install torsional damper on crankshaft, using torsional damper remover and installer as follows: b. Install appropriate end of threaded rod into crankshaft. IMPORTANT: Be sure to install threaded rod in crankshaft at least 1/2 in. (13 mm) to prevent damage to threads. c. Install plate, thrust bearing, washer and nut on rod. d. Install torsional damper on crankshaft by turning nut until it contracts.
72346
a - Torsional Damper Remover and Installer (J-23523-E) b. Remove tool from crankshaft. c. To prevent oil leakage, apply Quicksilver RTV sealant to torsional damper keyway. d. Install torsional damper bolt. Torque to 74 lb-ft (100 Nm). 4. Install drive pulley(s). Torque bolts to 35 lb-ft (48 Nm). 5. Install and adjust drive belt.
Index
Page 3A-60 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
1. Remove torsional damper. 2. Pry seal out of cover from the front with a large screwdriver, being careful not to distort front cover or damage crankshaft.
INSTALLATION
IMPORTANT: Correct rotation oil seal must be used to prevent oil leak.
73123
a
Front Seal WITHOUT Helical Grooves a - Can Be Used on Any Rotation Engine b - Seal Lip Toward Inside of Engine
73124
Front Seals WITH Helical Grooves a - MCM (LH) Rotation Engines b - Seal Lip Toward Inside of Engine c - Rotation of Crankshaft as Viewed from Front End Looking Toward Flywheel End
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-61
1. Apply Quicksilver Perfect Seal to seal retainer mating surface and apply grease to seal lips. 2. Install new seal with open end of seal inward, using crankcase front cover seal installer. Drive seal in until it just contracts. Do not use excessive force.
a
a - Crankcase Front Cover Seal Installer (J-35468) 3. Reinstall torsional damper.
72347
76577
5. Drive oil seal out of front cover (from the rear) using a punch.
Index
Page 3A-62 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Installation
IMPORTANT: Crankcase front cover is not reusable per G.M. Specification. It must be replaced if removed. 1. Install oil seal in cover with lip of seal toward inside of engine, using crankcase front cover seal installer. To prevent distortion support cover around seal area with an appropriate tool as shown.
b
72348
a - Crankcase Front Cover Seal Installer (J-35468) b - Support 2. Coat both sides of front cover gasket with Quicksilver Perfect Seal and place in position on engine. 3. Install front cover, making sure holes in cover align with dowel pins in block. Torque front cover attaching screws to 100 lb-in. (11 Nm).
76577
4. Install oil pan and torsional damper. 5. Install water circulating pump. 6. Install engine in boat. 7. Fill crankcase with engine oil.
Page 3A-63
Index
8. Follow procedures in SECTION 6A or 6B of this manual: Seawater Cooled Models: Provide for adequate water supply to seawater pickup (Refer to SECTION 6A). Closed Cooled Models: Refill closed cooling section (Refer to SECTION 6B), and provide adequate water supply to seawater pickup.
CAUTION
Ensure that cooling water supply is available before starting the engine. 9. Start engine and check for water and oil leaks.
Flywheel
Removal
1. Remove engine from boat. Refer to SECTION 2 - Removal and Installation. 2. Refer to Flywheel Housing description in this section and remove flywheel housing and related parts. 3. Remove coupler. 4. Remove flywheel.
72349
72350
Bravo Coupler
Inspection
1. Inspect splines in coupler for wear. 2. Check flywheel ring gear for worn and missing teeth.
Index
Page 3A-64 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Installation
1. Clean mating surfaces of flywheel and crankshaft. Remove any burrs. Mating surfaces must be clean bare metal. 2. Aligning dowel hole in flywheel with dowel in crankshaft, install flywheel. Torque bolts to 75 lb-ft (100 Nm). 3. Check flywheel runout as follows: a. Attach a dial indicator to engine block. b. Take readings around outer edge of flywheel. Push in on flywheel as far as it will go to remove crankshaft end play. c. Maximum runout - .008 in. (0.203 mm).
72353
a - .008 In. (0.203 mm) Max Runout IMPORTANT: Insert three rubber bumpers in Alpha coupler before installation on flywheel. a
72354
a - Rubber Bumper 4. Install drive coupler. Torque bolts to 35 lb-ft (48 Nm). 5. Install flywheel housing and related parts. Torque bolts to 30 lb-ft (41 Nm). 6. Install flywheel housing cover. Torque bolts to 80 lb-in. (9 Nm). 7. Refer to SECTION 2 Removal and Installation and install engine.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-65
Removal
Remove seal by using a screwdriver to pry it out of retainer as shown.
b a
a - Rear Seal b - Seal Retainer c - Slots (Three)
72355
Index
Page 3A-66 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
a
Rear Seal WITHOUT Helical Grooves a - Can Be Used On Any Rotation Engine b - Seal Lip Toward Inside Of Engine
73126
b c a
73127
Rear Seal WITH Helical Grooves a - MCM (LH) Rotation Engines b - Seal Lip Toward Inside Of Engine c - Rotation Of Crankshaft As Viewed From Flywheel End Looking Forward
Installation
1. Apply Quicksilver Perfect Seal to seal retainer mating surface. Apply grease to seal lips. 2. Install seal using rear main seal installer. (J-26817-A)
72356
Index
a
a - Fasteners b - Oil Seal Retainer
72464
Installation
1. Coat seal lips with clean 30W motor oil. 2. Install gasket and oil seal retainer with rear main seal. 3. Coat threads of oil seal retainer fasteners with Loctite Pipe Sealant with Teflon. 4. Install fasteners and torque to 133 lb-in.(15 Nm). 5. Install oil pan fasteners. Torque engine oil pan nuts and bolts 18 lb-ft (25 Nm). NOTE: A one-piece oil pan gasket may be reused if it is still pliable and is not damaged.
Index
Page 3A-68 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Main Bearings
IMPORTANT: Before removing main bearing caps or connecting rod caps, mark them for reassembly in their original locations. Main bearings are of the precision insert type and do not use shims for adjustment. If clearances are found to be excessive, a new bearing, both upper and lower halves, will be required. Service bearings are available in standard size and .001 in., .010 in. and .020 in. undersize. Selective fitting of both rod and main bearing inserts is necessary in production in order to obtain close tolerances. For this reason you may find one half of a standard insert with one half of a .001 in. undersize insert which will decrease the clearance .0005 in. from using a full standard bearing. IMPORTANT: If crankshaft has an undersize journal and a new bearing is required, journal must be reconditioned to accept a .010 or .020 in. undersize bearing as .009 in. undersize bearings are not available for service.
Inspection
In general, the lower half of the bearing (except No. 1 bearing) shows a greater wear and the most distress from fatigue. If, upon inspection, the lower half is suitable for use, it can be assumed that the upper half is also satisfactory. If the lower half shows evidence of wear or damage, both upper and lower halves should be replaced. Never replace one half without replacing the other half.
Checking Clearances
To obtain accurate measurements while using Plastigage, or its equivalent, engine must be out of the boat and upside down so crankshaft will rest on the upper bearings and total clearance can be measured between lower bearing and journal. To ensure the proper seating of the crankshaft, all bearing cap bolts should be at their specified torque. In addition, before to checking fit of bearings, the surface of the crankshaft journal and bearing should be wiped clean of oil. 1. With the oil pan and oil pump removed, remove bearing cap and wipe oil from journal and bearing cap to be inspected. 2. Place a piece of gauging plastic the full width of the bearing (parallel to the crankshaft) on the journal as shown.
72357
Index
3. Install the bearing cap and evenly torque the retaining bolts to specifications. Bearing cap MUST be torqued to specification in order to assure proper reading. Variations in torque affect the compression of the plastic gauge. IMPORTANT: Do not rotate the crankshaft while the gauging plastic is between the bearing and journal. 4. Remove bearing cap. The flattened gauging plastic will be found adhering to either the bearing cap or journal. 5. On the edge of the gauging plastic envelope there is a graduated scale correlated in thousandths of an inch. Without removing the gauging plastic, measure its compressed width (at the widest point) with the graduations on the gauging plastic envelope.
72358
a - Compressed Gauging Plastic b - Graduated Scale NOTE: Normally main bearing journals wear evenly and are not out of round. However, if a bearing is being fitted to an out-of-round journal (.001 in. max.), be sure to fit to the maximum diameter of the journal: If the bearing is fitted to the minimum diameter, and the journal is out of round .001 in., interference between the bearing and journal will result in rapid bearing failure. If the flattened gauging plastic tapers toward the middle or ends, there is a difference in clearance indicating taper, low spot or other irregularity of the bearing or journal. Be sure to measure the journal with a micrometer if the flattened gauging plastic indicates more than .001 in. difference. 6. If the bearing clearance is within specifications, the bearing insert is satisfactory. If the clearance is not within specifications, replace the insert. Always replace both upper and lower inserts as a unit. 7. A standard, or .001 in., undersize bearing may produce the proper clearance. If not, it will be necessary to regrind the crankshaft journal for use with the next undersize bearing. c. After selecting new bearing, recheck clearance. 8. Proceed to the next bearing. After all bearings have been checked, rotate the crankshaft to see that there is no excessive drag. When checking No. 1 main bearing, loosen accessory drive belts to prevent tapered reading with plastic gauge.
Index
Page 3A-70 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
9. Measure crankshaft end play by forcing the crankshaft to the extreme front position. Measure at the front end of the rear main bearing with a feeler gauge as shown [Specifications - .002-.006 (0.06-0.15)].
72360
Replacement
NOTE: Main bearings may be replaced with or without removing crankshaft.
c
Main Bearing Inserts a - Lower Bearing Insert (Install in Cap) b - Upper Bearing Insert (Install in Block) c - Oil Groove
72359
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-71
76580
2. Remove the main bearings from the cylinder block and main bearing caps.
76582
3. Coat bearing surfaces of new, correct size, main bearings with oil and install in the cylinder block and main bearing caps.
Index
Page 3A-72 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
76579
1. With oil pan, oil pump and spark plugs removed, remove cap on main bearing requiring replacement and remove bearing from cap. 2. Install main bearing remover/installer in oil hole in crankshaft journal. If such a tool is not available, a cotter pin may be bent, as shown, to do the job.
72622
a
a - Main Bearing Remover/Installer (J-8080) b - Cotter Pin 3. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise as viewed from the front of engine. This will roll upper bearing out of block. 4. Oil new selected size upper bearing and insert plain (un-notched) end between crankshaft and indented or notched side of block. Rotate the bearing into place and remove tool from oil hole in crankshaft journal. 5. Oil new lower bearing and install in bearing cap. 6. Install main bearing cap with arrows pointing toward front of engine. 7. Torque all main bearing caps, EXCEPT THE REAR MAIN CAP, to 75 lb-ft (102 Nm). Torque rear main bearing cap to 10-12 lb-ft (14-16 Nm); then tap end of crankshaft, first rearward then forward with a lead hammer. This will line up rear main bearing and crankshaft thrust surfaces. Torque rear main bearing cap to 75 lb-ft (102 Nm).
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-73
a
72361
a - Gauging Plastic b. Install the bearing in the connecting rod and cap. c. Install the bearing cap and evenly torque nuts to 45 lb-ft (61 Nm). IMPORTANT: Do not turn the crankshaft with the gauging plastic installed.
Index
Page 3A-74 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
d. Remove the bearing cap and using the scale on the gauging plastic envelope, measure the gauging plastic width at the widest point as shown.
72358
6. If the clearance exceeds specifications, select a new, correct size bearing and measure the clearance. NOTE: Be sure to check what size bearing is being removed in order to determine proper replacement size bearing. If clearance cannot be brought within specifications, the crankpin will have to be ground undersize. If the crankpin is already at maximum undersize, replace crankshaft. 7. Coat the bearing surface with oil, install the rod cap and torque nuts to 45 lb-ft (61 Nm). 8. When all connecting rod bearings have been installed, tap each rod lightly (parallel to the crankpin) to make sure they have clearance. 9. Measure all connecting rod side clearances between connecting rod caps as shown [Specifications - .006-.014 (0.152-0.356)].
72891
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-75
76571
76576
5. Use a ridge reamer to remove any ridge and/or deposits from upper end of cylinder bore. IMPORTANT: Before ridge and/or deposits are removed, turn crankshaft until piston is at bottom of stroke and place a cloth on top of piston to collect cuttings. After ridge and / or deposits are removed, turn crankshaft until piston is at top of stroke, then remove cloth and cuttings. 6. Mark connecting rods and bearing caps (left bank 1, 3 and 5; right bank 2, 4 and 6 from front to rear on same side as piston thrust). 7. Remove connecting rod cap and install connecting rod bolt guide (3/8-24) on bolts. Push connecting rod and piston assembly out of top of cylinder block.
Index
Page 3A-76 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
NOTE: It will be necessary to turn crankshaft slightly to disconnect and remove some connecting rod and piston assemblies.
72892
Disassembly
Disassemble piston from connecting rod using piston pin remover.
b a
d e
a b c d e - Piston Pin Remover (J-24086-B) - Arched Base - Piston - Connecting Rod - Rod Support
72893
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-77
1. Wash connecting rods in cleaning solvent and dry with compressed air. 2. Check for twisted and bent rods and inspect for nicks and cracks. Replace damaged connecting rods.
PISTONS
NOTE: Cylinder bore and taper must be within specifications before pistons can be considered for re-use. 1. Clean varnish from piston skirts with a cleaning solvent. DO NOT WIRE BRUSH ANY PART OF PISTON. Clean ring grooves with a groove cleaner and make sure oil ring holes are clean. 2. Inspect piston for damaged ring lands, skirts and pin bosses, wavy or worn ring lands, scuffed or damaged skirts and eroded areas at top of piston. 3. Inspect grooves for nicks and burrs that might cause rings to hang up. 4. Measure piston skirt and check clearance as outlined under Piston Selection. 5. Slip outer surface of a new top and second compression ring into respective piston ring groove and roll ring entirely around the groove to make sure that ring does not bind. If ring groove causes binding, remove by dressing with a fine cut file. If a distorted ring causes binding, recheck with another ring.
72894
Index
Page 3A-78 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
6. Proper clearance of piston ring in its groove is necessary for proper ring action. Therefore, when fitting new rings, clearances between ring and groove surfaces should be measured. See Specifications.
72895
PISTON PINS
1. Piston pin clearance is designed to maintain adequate clearance under all engine operating conditions. Because of this, piston and piston pin are a matched set and not serviced separately. 2. Inspect piston pin bores and piston pins for wear. Piston pin bores and piston pins must be free of varnish and scuffing when measured. Measure piston pin with a micrometer and piston pin bore with a dial bore gauge or inside micrometer. If clearance is in excess of the .001 in. (0.02 mm) wear limit, replace piston and piston pin assembly.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-79
Reassembly
PISTONS AND PISTON PINS
IMPORTANT: When reassembling pistons and connecting rods, be aware that: Piston and pin are machine fitted to each other and must remain together as a matched set. Do not intermix pistons and pins. If original pistons and/or connecting rods are being used, be sure to assemble pistons and connecting rods so they can be reinstalled in same cylinder from which they were removed. Connecting rod bearing tangs are always toward outside of cylinder block.
a
72368
a - Rod Bearing Tangs IMPORTANT: Notch in piston must be positioned facing toward the front of the engine.
72896
a - Notch
Index
Page 3A-80 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
1. Assemble piston to connecting rod using piston pin remover as shown. Follow instructions supplied with kit.
72897
a - Piston Pin Remover (J-24086-B) 2. Once assembled, check piston for freedom of movement in all directions on connecting rod; piston should move freely. If it does not, piston pin bore is tight and piston/pin assembly must be replaced. 3. If a new connecting rod has been installed, mark connecting rod and cap (on side of rod and cap with slots for connecting rod bearing tangs) with cylinder number in which it will be installed.
PISTON RINGS
All compression rings are marked on upper side of ring. When installing compression rings, make sure that marked side is toward top of piston. Oil control rings are a three-piece type, consisting of two rings and a spacer. 1. Select rings comparable in size to cylinder bore and piston size. 2. Slip compression ring in cylinder bore, then press ring down into cylinder bore about 1/4 in. (6 mm) (below ring travel). Be sure that ring is square with cylinder wall. 3. Measure gap between ends of ring with a feeler gauge as shown.
72372
4. If gap between ends of ring is below specifications, remove ring and try another for fit. 5. Fit each compression ring to cylinder in which it is going to be used. 6. Clean and inspect pistons.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-81
7. Install piston rings as follows: a. Install oil ring spacer in groove and insert anti-rotation tang in oil hole. b. Hold spacer ends together and install lower steel oil ring rail with gap properly located. c. Install upper steel oil ring rail with gap properly located. d. Flex the oil ring assembly to make sure ring is not binding. If ring groove is causing binding, remove with a fine cut file. If a distorted ring is causing binding, use a new ring. IMPORTANT: Use piston ring expander (91-24697) for compression ring installation. e. Install lower compression ring with marked side up, using ring expander. f. Install top compression ring with marked side up, using ring expander.
Installation
IMPORTANT: Cylinder bores must be clean before piston installation. Clean with a light honing, as necessary. Then clean with hot water and detergent wash. After cleaning, swab bores several times with light engine oil and clean cloth, then wipe with a clean dry cloth. 1. Lubricate connecting rod bearings and install in rods and rod caps. 2. Lightly coat pistons, rings and cylinder walls with light engine oil. 3. With bearing caps removed, install connecting rod bolt guide (3/8-24) (J-5239) on connecting rod bolts. IMPORTANT: Be sure ring gaps are properly positioned as shown.
e b c b
72373
Ring Gap Location a - Oil Ring Spacer Gap (Tang In Hole Or Slot Within Arc) b - Oil Ring Gaps c - 2nd Compression Ring Gap d - Top Compression Ring Gap e - Port Side f - Engine Front g - Starboard Side 4. Install each connecting rod and piston assembly in its respective bore. Install with connecting rod bearing tangs toward outside of cylinder block. Use piston ring compressor to compress rings. Guide connecting rod into place on crankshaft journal with connecting rod bolt guide. Use a hammer handle with light blows to install piston into bore. Hold ring compressor firmly against cylinder block until all piston rings have entered cylinder bore.
Index
Page 3A-82 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
IMPORTANT: Be sure to install new pistons in same cylinders for which they were fitted, and used pistons in same cylinder from which they were removed. Each connecting rod and bearing cap should be marked, beginning at front of engine (1, 3 and 5 in left bank and 2, 4 and 6 in right bank). Numbers on connecting rod and bearing cap must be on same side when installed in cylinder bore. If a connecting rod is ever transposed from one block or cylinder to another, new bearings should be fitted and connecting rod should be numbered to correspond with new cylinder number.
72552
a - Piston Ring Compressor (J-8037) 5. Remove connecting rod bolt guide. 6. Install bearing caps and torque nuts to 20 lb-ft (27 Nm), then tighten nuts an additional 70 degrees angular torque using a Torque Angle Gauge. 7. Check connecting rod side clearance. NOTE: If bearing replacement is required, refer to Connecting Rod Bearings. 8. Install oil pump. a. Install dipstick and oil pan. b. Install cylinder heads. c. Install intake manifold. d. Install distributor. 9. Fill crankcase with oil. Refer to SECTION 1 - Maintenance. 10. Torque rocker arm nuts to 22 lb-ft (30 Nm).
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-83
Crankshaft
Removal
1. Remove engine from boat. 2. Drain crankcase oil. 3. Remove starter.
b
a - Starter b - Mounting Bolts 4. Remove flywheel housing. 5. Remove drive coupler and flywheel.
76489
b
76490
a - Flywheel b - Bolts 6. Remove belts. 7. Remove water pump. 8. Remove crankshaft pulley and torsional damper. 9. Remove spark plugs. 10. Remove oil pan and dipstick tube. 11. Remove oil pump.
Index
Page 3A-84 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
76491
a - Timing Chain Gear Cover 13. Turn crankshaft to align timing mark with camshaft mark. 14. Remove camshaft sprocket.
76488
15. Remove rear main seal and retainer. 16. Make sure all bearing caps (main and connecting rods) are marked so they can be reinstalled in their original locations. 17. Remove connecting rod bearing caps, then push piston and rod assemblies toward heads. 18. Remove main bearing caps and carefully lift crankshaft out of cylinder block.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-85
19. If new main and/or connecting rod bearings are to be installed, remove main bearing inserts from cylinder block and bearing caps, and/or connecting rod bearing inserts from connecting rod and caps. Install new bearings following procedures outlined.
76581 76582
76579
Index
Page 3A-86 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Installation
1. If a new crankshaft is being installed, remove timing sprocket from old crankshaft and reinstall on new crankshaft as outlined. IMPORTANT: Be sure that all bearings and crankshaft journals are clean. 2. Install main bearings in engine block as follows.
c
72359
Main Bearing Inserts a - Lower Bearing Insert (Install in Cap) b - Upper Bearing Insert (Install in Block) c - Oil Groove 3. Carefully lower crankshaft into place. Be careful not to damage bearing surface. 4. Check clearance of each main bearing. If bearing clearances are satisfactory, apply engine oil to journals and bearings. 5. Install main bearing caps. Torque bolts to 75 lb-ft (102 Nm). Refer to Main Bearings when tightening rear main bearing cap. 6. Check crankshaft end play. 7. Install rear main seal retainer and seal. Torque fasteners to 133 lb-in. (15 Nm). 8. Check clearance for each connecting rod bearing. If bearing clearances are satisfactory, apply engine oil to journals and bearings. 9. Install rod caps and torque nuts to 45 lb-ft (61 Nm). 10. Reverse Steps 3 - 13 in Removal. 11. Install new oil filter. 12. Fill crankcase with oil.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-87
72899
a - Timing Marks Aligned b - Locating Pin 3. Remove camshaft sprocket and timing chain. (If sprocket does not come off easily, a light tap on the lower edge of the sprocket using a plastic mallet, should dislodge it.) 4. Remove crankshaft sprocket if it requires replacement.
CAUTION
When timing marks are aligned in this procedure, the No. 4 cylinder is on compression (TDC); therefore, if the distributor is to be installed, the rotor MUST BE positioned at the No. 4 post on the distributor cap. 2. Install timing chain on camshaft sprocket. Hold sprocket vertical with chain hanging down. Align marks on camshaft and crankshaft sprockets. IMPORTANT: Do not attempt to drive sprocket on camshaft, as welsh plug at rear of engine can be dislodged. 3. Install sprocket on camshaft. Torque bolts to 18 lb-ft (24 Nm). 4. Lubricate timing chain with engine oil. 5. Install crankcase front cover and torsional damper.
Index
Page 3A-88 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Crankshaft Sprocket
Removal
1. Remove torsional damper and crankcase front cover. 2. Remove camshaft timing chain. 3. Using crankshaft gear and sprocket puller (P/N J-5825-A), remove crankshaft sprocket.
Installation
1. Using crankshaft gear and sprocket installer, as shown, install sprocket on crankshaft.
72377
a - Crankshaft Gear and Sprocket Installer (J-5590) 2. Install timing chain. 3. Install crankcase cover and torsional damper.
72899
a - Reference Point
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-89
76577
3. Remove timing chain. 4. Insert hard wood wedge between gear teeth and remove TORX bolt retaining balance shaft driven gear. Remove gear.
72900
Index
Page 3A-90 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
5. Unscrew stud and remove balance shaft drive gear on camshaft as shown.
b a
72901
a - Stud b - Drive Gear 6. Remove two TORX bolts retaining balance shaft thrust plate. IMPORTANT: Care should be taken in next step as damage to cylinder block and/or balance shaft could result. 7. Insert pry bar in aft section between balance shaft and cylinder block. Gently apply forward pressure and remove balance shaft.
a b
c
a - Pry Bar b - Balance Shaft c - Bearing Housing
72902
NOTE: When replacing balance shaft rear bearing, place a cloth in valley to prevent any debris from entering the crankcase.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-91
8. Balance shaft rear bearing can be replaced using balance shaft removal and installer tool in conjunction with bearing puller.
b
72903
Index
Page 3A-92 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Installation
NOTE: GM shim (10229872) is placed on installer tool prior to the bearing. This will assure proper depth setting of rear bearing when installed. 1. Use balance shaft remover and installer tool along with GM shim to insert bearing.
76590
2. Lubricate bearings with engine oil and install balance shaft. 3. Using a soft face mallet, tap shaft until front bearing retaining ring seats against cylinder block.
b
a - Retaining Ring b - Cylinder Block 4. Install thrust plate and two TORX bolts. Torque to 120 lb-in. (14 Nm). 5. Install driven gear on balance shaft.
72904
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-93
6. Align marks on drive and driven gear and install drive gear on camshaft.
72905
a - Alignment Marks 7. Install bolts to retain camshaft sprocket and torque to 20 lb-ft (27 Nm). 8. Apply thread adhesive to threads of balance shaft bolt and install. 9. Insert hard wood wedge between gear teeth and torque driven gear retaining bolt to 15 lb-ft (20 Nm), then tighten bolt an additional 35 degrees angular torque using a Torque Angle Gauge.
a
72906
a - Wedge b - Driven Gear 10. Install timing chain. 11. Install crankcase front cover. 12. Install manifold.
Index
Page 3A-94 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Camshaft
Measuring Lobe Lift
NOTE: Procedure is similar to checking valve timing. If improper valve operation is indicated, measure lift of each push rod in consecutive order and record readings. 1. Remove valve mechanism. 2. Position indicator with ball socket adaptor tool on push rod. Ensuer that push rod is in lifter socket.
72907
a - Ball Socket Adaptor Tool (J-8520-1) 3. Rotate crankshaft torsional damper slowly in direction of engine rotation until lifter is on heel of cam lobe. At this point, push rod will be in its lowest position. 4. Set dial indicator on zero, then rotate balancer slowly (or attach an auxiliary starter switch and bump engine over) until push rod is in fully raised position. 5. Compare total lift, recorded from dial indicator, with Specifications. 6. Continue to rotate engine until indicator reads zero. This will be a check on accuracy of original indicator reading. 7. If camshaft readings for all lobes are within specifications, remove dial indicator assembly. 8. Install rocker arm and push rod. Torque nuts to 20 lb-ft (27 Nm).
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-95
Removal
1. Remove valve lifters.
76585
IMPORTANT: Crankcase front cover is not reusable per G.M. Specification. It must be replaced if removed. 2. Remove crankcase front cover.
76577
3. Remove camshaft as follows: a. Remove timing chain, sprocket and camshaft thrust plate.
Index
Page 3A-96 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
b. Install two 5/16-18 x 5 in. bolts in camshaft bolt holes and carefully remove camshaft as shown.
72908
Inspection
Measure camshaft bearing journals with a micrometer for out-of-round condition. If journals exceed .001 in. (0.025 mm) out-of-round, camshaft should be replaced. Also check camshaft for alignment with V-blocks and dial indicator which indicates exact amount camshaft is out of true. If out more than .002 in. (0.05 mm) (dial indicator reading) camshaft should be replaced.
72909
Installation
1. Install camshaft as follows: a. Install two 5/16-18 x 5 in. bolts in camshaft bolt holes, then lubricate camshaft journals with engine oil and install camshaft. DO NOT damage bearings. b. Lubricate camshaft lobes with General Motors Cam and Lifter Prelube or equivalent. c. Install timing chain. 2. Install crankcase front cover and valve lifters.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-97
Camshaft Bearings
Removal
Camshaft bearings can be replaced while engine is disassembled for overhaul or without complete disassembly. To replace bearings without complete disassembly, remove camshaft and crankshaft, leaving cylinder heads attached and pistons in place. Before removing crankshaft, fasten connecting rods against sides of engine so that they will not interfere while replacing camshaft bearings. 1. With camshaft and crankshaft removed, drive camshaft rear plug from cylinder block. NOTE: This procedure is based on removal of bearings from center of engine first, thus requiring a minimum amount of turns to remove all bearings. 2. Using camshaft bearing remover and installer set (J-6098-01) (with nut and thrust washer installed to end of threads), position pilot in front camshaft bearing and install puller screw through pilot. 3. Install tool with shoulder toward bearing. Ensure a sufficient amount of threads are engaged. 4. Using two wrenches, hold puller screw while turning nut. When bearing has been pulled from bore, remove tool and bearing from puller screw. 5. Remove remaining bearings (except front and rear) in same manner. You must position pilot in rear camshaft bearing to remove rear intermediate bearing.
a c b
d
a b c d - Index Point - Puller Screw - Driver - Bearing
72383
Index
Page 3A-98 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
6. Assemble driver on driver handle and remove front and rear camshaft bearings by driving toward center of cylinder block.
b
a - Driver b - Driver Handle c - Bearing (Hidden In This View)
72870
Inspection
Clean camshaft bearing bores in cylinder block with solvent and blow out with compressed air. Be sure grooves and drilled oil passages are clean.
Installation
Front and rear bearings must be installed last as pilot will not fit into bearing bores if bearings are installed. Lubricate outer surface of new camshaft bearings with engine oil to ease installation. IMPORTANT: All camshaft bearings are not the same. Be sure to install bearings in proper locations (Indicated by bearing manufacturer) and to position bearings as follows (directional references are in reference to engine in its normal operating position): Front bearing must be positioned so that oil holes are equal distance from 6 oclock position in the block. Intermediate and center bearings must be positioned so that oil holes are at the 5 oclock position (toward left side of block and at a position even with bottom of cylinder bore). Rear bearing must be positioned so that oil hole is at the 12 oclock position.
1. Installing intermediate and center bearings: a. Install nut and thrust washer all the way onto puller screw, then position pilot in front camshaft bearing bore and insert screw through pilot. b. Index center camshaft bearing, then position appropriate size remover and installer tool in bearing and thread puller screw into tool. Be sure at least 1/2 in. (13 mm) of threads are engaged. c. Using two wrenches, hold puller screw and turn nut until bearing has been pulled into position. Remove the remover and installer tool and check to ensure that oil hole(s) in bearing are positioned correctly. d. Install intermediate bearings in same manner being sure to index bearings correctly. It will be necessary to position pilot in rear camshaft bearing bore to install rear intermediate bearing.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-99
2. Installing front and rear bearings: a. Install appropriate size remover and installer tool on drive handle. b. Index front bearing (as explained in Important above), and drive it into position with tool. Check position of oil hole(s) in bearing to ensure bearing is positioned correctly. c. Install rear bearing in same manner, being sure to index bearing correctly. 3. Install a new camshaft rear plug. IMPORTANT: Plug must be installed flush to 1/32 in. (0.8 mm) deep and must be parallel with rear surface of cylinder block. 4. Install crankshaft and camshaft.
Cylinder Block
Cleaning and Inspection
1. Remove all engine components. 2. Wash cylinder block thoroughly in cleaning solvent and clean all gasket surfaces. 3. Remove oil gallery plugs and clean all oil passages. 4. Remove expansion plugs. NOTE: These plugs may be removed with a sharp punch or they may be drilled and pried out. 5. Clean and inspect water passages in cylinder block. 6. Inspect cylinder block for cracks in cylinder walls, water jacket valve lifter bores and main bearing webs.
Index
Page 3A-100 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
7. Measure cylinder walls for taper, out-of-round or excessive ridge at top of ring travel. This should be done with a dial indicator or inside micrometer. Carefully work gauge up and down cylinder to determine taper and turn it to different points around cylinder wall to determine out-of-round condition. If cylinders exceed specifications, boring and/or honing will be necessary.
a
Cylinder Measurement a - At Right Angle To Centerline Of Engine b - Parallel to Centerline Of Engine Out Of Round Equals The Difference Between red a and red b Measurement At Top Of Cylinder Bore and Measurement At Bottom Of Cylinder Bore
72385
72386 72387
8. Check cylinder head gasket surfaces for warp with a machinists straight-edge and a feeler gauge. Take measurements diagonally across surfaces (both ways) and straight down center. If surfaces are warped more than .003 in. (0.07 mm) in a 6 in. area or .007 in. (0.2 mm) overall, block must be resurfaced by an automotive machine shop.
a b
a - Machinists Straight Edge b - Feeler Gauge
72910
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-101
CYLINDER CONDITIONING
1. Performance of the following operation depends upon engine condition at time of repair. 2. If cylinder block inspection indicates that block is suitable for continued use (except for out-of-round or tapered cylinders), they can be conditioned by honing or boring. 3. If cylinders have less than .005 in. (0.127 mm) taper or wear, they can be conditioned with a hone and fitted with high limit standard size piston. A cylinder bore of more than .005 in. wear or taper may not clean up entirely when fitted to a high limit piston. To entirely clean up the bore, it will be necessary to bore for an oversize piston. If more than .005 in. taper or wear, bore and hone to smallest oversize that will permit complete resurfacing of all cylinders. 4. When pistons are being fitted and honing is not necessary, cylinder bores may be cleaned with a hot water and detergent wash. After cleaning, swab cylinder bores several times with light engine oil and a clean cloth, then wipe with a clean dry cloth.
CYLINDER BORING
1. Before using a boring bar, file off top of cylinder block to remove dirt or burrs. This is very important to prevent boring bar tilt. Boring bar tilt causes the bored cylinder wall to not be at right angles to crankshaft. 2. Measure piston to be fitted with a micrometer, measuring at center of piston skirt and at right angles to piston pin. Bore cylinder to same diameter as piston and hone to give specified clearance. NOTE: Hone cylinders as outlined under Cylinder Honing and Piston Selection, following. 3. Carefully observe instructions furnished by manufacturer of equipment being used.
CYLINDER HONING
1. Follow hone manufacturer s recommendations for use of hone and cleaning and lubrication during honing. 2. Occasionally, during the honing operation, thoroughly clean cylinder bore and check piston for correct fit in cylinder. 3. When finish-honing a cylinder bore to fit a piston, move hone up and down at a sufficient speed to obtain very fine uniform surface finish marks in a crosshatch pattern of approximately 30 degrees to cylinder bore. Finish marks should be clean but not sharp, free from imbedded particles and torn or folded metal. 4. Permanently mark piston (for cylinder to which it has been fitted) and proceed to hone cylinders and fit remaining pistons. IMPORTANT: Handle pistons with care and do not attempt to force them through cylinder until cylinder is honed to correct size, as this type piston can be distorted by careless handling. 5. Thoroughly clean cylinder bores with hot water and detergent. Scrub well with a stiff bristle brush and rinse thoroughly with hot water. It is extremely essential that a good cleaning operation be performed. If any abrasive material remains in cylinder bores, it will rapidly wear new rings and cylinder bores in addition to bearings lubricated by the contaminated oil. Swab bores several times with light engine oil on a clean cloth, then wipe with a clean dry cloth. Cylinder should not be cleaned with kerosene or gasoline. Clean remainder of cylinder block to remove excess material spread during honing operation.
Index
Page 3A-102 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
PISTON SELECTION
1. Check used piston to cylinder bore clearance as follows: a. Measure cylinder bore diameter with a telescope gauge 2-1/2 in. (64 mm) from top of cylinder bore as shown.
72386
b. Measure piston diameter at skirt across center line of piston pin as shown.
72911
c. Subtract piston diameter from cylinder bore diameter to determine piston-to-bore clearance. Determine if piston-to-bore clearance is in acceptable Specifications range. 2. If used piston is not satisfactory, determine if a new piston can be selected to fit cylinder bore within acceptable range. 3. If cylinder bore must be reconditioned, measure new piston diameter (across centerline of piston pin), then hone cylinder bore to correct clearance (preferable range). 4. Mark piston to identify cylinder for which it was fitted.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-103
72912
Typical By-Pass Valve a - Fiber Valve 4. Wipe out valve chamber in cylinder block to remove any foreign material. 5. Install by-pass valve and cylinder block adaptor to engine block. 6. Lubricate oil filter rubber seal and install hand-tight only.
Index
Page 3A-104 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
75010
Typical a - Nut 2. The outer oil line on the oil filter housing must be removed in order to install the bracket.
75010
a - Remove This Line NOTE: Oil lines must be routed under the return line to the power steering pump. Ensure that the oil lines do not rub or chafe on the exhaust manifold or engine mount.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-105
3. Place bracket over the stud and install nut. Torque nut to 12 lb-ft (16 Nm).
c
a - Bracket b - Nut c - Power Steering Return Line 4. Install bracket screw from the front side of power steering bracket.
75010
75011
a - Bracket Screw 5. Install previously removed oil line into oil filter housing. Torque fitting 20 to lb-ft (27 Nm). 6. Lightly lubricate seal on oil filter with engine oil. Install oil filter on oil filter adapter. Hand tighten only. 7. Route oil lines past engine mount. Use hose clip to retain hoses. Remove upper screw from port side engine mount. Place hose clip over screw and reinstall screw.
Index
Page 3A-106 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
8. Place the seal in adapter and lightly lubricate with engine oil. Position adaptor over engine block and install the bushing in the block. Torque bushing to 40 ft-lb (50 Nm).
d
75175
a b c d
9. Install oil lines in adapter and orientate as shown. Torque fittings to 20 lb-ft (27 Nm).
a
75163
a - Oil Lines 10. Check oil level and fill if necessary. 11. Start engine and check for oil leaks.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-107
Index
Page 3A-108 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 3A-109
STARTING SYSTEMS
ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS
Section 4A - Starting Systems
Table of Contents
Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacement Parts Warning . . . . . . . . . . General Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Starting System Components . . . . . . . . . Positive Current Flow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Battery Cable Recommendations . . . Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Charging Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . How Temperature Affects Battery Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Standard Starter Slave Solenoid . . . . . . Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Standard Type Slave Solenoid . . . . . Testing / Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Permanent Magnet - Gear Reduction (PG260F1) Starter Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . Starter Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PG260F1 Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solenoid Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4A-2 4A-2 4A-2 4A-3 4A-4 4A-4 4A-4 4A-6 4A-7 4A-7 4A-8 4A-8 4A-9 4A-9 4A-9 4A-9 4A-10 4A-10 4A-10 4A-10 4A-10 4A-11 4A-12 4A-13 Periodic Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Pinion Clearance . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Delco PG260 Starter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PG260 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . Torque Specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . PG260 Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Solenoid Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Periodic Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Motor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Armature Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Armature Bearing (Commutator End) Gear Bearing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Shaft Assembly Bearing . . . . . . . . . . . Drive End Housing Bearing . . . . . . . . Brushes and Brush Holder . . . . . . . . . 4A-13 4A-13 4A-13 4A-13 4A-16 4A-17 4A-21 4A-22 4A-23 4A-23 4A-23 4A-23 4A-23 4A-24 4A-25 4A-25 4A-26 4A-26 4A-26 4A-30 4A-31 4A-32 4A-32 4A-33 4A-33 4A-34
Page 4A-1
STARTING SYSTEMS
Identification
75820
74041
General Precautions
CAUTION
The starter motor is designed to operate under great overload and produce a high horsepower for its size. It can do this only for a short time, since considerable heat accumulates and can cause serious damage. For this reason, the cranking motor must never be used for more than 30 seconds at any one time. Cranking should not be repeated without a pause of at least 2 minutes to permit the heat to escape.
Page 4A-2
STARTING SYSTEMS
B I
h d
72929
a b c d e f g h
- Ignition Switch - 20 Amp Fuse - Neutral Safety Switch - Ground Stud - Starter Motor - Circuit Breaker - Starter Slave Solenoid - Wire Junction
Page 4A-3
STARTING SYSTEMS
Battery
Battery Cable Recommendations
IMPORTANT: Terminals must be soldered to cable ends to ensure good electrical contact. Use electrical grade (resin flux) solder only. Do not use acid flux solder as it may cause corrosion and failure. Cable Length Up to 3 - 1/2 ft (1.1m) 3-1/2 - 6 ft (1.1-1.8m) 6 ft - 7-1/2 ft (1.8-2.3m) 7-1/2 - 9-1/2 ft (2.3-2.9m) 9-1/2 - 12 ft (2.9-3.7m) 12 - 15 ft (3.7-4.6m) 15 - 19 ft (4.6-5.8m) 4 2 1 0 00 000 0000 Both positive (+) and negative () cables Cable Gauge (25 mm2) (35mm2) (50mm2) (50mm2) (70mm2) (95mm2) (120m2)
Page 4A-4
STARTING SYSTEMS
MULTIPLE EFI ENGINE BATTERY PRECAUTIONS Situation Alternators: Alternators are designed to charge the battery that supplies electrical power to the engine that the alternator is mounted on. When batteries for two different engines are connected, one alternator will supply all of the charging current for both batteries. Normally, the other engines alternator will not be required to supply any charging current. EFI Electronic Control Module (ECM): The ECM requires a stable voltage source. During multiple engine operation, an onboard electrical device may cause a sudden drain of voltage at the engines battery. The voltage may go below the ECMs minimum required voltage. Also, the alternator on the other engine may now start charging. This could cause a voltage spike in the engines electrical system. In either case, the ECM could shut off. When the voltage returns to the range that the ECM requires, the ECM will reset itself. The engine will now run normally. This ECM shut down usually happens so fast that the engine just appears to have an ignition miss. Recommendations Batteries: Boats with multi-engine EFI power packages require each engine be connected to its own battery. This ensures that the engines Electronic Control Module (ECM) has a stable voltage source. Battery Switches: Battery switches should always be positioned so each engine is running off its own battery. DO NOT operate engines with switches in BOTH or ALL position. In an emergency, another engines battery can be used to start an engine with a dead battery. Battery Isolators: Isolators can be used to charge an auxiliary battery used for powering accessories in the boat. They should not be used to charge the battery of another engine in the boat unless the type of isolator is specifically designed for this purpose. NOTE: Sure Power Industries Inc., Model 32023A meets this design specification. 1. The boat may have 2 engines connected to a single Model 32023A battery isolator. 2. The Model 32023A battery isolator is connected to 2 banks of batteries. 3. Each bank contains 2 batteries with the cranking battery for 1 engine in each bank. 4. The second battery in each bank is connected in parallel to the cranking battery. 5. The Model 32023A battery isolator is designed for this type of use; 2 battery banks, 2 charging sources, 120 amps (maximum alternator output). 6. When the engines are running, either engines alternator could be charging either bank of batteries through the Model 32023A battery isolator. Any other manufacturers battery isolator that is the same type as the Sure Power Inc., Model 32023A could also be used. Generators: The generators battery should be considered another engines battery.
Page 4A-5
STARTING SYSTEMS
Maintenance
WARNING
DO NOT use jumper cables and a booster battery to start engine. DO NOT recharge a weak battery in the boat. Remove battery and recharge in a well ventilated area away from fuel vapors, sparks or flames.
WARNING
Batteries contain acid which can cause severe burns. Avoid contact with skin, eyes and clothing. Batteries also produce hydrogen and oxygen gases when being charged. This explosive gas escapes fill/vent caps and may form an explosive atmosphere around the battery for several hours after it has been charged; sparks or flames can ignite the gas and cause an explosion which may shatter the battery and could cause blindness or other serious injury. Safety glasses and rubber gloves are recommended when handling batteries or filling electrolyte. Hydrogen gases that escape from the battery during charging are explosive. When charging batteries, be sure battery compartment, or area where batteries are located, is well vented. Battery electrolyte is a corrosive acid and should be handled with care. If electrolyte is spilled or splashed on any part of the body, immediately flush the exposed area with liberal amounts of water and obtain medical aid as soon as possible.
CAUTION
To prevent damage to the electrical system be sure to adhere to the following: w Never disconnect the battery cables while the engine is running. w w w w If a charger or booster is to be used, be sure to connect it in parallel with existing battery (positive to positive and negative to negative). When applying a booster charge to battery, disconnect both cables from battery (to prevent damage to voltage regulator). Check battery condition periodically. Make sure that battery leads are kept clean and tight.
PERIODIC INSPECTION
1. Inspect terminals for corrosion and loose connections. 2. Inspect wiring for frayed and worn insulation. 3. Check starter mounting bolts for tightness.
Page 4A-6
STARTING SYSTEMS
Testing
CAUTION
Test battery in well ventilated area as gases given off by battery are hazardous. A strong battery must be maintained. If battery shows less than 9.5 volts when under starting load, (at 80 F or 27 C) it should be recharged. Check with DC voltmeter.
9.5
a
a - Voltmeter b - Battery
b
76498
Place battery under heavy load (as during engine cranking or with a variable resistor tester) and test cell voltage while under load. Certain conditions must be met before testing. Battery must be 60 to 100F (16 to 38C). Electrolyte level must be correct in all cells. Battery must be at least half charged. No obvious defects.
1. Check voltage per manufacturers specifications. 2. If readings are low, recharge and retest. 3. If readings remain low, battery should be replaced.
Storage
1. Remove battery and clean exterior. 2. Check fluid level and fill if low. 3. Cover terminals and bolts with light coat of grease. 4. Set battery on wood or in carton; store in cool, dry place. 5. Check every 20 days for fluid level and slow charge. IMPORTANT: A discharged battery can be damaged by freezing.
Page 4A-7
STARTING SYSTEMS
Charging Guide
12 VOLT BATTERY RECOMMENDED RATE1 AND TIME FOR FULLY DISCHARGED CONDITION
Twenty Hour Rating 50 AmpereHours or less Above 50 to 75 AmpereHours Above 75 to 100 Ampere-Hours Above 100 to 150 AmpereHours Above 150 Ampere-Hours
1
5 Amps 10 Hours
40 Amps
50 Amps
To avoid damage, charging rate must be reduced or temporarily halted, if: 1. Electrolyte temperature exceeds 125 F (52 C). 2. Violent gassing or spewing of electrolyte occurs. Battery is fully charged when, over a two hour period at a low charging rate in amperes, all cells are gassing freely and no change in specific gravity occurs. For the most satisfactory charging, the lower charging rates in amperes are recommended. Full charge specific gravity is 1.260-1.280, corrected for temperature with electrolyte level at split ring.
45%
350%
74310
Page 4A-8
STARTING SYSTEMS
76517
Testing / Replacement
1. Using continuity meter, connect test leads and connect 12 volt battery with jumper leads as shown.
72630
Page 4A-9
STARTING SYSTEMS
Installation
IMPORTANT: Install special mounting shim (if equipped) between starter motor and engine block. 1. Place starter motor in position and install mounting bolts. Torque bolts to 30 lb-ft (41 Nm). 2. Connect YELLOW/RED wire to terminal S of solenoid. 3. Connect ORANGE wire, RED wire, and battery cable to large terminal of solenoid. 4. Tighten fasteners securely. 5. Coat terminals with Quicksilver Liquid Neoprene. 6. Install battery cable boot, if equipped. 7. Connect positive (+) cable to positive (+) battery terminal and tighten cable clamp. Then connect negative () cable to negative () terminal and tighten clamp.
Brush Spring Length Pinion Clearance Bearing Depth (Gear) Bearing Depth (Housing)
Length New - 0.36 - 0.42 in. (9.2 10.7 mm) Length Used - 0.18 - 0.23 in. (4.62 - 5.98 mm) 0.009 - 0.160 in. (0.23-4.06 mm) Flush - Inside .009-.017 (0.4mm) Maximum
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Starter Mounting Bolts All Other Fasteners lb-in. lb-ft 30 Nm 41
Tighten Securely
Lubricants / Sealants
Description Quicksilver 2-4-C Marine Lubricant With Teflon Quicksilver Liquid Neoprene SAE 10W Oil
Page 4A-10
STARTING SYSTEMS
Description
The Permanent Magnet Gear Reduction starter motors feature small permanent magnets mounted inside the field frame (NOTE: The actual configuration of these magnets differs between the models; the field frames with permanent magnets are not interchangeable. Otherwise, the units are similar.) These magnets take the place of current-carrying field coils mounted on iron pole pieces. Internal gear reduction, approximately 4 to 1, through planetary gears results in armature speeds in the 7000 rpm range. The armature and drive shaft are mounted on roller or ball bearings in place of bushings. The solenoid switch, plunger, return spring, and shift lever are permanently mounted in the drive housing.
CAUTION
The starter motor is designed to operate under great overload and produce a high horsepower for its size. It can do this only for a short time, since considerable heat accumulates and can cause serious damage. For this reason, the cranking motor must never be used for more than 30 seconds at any one time. Cranking should not be repeated without a pause of at least 2 minutes to permit the heat to escape.
Page 4A-11
STARTING SYSTEMS
1 2
6 7 8 9 16 10 21 22 17 18 11 12 13
5 14
19
15
75820
- Screw (2) - End Frame and Bearing - Brush With Holder - Armature - Field Frame (With Permanent Magnets) 6 - Washer 7 - Shield 8 - Planetary Gears 9 - Shaft 10 - Gear 11 - Drive 1 2 3 4 5
12 - Collar 13 - Retaining Ring 14 - Trust Collar 15 - Drive Housing 16 - Nut 17 - Solenoid 18 - Solenoid Drive Arm 19 - Screw (3) 20 - Long Screw (2) 21 - Rubber Grommet 22 - Metal Disc
Page 4A-12
STARTING SYSTEMS
Solenoid Switch
The solenoid switch can be removed and replaced if defective.
Periodic Inspection
Cranking motor and solenoid are completely enclosed in the drive housing to prevent entrance of moisture and dirt. However, periodic inspection is required as follows: 1. Inspect terminals for corrosion and loose connections. 2. Inspect wiring for frayed and worn insulation. 3. Check starter mounting bolts for tightness.
Motor
Removal
WARNING
Disconnect battery cables at battery before removing starter. 1. Disconnect battery cables from battery. 2. Disconnect wires from solenoid terminals. IMPORTANT: Some starter motors may use a special mounting shim for gaining flywheel clearance. Do not lose this shim; it will be needed when remounting starter on engine block. 3. Remove starter mounting bolts. 4. Pull starter assembly away from flywheel and remove from engine.
Disassembly
1. Remove brush lead from solenoid and long screws from end frame.
c a d
e
a b c d e - Brush Lead - Screws - Solenoid Switch - Drive Housing - Field Frame
75820
Page 4A-13
STARTING SYSTEMS
2. Remove armature and field frame from drive housing. NOTE: Permanent magnets inside field frame will be holding armature in place.
b a c
e
74270
a b c d e
- End Frame and Bearing - Screws (2) - Brush Holder - Armature - Field Frame
c b
a - Shield b - Washer c - Drive Housing
74038
Page 4A-14
STARTING SYSTEMS
4. Remove the three screws retaining the solenoid. 5. Remove solenoid from drive housing.
b a
a - Drive Housing b - Solenoid c - Screws (3) 6. Remove drive and associated parts from drive housing.
74036
a
74035
75821
a - Drive Housing b - Drive 7. Remove solenoid arm, metal disc and rubber grommet from the drive housing.
a c b
d
75821
a b c d
STARTING SYSTEMS
8. Remove thrust collar, retaining ring and collar from planetary shaft with drive.
a d c
a b c d - Thrust Collar - Retaining Ring (Inside Collar) - Collar - Planetary Shaft and Drive
75821
74087
Page 4A-16
STARTING SYSTEMS
Reassembly
1. Install gear and drive over planetary shaft.
b a
74087
Typical a - Planetary Shaft b - Gear c - Drive 2. Assemble drive on shaft assembly as follows: a. Lubricate drive end of shaft assembly with SAE 10W oil. b. Place gear over shaft. c. Slide drive assembly onto shaft with pinion facing outward. d. Slide retainer onto shaft with cupped surface facing end of shaft (away from pinion). e. Position snap ring on upper end of shaft and hold in place with block of wood. Strike wood block with hammer, thus forcing snap ring over end of shaft. Slide snap ring down into groove.
a b c
72073
Page 4A-17
STARTING SYSTEMS
f.
g. Position retainer and thrust collar next to snap ring. Then, using two pliers, grip retainer and thrust collar and squeeze until snap ring is forced into retainer.
72074
a - Retainer b - Thrust Collar c - Snap Ring 3. Install the planetary gears on planetary gear shaft assembly. 4. Install solenoid arm, metal disc and rubber grommet in the drive housing. NOTE: Solenoid arm is designed to fit only one way. Do not use force.
a b c
d
75821
a b c d
Page 4A-18
STARTING SYSTEMS
a
74035
75821
a - Drive Housing b - Drive 6. Attach solenoid arm to solenoid. Place solenoid in drive housing and tighten screws.
a
a - Drive Housing b - Solenoid c - Screw (3) 7. Install washer and shield in drive housing.
74036
c
74038
75821
Page 4A-19
STARTING SYSTEMS
8. Install field frame over armature. Align slot in field frame with rubber grommet.
a
a - Armature b - Field Frame Slot c - Rubber Grommet 9. Install field frame and end frame in drive housing. 10. Install long screws and brush lead. Tighten fasteners securely.
75821
c b
a b c d e - End Frame - Field Frame - Drive Housing - Long Screws - Brush Lead
d
75821
Page 4A-20
STARTING SYSTEMS
74041
75820
a - Brush Lead 2. Connect 12 volt battery positive (+) lead to battery terminal and negative () lead to frame. 3. Momentarily touch a jumper lead from battery terminal to switch terminal. This shifts pinion into cranking position where it will remain until battery is disconnected.
72629
4. Push pinion back toward commutator end to eliminate slack. 5. Measure distance between pinion and pinion retainer.
Page 4A-21
STARTING SYSTEMS
6. If clearance is not within limits of .010-.160 in. (0.25-4.00 mm), it may indicate excessive wear of solenoid linkage, shift lever yoke or improper assembly of shift lever mechanism. Replace worn or defective parts, since no provision is made for adjusting pinion clearance.
c
72077
Installation
IMPORTANT: Install special mounting shim (if equipped) between starter motor and engine block. 1. Place starter motor in position and install mounting bolts. Torque bolts to 30 lb-ft (41 Nm). 2. Connect YEL/RED wire to terminal S of solenoid. Connect ORG wire, RED wire, and battery cable to large terminal of solenoid. Tighten fasteners securely. Coat terminals with Quicksilver Liquid Neoprene. Install battery cable boot, if equipped. 3. Connect positive (+) cable to positive (+) battery terminal and tighten cable clamp. Then connect negative () cable to negative () terminal and tighten clamp.
Page 4A-22
STARTING SYSTEMS
Torque Specification
Fastener Location Starter Mounting Bolts Fastener Not Listed lb-in. lb-ft 30 Nm 41
Tighten Securely
NOTE: The PG260 starter cannot be rebuilt. The only replacement components available are the solenoid and drive housing.
Lubricants / Sealants
Description Quicksilver 2 4 C Marine Lubricant With Teflon Quicksilver Liquid Neoprene SAE 10W Oil Part Number 92-825407A3 92-25711--3 Obtain Locally
Description
The Delco PG260 starter motor features small permanent magnets mounted inside the field frame. These magnets take the place of current-carrying field coils mounted on iron pole pieces. Internal gear reduction, approximately 4 to 1, through planetary gears results in armature speeds in the 7000 rpm range. The armature and drive shaft are mounted on roller or ball bearings in place of bushings. The solenoid switch, plunger, return spring, and shift lever are permanently mounted in the drive housing.
CAUTION
The starter motor is designed to operate under great overload and produce a high horsepower for its size. It can do this only for a short time, since considerable heat accumulates and can cause serious damage. For this reason, the cranking motor must never be used for more than 30 seconds at any one time. Cranking should not be repeated without a pause of at least 2 minutes to permit the heat to escape.
Page 4A-23
STARTING SYSTEMS
20 1
6 7 8
9 16
17
10 11 21 12 14
18
13
15 19
Page 4A-24
STARTING SYSTEMS
1 - Screw (2) 2 - End Cap 3 - Brushes with Holder 4 - Armature 5 - Field Frame (with Permanent Magnets) 6 - Washer 7 - Shield 8 - Planetary Gears 9 - Shaft 10 - Gear 11 - Drive 12 - Collar 13 - Retaining Ring 14 - Thrust Collar 15 - Drive Housing 16 - Nut 17 - Solenoid 18 - Solenoid Drive Arm 19 - Screw (3) 20 - Thru Bolt (2) 21 - Rubber Grommet
Solenoid Switch
The solenoid switch plunger, return spring and shift lever are completely sealed and permanently mounted in the drive housing. If solenoid is defective, entire drive housing must be replaced.
Periodic Inspection
Cranking motor and solenoid are completely enclosed in the drive housing to prevent entrance of moisture and dirt. However, periodic inspection is required. 1. Inspect terminals for corrosion and loose connections. 2. Inspect wiring for frayed and worn insulation. 3. Check starter mounting bolts for tightness.
Page 4A-25
STARTING SYSTEMS
Motor
Removal
WARNING
Disconnect battery cables at battery before removing starter. 1. Disconnect battery cables from battery. 2. Disconnect wires from solenoid terminals. IMPORTANT: Some starter motors may use a special mounting shim for gaining flywheel clearance. Do not lose this shim; it will be needed when remounting starter on engine block. 3. Remove starter mounting bolts. 4. Pull starter assembly away from flywheel and remove from engine.
a
74523
Disassembly
1. Remove brush lead from solenoid and screws from end frame.
c a d
e
a b c d e - Brush Lead - Screws - Solenoid Switch - Drive Housing - Field Frame
75820
Page 4A-26
STARTING SYSTEMS
2. Remove through bolts and separate end frame from field frame and end cap.
c a
b
a - End Cap b - Through Bolt c - Drive Housing 3. Remove brush holder from end cap.
74040
a
a - Brush Holder b - End Cap c - Screws (2)
c b
74037
4. Remove armature and field frame from drive housing. 5. Pull armature out of field frame. NOTE: Permanent magnets inside field frame will be holding armature in place.
b
a - Armature b - Field Frame
74086
Page 4A-27
STARTING SYSTEMS
a
a - Shield b - Washer
74038
7. Remove the three screws retaining the solenoid. 8. Remove solenoid from drive housing.
b a
a - Drive Housing b - Solenoid c - Screws (3) 9. Remove drive and associated parts from drive housing.
74036
a
a - Drive Housing b - Drive
74035
Page 4A-28
STARTING SYSTEMS
10. Remove solenoid arm and rubber grommet from the drive housing.
a
74105
74048
74018
a - Rubber Grommet b - Solenoid c - Drive Housing 11. Remove thrust collar, retaining ring and collar from planetary shaft.
a c b
74016
a b c d
Page 4A-29
STARTING SYSTEMS
74087
Page 4A-30
STARTING SYSTEMS
Armature Tests
TEST FOR SHORTS Check armature for shorts by placing on growler and holding hack saw blade over armature core while rotating armature. If saw blade vibrates, armature is shorted. After cleaning between commutator bars, recheck. If saw blade still vibrates, replace armature.
b c
01440
a - Hacksaw Blade b - Armature Cover c - Growler TEST FOR GROUND 1. With continuity meter, place one lead on armature core or shaft and other lead on commutator. 2. If meter hand moves, armature is grounded and must be replaced.
a
a b c d - Commutator - Armature Core - Shaft - Growler
01441
Page 4A-31
STARTING SYSTEMS
b
72068
a - Universal Puller Plate b - Bearing INSTALLATION IMPORTANT: Brush holder must be installed on armature before installing armature bearing. Using the correct size driver, press on inner bearing race until it contacts shoulder of armature shaft.
Gear Bearing
REMOVAL Using the correct size driver, press bearing out of gear. INSTALLATION 1. Using the correct size driver, press bearing into gear, from direction shown, to depth specified.
72625
a - Depth - .011-.014 in. (0.28-0.38 mm) b - Installation Direction 2. Lubricate bearing and gear teeth with a small amount of Quicksilver 2-4-C Marine Lubricant with Teflon.
Page 4A-32
STARTING SYSTEMS
72070
a - Roller Bearing
a
a - Drive End Housing b - Bearing
72626
Page 4A-33
STARTING SYSTEMS
INSTALLATION 1. Using the correct size driver, press bearing into housing, from direction shown, to depth specified.
72626
a - Depth - .009-.017 in. (0.25-0.45 mm) b - Installation Direction 2. Lubricate bearing with a small amount of Quicksilver 2-4-C Marine Lubricant with Teflon.
a b
72069
a - Brush Leads b - Guide REMOVAL 1. Remove armature bearing. 2. Remove brush holder.
Page 4A-34
STARTING SYSTEMS
INSTALLATION 1. Push each brush up into its guide to allow spring to hold it in place.
a b
72072
a - Brush b - Guide c - Brush Spring 2. Place brush holder on armature and push brushes down against commutator.
72069
Page 4A-35
STARTING SYSTEMS
Page 4A-36
ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS
Section 4B - Thunderbolt V Ignition System
Table of Contents
Replacement Parts Warning . . . . . . . . . . General Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EFI System Maintenance Precautions . Thunderbolt V Ignition System . . . . . . . . Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Timing and Idle Adjustment Procedures Setting Base Ignition Timing . . . . . . . . Adjusting Idle Mixture . . . . . . . . . . . . . Spark Plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Idle Speed Spark Control . . . . . . . . . . Acceleration Spark Advance . . . . . . . Mean-Best-Timing (MBT) Spark Advance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Over-Speed Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Knock Retard Spark Control . . . . . . . Spark Plug Wires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjusting Engine Idle Speed . . . . . . . 4B-2 4B-2 4B-3 4B-4 4B-4 4B-5 4B-5 4B-5 4B-6 4B-6 4B-6 4B-6 4B-7 4B-7 4B-7 4B-8 4B-8 4B-8 4B-8 4B-9 4B-9 Circuit Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ignition Control Module . . . . . . . . . . . . Knock Control Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ignition Control System Timing Lead Thunderbolt V Spark Control Graph . . . Distributor Advance Curves . . . . . . . . . . . Distributor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation - Engine Not Disturbed . . Installation - Engine Disturbed . . . . . . Distributor Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Rotor/Sensor Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4B-10 4B-10 4B-10 4B-10 4B-11 4B-12 4B-12 4B-12 4B-13 4B-13 4B-14 4B-14 4B-15 4B-15 4B-15 4B-16 4B-16 4B-16 4B-17 4B-17 4B-17 4B-18 4B-18
4
B
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4B-1
General Precautions
CAUTION
Avoid personal injury and/or property damage. Listed below are some of the precautions, along with others listed throughout this manual, that you should observe to help ensure an accident-free maintenance experience: Always disconnect battery cables from battery BEFORE working on electrical system to prevent injury to yourself or damage to electrical system. Be sure that engine compartment is well ventilated and that no gasoline vapors are present, to avoid the possibility of fire. Be sure to keep hands, feet and clothing clear of moving parts. DO NOT touch or disconnect any ignition system parts while engine is running. DO NOT reverse battery cable connections. System is negative () ground. DO NOT disconnect battery cables while engine is running. When working on engine, spark plug holes and carburetor throat should be kept covered to prevent foreign objects from entering combustion chamber. Replace a component if there is any doubt as to the condition of the component.
WARNING
When performing the following procedure, be sure to observe the following: Be sure that engine compartment is well ventilated and that no gasoline vapors are present, to avoid the possibility of fire. Be sure to keep hands, feet and clothing clear of moving parts. DO NOT touch or disconnect any ignition system parts while engine is running. DO NOT reverse battery cable connections. System is negative () ground. DO NOT disconnect battery cables while engine is running.
Index
Page 4B-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CAUTION
Avoid damage to the EFI electrical system components: Refer to the following precautions when working on or around the EFI electrical harness, or when adding other electrical accessories: DO NOT tap accessories into engine harness. DO NOT puncture wires for testing (Probing). DO NOT reverse battery leads. DO NOT splice wires into harness. DO NOT attempt diagnostics without proper, approved Service Tools.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4B-3
6 7 8 9
10
75856
1 - Cable Kit - Ignition (Spark Plug and Coil) 2 - Boot 3 - Screw 4 - Spark Plug 5 - Cap 6 - Gasket 7 - Rotor 8 - Sensor Wheel 9 - Sensor Assembly 10 - Housing
Index
Page 4B-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4B-5
Spark Plugs
Specifications
Model Spark Plug Gap Spark Plug Type 4.3L / 4.3LH .045 in. (1.1 mm) AC-MR43LTS NGK-BPR6EFS Champion RS12YC 4.3L EFI
Removal
1. Disconnect spark plug wires (high tension leads) from spark plugs. NOTE: Use care when removing spark plug wires and boots from spark plugs. Twist the boot 1/2 turn before removing. Firmly grasp and pull on the boot to remove the wire end. 2. Remove spark plugs. NOTE: A thin-walled spark plug socket may be required.
Inspection
1. Inspect each spark plug for manufacturer and spark plug number. All plugs must be from the same manufacturer and have the same spark plug number. Refer to SECTION 1B. - Specifications for spark plug numbers. 2. Inspect each plug individually for badly worn electrodes, glazed, broken or blistered porcelain and replace where necessary.
a b c f e
a b c d e f - Porcelain Insulator - Insulator - Cracks Often Occur at This Point - Shell - Proper Gap - Side Electrode - Center Electrode (When Adjusting Gap - DO NOT Bend)
d
72734
Index
Page 4B-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Replacing
1. Clean the plug seating area on the cylinder heads. 2. Adjust spark plug gap with a round feeler gauge. Bend side electrode to adjust gap. Refer to SECTION 1B Specifications for correct spark plug gap.
a b
a - Seating Area b - Gap IMPORTANT: It is recommended that spark plugs be torqued to the amount specified. In the absence of a torque wrench or access problems to the plugs, the spark plugs should be hand tightened until the plug seats on the cylinder head. Then, securely tighten with appropriate wrench and socket. 3. Install spark plugs and torque to specifications. Refer to Torque Specifications in this section. 4. Install spark plug wires in proper order. Refer to Engine Rotation and Firing Order and/or Spark Plug Wires, following.
75084
Description
The Thunderbolt V ignition system has several spark control features that will be described following: Idle Speed Spark Control Acceleration Spark Advance Mean-Best-Timing Spark Advance Over-Speed Control (Rev-Limiter) Knock Retard Spark Control
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4B-7
Over-Speed Control
The ignition module will prevent the engine speed from exceeding a preset limit by stopping the spark. This feature has an rpm range that varies from model to model. The over-speed limit for a particular engine is set slightly higher than the top end of the rpm range for that model. For example, if the recommended range is 4600-5000 rpm, the over-speed limit would be set at 5100 rpm. When rpm reaches this limit, spark is turned-off until engine rpm drops down to a Reset rpm, which would be approximately 4750 rpm for this example. At this point, spark comes back on.
Index
Page 4B-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4B-9
Circuit Description
Refer to the circuit wiring diagram on the following page for reference to this circuit description.
This lead, when connected to an engine ground (), locks the ignition control module into the Base Timing mode.
Index
Page 4B-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
35
30
25
20
15
10
10
0 500
ENGINE R.P.M.
Index
= Base Timing Advance Curve = Idle Speed Advance Range = Knock Retard Range = Acceleration Advance Range = MBT Advance Range
Page 4B-11
35
30
25
20
15
10
500
1000
1500
2000
2500
3000
3500
4000
4500
5000
ENGINE RPM
70808-15
Distributor
Removal
1. Unplug wiring harness from ignition amplifier on distributor housing. 2. Remove distributor cap. Do not remove high tension leads unless necessary. 3. Crank engine over until timing marks line up and rotor is pointing toward No. 1 cylinder on distributor cap. 4. Mark distributor housing in reference to engine block. 5. Remove bolt and hold-down clamp and remove distributor. 6. To simplify distributor installation, do not turn crankshaft when distributor is removed from engine.
Index
Page 4B-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Disassembly
1. Remove rotor, sensor wheel and sensor. 2. Remove roll pin, washer and driven gear from distributor shaft. 3. Check for side play between shaft and distributor housing bushings. Maximum side play is .002 in. (0.05 mm). 4. Remove shaft from housing and check shaft for being bent with a dial indicator and V-blocks. Maximum runout is .002 in. (0.5 mm).
Reassembly
1. Lubricate shaft with engine oil. Install E-clip (if removed) on shaft in housing. 2. Install washer on shaft. Install original gear; slide onto shaft and install roll pin. 3. Hole may be offset and gear will only fit in one direction. 4. If installing a new gear, the gear will come drilled on one side. Slide gear onto shaft; align hole in gear with hole in shaft. Using these holes as guides, drill through other side of gear with a 3/16 in. carbide tripped drill. 5. If a new gear has only a dimple, you will have to drill through one side of the gear before you slide gear onto shaft. In most cases it is recommended to have a machine shop complete the drilling operation for new gear installation.
a b d
c
a b c d - Drill Press - 3/16 In. Carbide Tip Drill - V - Block - New Gear
72735
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4B-13
CAUTION
If timing chain has been aligned as outlined in Section 3A - Timing Chain and Sprocket, the No. 4 cylinder is on compression (TDC) and the distributor MUST BE installed with the rotor positioned at the No. 4 post on the distributor cap. Electrical timing on No. 1 spark plug remains the same as outlined following. 1. Locate No. 1 piston in firing position by either of two methods described below. a. Remove No. 1 spark plug and, with finger on plug hole, crank engine until compression is felt in No. 1 cylinder. Continue cranking until pointer lines up with timing mark on crankshaft pulley, or b. Remove rocker cover and crank engine until No. 1 intake valve closes, continuing to crank slowly until pointer lines up with timing mark on crankshaft pulley. 2. Position distributor to opening in block in normal installed attitude. 3. Position rotor to point toward No. 1 cylinder on cap (with distributor housing held in installed attitude), then turn rotor counterclockwise approximately 1/8-turn more and push distributor down to engage camshaft. It may be necessary to rotate rotor slightly until camshaft engagement is felt. 4. While pressing down firmly on distributor housing, engage starter a few times to make sure oil pump shaft is engaged. Install hold-down clamp and bolt and snug up bolt. 5. Place distributor cap in position and check that rotor lines up with terminal for No. 1 spark plug. Install cap. 6. Refer to High Tension Leads and install wires. Refer to Specifications for firing order. 7. Time ignition as outlined under Ignition Timing.
Index
Page 4B-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Distributor Cap
Removal
1. Loosen four distributor cap retaining screws. 2. Remove distributor cap.
Inspection
1. Clean cap with warm soap and water and blow off with compressed air. 2. Check cap contact for excessive burning or corrosion. Check center contact for deterioration. 3. Check cap for cracks or carbon tracks using magneto analyzer. 4. Check condition of distributor cap gasket. Replace gasket if damaged or missing. 5. If high tension leads are removed from cap refer to Spark Plug Wires in this section and the following illustrations for installation.
72981
72978
a - Vent
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4B-15
Rotor/Sensor Wheel
Removal
1. Remove distributor rotor/sensor wheel assembly from distributor shaft. Rotor and sensor wheel are secured to the shaft with Loctite. Use two flat blade screwdrivers. The screwdrivers are positioned opposite each other with the blade tips on the underside of the rotor and sensor wheel assembly. Make sure blade tips are toward distributor shaft until they come in contact with shaft. A downward push on both screwdriver handles at the same time will pry off rotor/sensor wheel assembly. The use of torch lamp will also aid in the removal of the rotor/sensor wheel assembly.
WARNING
Wear protective gloves when handling heated rotor/sensor wheel assembly to avoid severe burns.
Inspection
1. With the rotor/sensor wheel assembly removed, inspect the locating key inside the rotor. 2. The locating key will appear as a clean edged, 1/8 in. (3 mm) wide, sloped ramp at the bottom of the splined hole.
b a d
c
a b c d - Locating Key - Screws (Hex Head) - Sensor Wheel - Locating Pin
72980
3. If there is any doubt if sensor wheel is located properly, lay sensor wheel on top of the figure above with sensor fingers facing up (toward you). Line up three screw holes and locating pin hole on sensor wheel with the figure. If wheel is indexed properly all the fingers on wheel will line up with those in the figure. 4. If there are pieces of material shaved off the key or if it appears to have been damaged by being forced down while misaligned with slot in distributor shaft, the rotor must be replaced. 5. Check rotor for burned or corroded center contact. 6. Check rotor for cracks and carbon tracks using magneto analyzer and instructions supplied with analyzer.
Index
Page 4B-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
7. If rotor is damaged, replace rotor by removing three hex bolts and separating sensor wheel from rotor. Reinstall sensor wheel to new rotor making sure locating pin on rotor is installed in locating hole in sensor wheel. Tighten three hex bolts securely. 8. Bend carbon brush tang upward slightly until a distance of 1/4 in. (6.4 mm) is obtained between rotor and tang.
72979
Installation
1. Put 2 drops of Loctite 27131 into the rotor so it lands on the locating key. 2. Put 2 drops of Loctite 27131 in keyway on upper portion of distributor shaft. 3. Immediately install rotor assembly onto distributor shaft. Make sure rotor locating key is aligned with keyway in distributor shaft before pressing rotor all the way down on the shaft, until it stops, with the palm of your hand. Let Loctite cure overnight with distributor in inverted position. 4. The rotor should fit very tight. It may be necessary to heat rotor with torch lamp to properly install. It is important not to let any Loctite run down distributor shaft. Loctite could get into top distributor housing bushing. 5. Reinstall distributor cap on distributor. 6. Install spark plug wires (if removed). Refer to Spark Plug Wires in this section.
Sensor
Removal
1. Remove rotor and sensor wheel. 2. Remove two screws that hold sensor into distributor housing. 3. Remove sensor from housing.
b a
72732
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4B-17
Inspection
1. Use a magnifying glass and light to inspect the two metal jumper leads for cracks. If a crack is found in either metal jumper lead, install a new sensor.
72733
a - Jumper Leads
CAUTION
Do not use any type of silicone sealer on the inside of the distributor. Most silicone sealers give off an acidic vapor during the curing stage of the sealer. This acid can cause corrosion on the ignition components.
Installation
1. Install sensor into housing and install two retaining screws. 2. Install sensor wheel, rotor and distributor cap.
Index
Page 4B-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4B-19
Index
Page 4B-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Section 4C - Charging System
Table of Contents
General Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EFI Electrical System Precautions . . . . . Replacement Parts Warning . . . . . . . . . . Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mando . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . DelcoRemy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4C-2 4C-2 4C-2 4C-3 4C-3 4C-3 4C-4 4C-4 4C-4 4C-4 4C-5 4C-6 4C-6 Charging System Resistance . . . . . . . Circuitry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Component . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Alternator Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pulley Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Battery Isolator Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . 4C-7 4C-9 4C-10 4C-15 4C-16 4C-16 4C-16 4C-21 4C-21 4C-25 4C-26 4C-27
4
C
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-1
CHARGING SYSTEM
General Precautions
The following precautions MUST BE observed when working on the alternator system. Failure to observe these precautions may result in serious damage to the alternator or alternator system. 1. DO NOT attempt to polarize the alternator. 2. DO NOT short across or ground any of the terminals on the alternator, except as specifically instructed in the Troubleshooting Tests, following. 3. NEVER disconnect the alternator output lead or battery cables when the alternator is being driven by the engine. 4. NEVER disconnect regulator lead from alternator regulator terminal when the alternator is being driven by the engine. 5. ALWAYS remove negative () battery cable from battery before working on alternator system. 6. When installing battery, BE SURE to connect the positive (+) battery cable to the positive (+) battery terminal and the negative () (grounded) battery cable to negative () battery terminal. 7. If a charger or booster battery is to be used, BE SURE to connect it in parallel with existing battery (positive to positive; negative to negative).
Index
Page 4C-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
Identification
c
b a
Mando 55 Amp and 65 Amp Alternator (S/N 0L619083 and Below) a - Excitation Wire - PURPLE b - Sensing Wire - RED/PURPLE c - Part Number and Amperage Rating (Hidden In This View)
72078
72078
Specifications
Mando
Description 55 Amp Part Number Excitation Circuit Current Output Voltage Output Min. Brush Length 807652T 1.3 to 2.5 Volts 50 Amp. Min. 13.9 to 14.7 Volts 1/4 in. (6 mm) Specification 65 Amp 807653T 1.3 to 2.5 Volts 60 Amp. Min. 13.9 to 14.7 Volts 1/4 in. (6 mm)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-3
CHARGING SYSTEM
DelcoRemy
Description Part Number Rating Output (1300 / 2500 / 6500 Grpm) Regulator Setting Voltage Specification 862031T 12 (V) x 65 (A) 8 / 47 / 65 (A) @ 20 14.4 - 15 Volts @ 25
Tools
Description Bearing Removal and Installation Kit Universal Puller Plate Ammeter (0-100 Amp) Multimeter Part Number 91-31229A7 91-37241 Obtain Locally 91-854009A1
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location End Frame Screws Brush Setscrews Regulator Mounting Screws Regulator Leads Ground Terminal Nut Pulley Nut Alternator to Mounting Bracket Alternator Mounting Bracket Belt Tension Ground Terminal Nut (Delco 65 Amp Alternator) Pulley Nut (Delco 65 Amp Alternator) 55 70 lb-in. 55 18 42 25 25 42 35 30 See Note 5.5 95 lb-ft Nm 5.5 1.5 4.2 2.5 2.5 57 48 41
NOTE: Belt deflection is to be measured on the belt at the location that has the longest distance between two (2) pulleys. Normally this location is between the power steering pump and the belt adjustment pulley. This location will be different on engines with closed cooling or models without power steering.
Index
Page 4C-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
Description
This package uses an integral regulator charging system. The integrated circuit regulator is a solid state unit that is mounted inside the alternator to the slip ring end frames. All regulator components are enclosed in a solid mold to protect them from the heat and corrosive elements. The regulator voltage cannot be adjusted. The alternator rotor gears contain enough grease to eliminate the need for periodic lubrications. Two brushes carry current through two slip rings to the field coil mounted on the rotor. Under normal conditions, this arrangement is capable of providing long periods of attention free service. Stator windings are assembled inside a laminated core that is mounted between the alternator drive end frame and the slip ring end frame. A rectified bridge that contains six diodes is connected to the stator winding. These diodes electrically change stator AC voltage into DC voltage. This DC voltage is then transmitted to the alternator output terminal. A capacitor or condenser, mounted in the regulator, protects the rectifier bridge. This capacitor also suppresses radio noise. NOTE: There are no repair or replacement internal parts for this alternator. The alternator has to be replaced as a complete assembly. The only part that is available is the pulley.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-5
CHARGING SYSTEM
Testing
Charging System
1. Check belt condition and tension. 2. Check battery condition.
X.X
+ +
76498
3. With a fully charged battery, connect voltmeter leads directly to the battery posts. 4. Start engine and run at 1300-1500 rpm. Read voltmeter. Most systems will read 13.8-14.8 volts. NOTE: If the voltage reading is within specifications, switch voltmeter to AC volt position. There should not be more than a 0.250 AC voltage reading with the engine running. A reading more than 0.250 AC volts indicate defective diodes in the alternator. 5. If the voltmeter reading at the battery posts is below 13.5 volts, connect the voltmeter positive (+) lead to the alternator output terminal. Connect the voltmeter negative () lead to the ground terminal on the alternator. Repeat step 4.
c
X.X
+
76498
b
76533
Typical a - Output Terminal b - Ground Terminal c - Voltmeter 6. If voltmeter reading is now within specifications, there is too much resistance between the alternator and the battery. 7. If the reading is below 12.5 volts, the alternator may not be charging. Check all wiring leading to the alternator.
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
Page 4C-6
CHARGING SYSTEM
c
X.X
d +
a +
76498
b
76533
Typical a - Output Terminal b - Ground Terminal c - Voltmeter d - Battery 5. Start engine and run at 13001500 rpm. Read voltmeter. A reading of more than 0.5 volts show excessive resistance in wiring.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-7
CHARGING SYSTEM
6. Connect the voltmeter negative () lead to the alternator ground terminal. Connect voltmeter positive (+) lead to the battery negative () post.
c
X.X
d +
a +
76498
b
76533
Index
Page 4C-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
Circuitry
Perform the following tests, using a 0-20 volt DC voltmeter, to check that all of the circuits between the alternator and the other components within the alternator system are in good condition.
OUTPUT CIRCUIT
1. Ensure battery is fully charged by using the hydrometer test outlined in 4A. 2. Start engine and increase RPM to approximately 1500 rpm. 3. Check voltage reading. The voltage should read between 13.8 and 14.2 volts. If the reading is below 13.8 volts: a. Connect positive (+) voltmeter lead to alternator output post. b. Connect negative () lead to ground post on alternator. c. Wiggle engine wiring harness while observing voltmeter. Meter should indicate approximate battery voltage and should not vary. If no reading is obtained, or if reading varies, go to Resistance in this section.
e c b
Typical a - Output Wire - ORANGE b - Excitation Wire - PURPLE c - Sensing Wire - RED/PURPLE d - Voltmeter (0-20 Volts) e - Ground
72784
EXCITATION CIRCUIT
1. Connect positive (+) voltmeter lead to tie strap terminal on alternator and negative () lead to a ground terminal on alternator (Test 1). 2. Turn ignition switch to ON position and note voltmeter reading. Reading should be 1.3 to 2.5 volts. 3. If no reading is obtained, an opening exists in alternator excitation lead or in excitation circuit of regulator. Unplug PURPLE lead from regulator. Connect positive voltmeter lead to PURPLE lead and negative voltmeter leads to ground (Test 2). If voltmeter now indicates approximate battery voltage, voltage regulator is defective and must be replaced. If no voltage is indicated, check excitation circuit for loose or dirty connections or damaged wiring.
Page 4C-9
Index
CHARGING SYSTEM
SENSING CIRCUIT
1. Unplug RED/PURPLE lead from voltage regulator. 2. Connect positive (+) voltmeter lead to red/purple lead and negative () voltmeter lead to ground terminal. 3. Voltmeter should indicate battery voltage. If battery voltage is not present, check sensing circuit (red/purple lead) for loose or dirty connection or damaged wiring.
a e
b
Typical a - Output Wire - ORANGE b - Excitation Wire - PURPLE c - Sensing Wire - RED/PURPLE d - Voltmeter (0-20 Volts) e - Ground
72786
Component
ROTOR
1. Test rotor field circuit for opens, shorts or high resistance (Test 1), using an ohmmeter (set on R x1 scale), as follows:
72831
Testing Rotor Field Circuit a - Test 1 b - Test 2 a. Connect one ohmmeter lead to each slip ring.
Index
Page 4C-10
b. Ohmmeter reading should be 4.2 to 5.5 ohms with rotor at room temperature 70-80F (21-26C).
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
c. If reading is high or infinite (no meter movement), high resistance or an open exists in the field circuit. Check for poor connections between field winding leads and slip ring terminals. If cause for open or high resistance cannot be found, connect ohmmeter directly to slip ring terminals. If correct reading is now obtained, or if reading is still high or infinite, replace complete rotor assembly. d. If reading is low, a short exists in the field circuit. Inspect slip rings to be sure that they are not bent and touching outer slip ring. Also, be sure that excess solder is not shorting terminals to aft slip ring. If cause for short cannot be found, unsolder field winding leads from slip ring terminals and connect ohmmeter directly to leads. If correct reading is now obtained, or if reading is still low, slip rings and rotor field windings are shorted, and complete rotor assembly must be replaced.
d b c
a
73112
a b c d
2. Test rotor field circuit for grounds (Test 2), using an ohmmeter (set on R x1 scale) as follows: a. Connect one lead of ohmmeter to either slip ring and the other lead to rotor shaft or pole pieces. b. Meter should indicate no continuity (meter should not move). c. If continuity does exist, complete rotor assembly must be replaced. IMPORTANT: If alternator has output at low speeds, but no output at high speeds, rotor field winding may be shorting or grounding out, due to centrifugal force. Replace rotor if all other electrical components test good.
STATOR
IMPORTANT: Stator leads MUST BE disconnected from rectifier for this test. 1. Test stator for grounds (Test 1), using an ohmmeter (set on R x1 scale) as follows: a. Connect one lead of ohmmeter to one of the stator leads and the other lead to stator frame. Be sure that lead makes good contact with frame. b. Meter should indicate no continuity (meter should not move). If continuity does exist, stator is grounded and must be replaced. 2. Test for opens in stator (Test 2), using an ohmmeter (set on R x1 scale) as follows: a. Connect ohmmeter between each pair of stator windings (three different ways).
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-11
CHARGING SYSTEM
b. Continuity should be present in all three cases (meter should move). If it does not, one or more of the windings are open and stator must be replaced.
72833
Testing Stator a - Test 1 b - Test 2 3. A short in the stator is difficult to detect without special equipment, because of the low windings resistance. If all other electrical components test out good, and alternator fails to produce rated output, stator probably is shorted and should be replaced. Also, examine stator for heat discoloration, as this usually is a sure sign of a short.
NEGATIVE () RECTIFIER
IMPORTANT: Rectifier MUST BE disconnected from stator for this test.
CAUTION
DO NOT use a test instrument with more than a 12 volt source (in the following test), as rectifier may be damaged. 1. Connect one lead of an ohmmeter (set on R x1 scale) to negative () rectifier heat sink and the other lead to one of the rectifier terminals. Note the reading. 2. Reverse leads and again note reading. 3. Meter should indicate a high or infinite resistance (no meter movement) when connected one way and a low reading when connected the other. If both readings are high or infinite, rectifier is open. If both readings are low, rectifier is shorted. 4. Repeat Steps 1. through 3. for two other rectifiers in heat sink.
Index
Page 4C-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
a
a - Heat Sink b - Rectifier Terminal c - Test These Two Rectifiers In The Same Manner
72147
CAUTION
DO NOT use a test instrument with more than a 12 volt source (in the following test), as rectifier may be damaged. 1. Connect one lead of an ohmmeter (set on R x1 scale) to 1/4 in. stud on positive (+) rectifier heat sink and the other lead to one of the rectifier terminals. Note the meter reading. 2. Reverse leads and again note reading. 3. Meter should indicate a high or infinite resistance (no meter movement) when connected one way and a low reading when connected the other. If both readings are high or infinite, rectifier is open. If both readings are low, rectifier is shorted. 4. Repeat Steps 1. through 3. for two other rectifiers in heat sink.
b c
a
a - Stud b - Rectifier Terminal c - Repeat Test Between These Terminals And Stud
72834
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-13
CHARGING SYSTEM
5. Replace assembly if any one of the rectifiers is shorted or open. 6. Connect one lead of an ohmmeter (set on R x1) to the common side of the diode and the other lead to the other side, of one of the three diodes.
b a
72148
a - Common Side Of Diode Circuit Board b - Repeat Test For Two Diodes 7. Reverse leads and again note reading. 8. Meter should indicate a high or infinite resistance (no meter movement) when connected one way and a low reading when connected the other. If both readings are high or infinite, diode is open. If both readings are low, diode is shorted. 9. Repeat Steps 1. through 3. for the other two diodes. 10. Replace rectifier assembly if any one of the diodes is shorted or open.
CONDENSER
1. Using magneto analyzer and accompanying instructions, perform the following condenser tests: a. Condenser Capacity Test (must be .5 mfd). b. Condenser Short or Leakage Test. c. Condenser Series Resistance Test. 2. Replace condenser if test results are not within specifications.
Index
Page 4C-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
Exploded View
19
22
21
20
25
24
27 29 28
26 23 10 12 2 10 2 9 13 3 14 10 11 1 6 3 8
4 5
2 13 2 7
17 18
16
15
72276
1 - Screws (3) 2 - Nut (9) 3 - Flat Washer (4) 4 - Sensing Wire (RED / PUR) 5 - Excitation Wire (PUR) 6 - Cover 7 - Tie Strap 8 - Rubber Gasket 9 - Condenser 10 - Insulator 11 - Bolt (4) 12 - End Frame (Rear) 13 - Cap (2) 14 - Brush / Regulator Assembly 15 - Rectifier Assembly
16 - Flat Washer 17 - Screw 18 - Stator 19 - Rotor And Slip Ring 20 - Retaining Plate 21 - Front Bearing 22 - End Frame (Front) 23 - Screw (3) 24 - Fan Spacer 25 - Fan 26 - Pulley Spacer 27 - Pulley 28 - Lockwasher 29 - Nut
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-15
CHARGING SYSTEM
Alternator Repair
Removal
1. Disconnect negative () battery cable from battery. 2. Disconnect wiring harness from alternator. 3. Loosen serpentine belt with the adjustment pulley. 4. Turn the adjustment stud and loosen belt. Remove belt. 5. Remove alternator mounting bolt, washers and remove alternator.
c a d b
76465
Delco Alternator Shown, Mando Similar a - Serpentine Belt b - Adjustment Pulley c - Adjustment Stud d - Mounting Bolt
Disassembly
NOTE: Mando Alternator shown throughout, Delco Alternator should be replaced if it tests defective IMPORTANT: The following instructions are for complete disassembly and overhaul of the alternator. In many cases, however, complete disassembly of alternator is not required and, in those cases, it is necessary only to perform the operations required to repair or replace the faulty part. 1. Mount alternator in a vise so that rear end frame is facing you.
Index
Page 4C-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
2. Disconnect regulator leads from terminals on rear end frame. Remove four nuts, Phillips head screw and two regulator leads. Then pull regulator cover away from rear end frame.
c d a
a b c d - Regulator Leads - Nuts (4) - Phillips Head Screw - Regulator Cover
72963
3. Remove stud cover insulator, two nuts and tie strap from brush/regulator assembly. IMPORTANT: Scribe pieces during disassembly to assist in exact same positioning during reassembly. 4. Remove two brush/regulator attaching screws and remove brush/regulator assembly.
b c d a
a b c d - Screws - Brush / Regulator Assembly - Stud Cover Insulator - Tie Strap
72823
5. Scribe a mark on rear end frame, stator and front end frame to ensure proper reassembly later. 6. Remove four screws which secure end frames and stator together. IMPORTANT: DO NOT insert screwdriver blades more than 1/16 in. (1.5 mm) into openings (in next step), as stator windings may be damaged.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-17
CHARGING SYSTEM
7. Separate rear end frame and stator assembly from front end frame and rotor assembly using two thin blade screwdrivers (positioned 180 degrees apart from one another) at the locations shown. Use the two slots shown to initially separate units.
c e a d
72824
a b c d e
- DO NOT Insert Screwdriver Blades More Than 1/16 In. (1.5 mm) Into Slots. - Rear End Frame - Stator - Front End Frame - Scribe Marks
8. Place rear end frame and stator assembly on the bench with stator downward. Be sure that bench is clean and free of metal chips. Remove nuts, washers, insulators and condenser from output and ground studs. 9. Turn end frame over (stator upward) and remove one Phillips head screw which secures rectifiers to end frame.
b
72826
a - Rectifier Assembly b - Phillips Head Screw 10. Separate stator and rectifier assembly from rear end frame using screwdriver slots.
Index
Page 4C-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
11. Unsolder the three stator leads from the rectifier heat sink. Place a needle nose pliers on diode terminal between solder joint and diode body to help prevent heat damage to diodes. Unsolder joints as quickly as possible and allow diode terminal to cool before removing pliers.
72827
b
a - Heat Sink b - Stator Leads (3) IMPORTANT: With alternator disassembled to this point, stator, rectifier, diodes, and rotor may be tested, as explained under Component Testing, following. IMPORTANT: DO NOT clamp vise on rotor pole pieces when removing pulley nut (in next step), as pole pieces may be distorted. 12. Remove pulley retaining nut by clamping pulley in a vise (using an old belt or protective jaws to protect pulley) and turning nut counterclockwise with a wrench. Remove lockwasher, slide pulley and fan from shaft. If pulley is difficult to remove, it may be necessary to use a universal puller.
b a
72828
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-19
CHARGING SYSTEM
13. Remove the three phillips head screws and lockwashers which secure the front bearing retaining plate.
b
a - Phillips Head Screws and Lockwashers b - Front Bearing Retaining Plate
72829
14. Remove front bearing from front end frame using an arbor press and a suitable size mandrel. Discard bearing.
a b c
72830
a - Press b - Mandrel c - Bearing 15. If rotor slip rings or rear bearing requires replacement, entire rotor must be replaced. Parts cannot be purchased separately.
Index
Page 4C-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
g. Fan - inspect for cracked or bent fins, broken welds (bi-rotational fan only) or worn mounting hole (from fan spinning on shaft). h. Pulley - inspect pulley mounting bore end for wear. Inspect drive surface of pulley sheaves for trueness, excessive wear, grooves, pits, nicks and corrosion. Repair damaged surfaces, if possible, with a fine file and a wire brush or replace pulley, if beyond repair. Drive surfaces MUST BE perfectly true and smooth or drive belt wear will be greatly accelerated.
Reassembly
1. Install new front bearing into front end frame bearing bore using an arbor press. If necessary, use a bearing driver that contacts outer race only.
72835
a - Press b - Mandrel
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-21
CHARGING SYSTEM
2. Install front bearing retaining plate using three Phillips head screws and lockwashers.
b
72829
a - Phillips Head Screws And Lockwashers b - Front Bearing Retaining Plate 3. Slide front end frame over rotor. 4. Assemble stator to rectifier by soldering the three leads to the three rectifier terminals.
72826
a - Stator Lead Connections NOTE: Be sure to connect leads to their original positions. 5. Install assembled stator and rectifier assembly into rear end frame, aligning scribe marks on each (scribed during disassembly), and install Phillips head screw and washer to retain. IMPORTANT: The insulating washers MUST BE installed as shown or damage to the alternator will result. 6. Position stator down with rear end frame up and reinstall insulators, nuts and condenser.
c b a
72561
Index
Page 4C-22
CHARGING SYSTEM
7. Position rear end frame and stator assembly over front end frame and rotor assembly and align scribe marks on each (scribed during disassembly). Hand-press end frames together, then install four screws. Tighten screws securely.
e d c b
72561
a b c d e
- Rear End Frame - Stator - Front End Frame - Scribe Marks - Insert Screws (4) (Two Hidden)
8. Depress brushes flush with top of brush holder and insert a #54,.050 in. (1 mm) drill bit or smaller into hole in brush holder to hold brushes compressed during reassembly.
a
a - Drill Bit NOTE: Rubber gasket shown removed for clarity.
72836
9. Install brush/regulator assembly in rear end frame cavity and secure with two mounting screws, as shown. Tighten screws securely. Remove drill bit to release brushes against slip rings.
b
72837
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-23
CHARGING SYSTEM
10. Install tie bar to rectifier stud and stud on brush/rectifier assembly. Tighten nuts securely.
b a
a - Studs b - Tie Bar 11. Install cover with one phillips head screw and two nuts. Install two leads with nuts.
72823
72963
c
a - Phillips Head Screw b - Nuts (4) c - Leads 12. Install insulator caps.
a
72078
a - Insulator Caps
Index
Page 4C-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
Installation
1. Position alternator in mounting bracket and install mounting bolts. Torque to 35 lb-ft (48 Nm).
a
Typical Models a - Bracket b - Bolts
75713
2. Position alternator drive belt on pulleys and adjust tension as explained under Drive Belt Tension Adjustment, preceding. 3. Reconnect wiring harness to alternator.
d c b a
a b c d - Excitation Lead -(PURPLE) - Sensing Lead - (RED / PURPLE) - Ground Lead - (BLACK) - Output Lead - (ORANGE)
72838
76093
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-25
CHARGING SYSTEM
Pulley Removal
1. Remove serpentine belt. 2. Clamp pulley in a vise (using an old belt or protective jaws to protect pulley) to remove nut.
72828
a - Old Belt to Protect Pulley 3. Slide components off of alternator shaft. 4. Install components and pulley on alternator shaft. 5. Torque pulley adjustment nut to specifications.
Index
Page 4C-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
h
B2 A B1
d
1
d f
f g e
72934
a b c d e f g h
- Circuit Breaker - Harness Connector - Alternator - Starter - Cranking Battery - Ground Stud - Auxiliary Battery - Isolator
1 - Disconnect Orange Wire From Alternator Battery Terminal. Splice Sufficient Gauge Wire To The Orange Wire And Connect As Shown. 2 - 8 Gauge Minimum
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-27
CHARGING SYSTEM
Index
Page 4C-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CHARGING SYSTEM
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4C-29
CHARGING SYSTEM
Index
Page 4C-30 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
ELECTRICAL SYSTEM
Section 4D - Instrumentation
Table of Contents
Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Special Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lighting Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil, Fuel and Temperature . . . . . . . . . Battery Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cruiselog Meter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gauge Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4D-2 4D-2 4D-2 4D-3 4D-3 4D-5 4D-5 4D-6 4D-7 4D-7 4D-8 4D-8 4D-8 Senders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Tank Sender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ignition Key Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lanyard Stop Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Start/Stop Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Audio Warning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Buzzer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Oil Pressure Switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Temperature Switch . . . . . . . . . 4D-9 4D-9 4D-10 4D-13 4D-16 4D-16 4D-17 4D-17 4D-19 4D-20 4D-20 4D-21 4D-21
4
D
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-1
INSTRUMENTATION
Tools
Description Voltmeter Ohmmeter Service Tachometer Continuity Meter Obtain Locally Part Number
Identification
NOTE: One of three distinct lines (Series) of Quicksilver gauges may be installed (if equipped with Quicksilver gauges). Aside from different gauge face appearances and styling, the back of the gauges and wiring connections are different as shown.
72746
72965
index
Page 4D-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
Special Information
Lighting Options
COMMODORE AND INTERNATIONAL SERIES
These gauges may be wired so that the illumination lighting is provided from the ignition switch or a separate instrumentation lighting switch. By removing contact strip I from between + terminal and the screw as shown following, and supplying a separate +12 V power supply to the screw connection, illumination lights can be operated independent of ignition switch.
a
Ignition Switch Lighting Circuit a - Positive (+) 12 Volt Power Supply From Ignition Switch b - Contact Strip I c - Screw Connection
72966
b
Separate Instrumentation Lighting Circuit Wiring a - Positive (+) 12 Volt Power Supply From Ignition Switch b - Contact Strip I c - Screw Connection
72967
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-3
INSTRUMENTATION
QSI SERIES
These gauges are equipped with optional illumination lighting. Light bulb socket can be removed and contacts can be aligned to be used with ignition switch lighting circuit +12 V or separate instrumentation lighting circuit LT. IMPORTANT: Light socket must be removed from gauge and turned counterclockwise (facing back of gauge) when adjusting to desired setting. Turning socket while still installed in gauge could result in damage to gauge or socket. NOTE: For different lighting effects, colored sleeves are available through the Quicksilver Accessories and can be assembled to the bulb.
a
72968
Ignition Switch Lighting Circuit Position a - Positive (+) 12 Volt Power Supply From Ignition Switch
a
72969
Separate Instrumentation Lighting Circuit Position a - Positive (+) 12 Volt Power Supply From Ignition b - Positive (+) 12 Volt Power Supply From Separate Instrumentation Lighting Circuit
index
Page 4D-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
Gauges
Oil, Fuel and Temperature
IMPORTANT: If testing proves gauge to be defective, it must be replaced as there is no repair available.
TESTING
1. Turn ignition switch to OFF. 2. Remove wire from terminal S (SEND).
a
Typical a - Terminal S (SEND) 3. Turn ignition switch to RUN. Gauge being tested must be at position A.
72965
72747
Position A (Typical) 4. Turn ignition switch to OFF. 5. Connect jumper wire from terminal G (GND) to terminal S (SEND).
72748
index
Typical
Page 4D-5
INSTRUMENTATION
6. Turn ignition switch to RUN. 7. Indicator needle of gauge being tested must read at position B. If not, replace gauge.
72749
Position B (Typical)
Battery Gauge
TESTING
1. Remove cables from battery and fully charge battery. 2. Connect negative () jumper lead from battery to gauge terminal G (GND). 3. Connect positive (+) jumper lead from battery to gauge terminal I or +12 V.
72750
72751
Typical
index
Page 4D-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
Cruiselog Meter
TESTING
1. Connect jumper wire from positive (+) battery terminal to positive (+) gauge terminal. 2. Connect jumper wire from negative () battery terminal to negative () gauge terminal.
72752
3. Observe gauge run indicator. If indicator is turning, gauge is operable. If not, replace gauge.
a
72753
a - Indicator
Vacuum Gauge
TESTING
1. Disconnect vacuum hose from engine. Connect service vacuum gauge to engine and record engine vacuum readings at idle, 1000, 2000 and 3000 rpm. Reconnect vacuum hose and compare vacuum gauge readings (at specified rpm) with service gauge readings. Readings should be within 3 inches of vacuum of each other. IMPORTANT: Make sure that vacuum hose between gauge and engine is not leaking and that all connections are tight. 2. If gauge readings are not within specifications, gauge is defective.
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-7
INSTRUMENTATION
Speedometer
TESTING
IMPORTANT: When testing speedometer gauge for accuracy, the air supply used for the test must be regulated to the specified air pressure. Do not apply excessive air pressure to speedometer gauge. 1. Apply air pressure directly to speedometer gauge (specified in chart) and note gauge reading. Light tapping of pressure gauge is required during accuracy check. 2. If gauge readings are not within specifications, gauge is defective.
CALIBRATION CHART
Air Pressure Gauge psi 5.3 27.8 Speedometer Gauge MPH (km/Hr) 202 (321.6) 451 (721.6)
Tachometer
TESTING
1. Connect a service tachometer to engine and compare readings. 2. Replace if not within specifications. Tachometer 6000 rpm 8000 rpm Allowance 150 rpm 200 rpm
Gauge Replacement
1. Disconnect battery cables from battery. 2. Remove wires from back of gauge. 3. Remove hoses (vacuum, speedometer gauge). 4. Disconnect light socket. 5. Remove holding strap and remove gauge. 6. Position gauge assembly in appropriate mounting hole. 7. Install holding strap and nuts. Tighten nuts evenly and securely. IMPORTANT: Do not distort case or bracket by overtightening. 8. Connect ground (BLK) wire to ground terminal, if gauge is not mounted in metal panel. 9. Connect other wires to gauge as shown in SECTION 4E. 10. Connect hoses (vacuum, speedometer gauges). 11. Install gauge light socket. 12. Coat all terminals with Quicksilver Liquid Neoprene. 13. Reconnect battery cables to battery.
index
Page 4D-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
Senders
Oil Pressure
TESTING
IMPORTANT: Use following test procedure for checking accuracy of oil pressure sender only. If oil pressure gauge indicates zero oil pressure, refer to SECTION 1C Troubleshooting. 1. Remove wire from sender terminal. 2. Connect ohmmeter between sender terminal and sender case. Check ohms reading without engine running (zero pressure), then check reading with engine running. Compare oil pressure and ohms readings as shown in following chart:
d c b
a
72754
a b c d
Ohms Reading Single 227-257 142-162.5 91.7-113.6 9-49 Dual 113.5-128.5 71-81.25 45.8-56.8 4.5-24.5
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-9
INSTRUMENTATION
Water Temperature
REMOVAL
1. Drain coolant from closed cooling system into a suitable container as outlined in SECTION 6B. 2. Remove TAN wire from temperature sender.
a
a - TAN Wire b - Water Temperature Sender
b
75846
TESTING
1. Connect an ohmmeter between temperature sender terminal (+) and hex (case) for ground () as shown.
b
72768
index
Page 4D-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
WARNING
The following test involves the use of intense heat. Failure to follow appropriate procedures or warnings can cause burns which can result in severe personal injury. While performing the following test, observe these general precautions: Wear personal protective clothing such as rubber gloves, a non-flammable apron, and eye protection - preferably full face shield or safety glasses. The appropriate heat source should only be electric. Heat source should be operated by a qualified person. Be sure to follow all instructions of the manufacturer of the heat source. The heat source should be checked each time it is used to be sure it is functioning properly. The thermometer used in the test should be a high-temperature thermometer with a maximum reading of at least 300F (150C). Under no circumstances should the operator allow temperatures to exceed test specifications. Perform test only in a well ventilated area. Use a suitable container, such as metal, to hold the water. Avoid use of glass containers unless the operator first confirms for himself/herself that the glass container is an appropriate high-temperature vessel. Because the components will reach high temperatures DO NOT handle materials or components until COMPLETELY cooled.
2. Follow these instructions: a. With ohmmeter connected as outlined and using suitable container, thermometer and heat source, suspend sender with tip in water. b. Heat water and observe thermometer. c. As temperature rises ohmmeter readings must be within the ranges specified for each temperature (see chart below).
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-11
INSTRUMENTATION
d. Turn heat source off. Allow water and components to cool. NOTE: While water cools you may recheck ohmmeter readings.
e d b
a c
72769
a b c d e
3. Replace sender if ohmmeter readings are other than as shown for each temperature.
index
Page 4D-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Loctite Pipe Sealant with Teflon to threads of temperature sender. 2. Install sender in thermostat housing and tighten securely.
a
a - TAN Wire b - Water Temperature Sender
b
75846
3. Connect tan wire and coat with Liquid Neoprene. 4. Refill closed cooling system with approved coolant as outlined in SECTION 6B.
b
a - Ohmmeter Leads b - Vertical Float Arm
72755
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-13
INSTRUMENTATION
5. With float arm in EMPTY position (arm vertical) meter should read 240 ohms (+ 5 ohms). Sender is defective if not within specifications.
72756
CAPSULE TYPE
Testing 1. Disconnect wire from terminal on fuel tank capsule. 2. Remove two screws and remove capsule assembly. 3. Place a magnet under fuel capsule. 4. Connect ohmmeter between fuel capsule terminal and metal portion of capsule housing.
b c
a - Ohmmeter Leads b - Capsule Assembly c - Magnet
72757
index
Page 4D-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
5. Turn magnet counterclockwise until fuel capsule indicator reads EMPTY. Ohmmeter should read 240 ohms (+ 5 ohms).
72758
a - Capsule Reading Empty 6. Turn magnet clockwise until fuel capsule indicator reads FULL. Ohmmeter should read 30 ohms (+ 5 ohms). Fuel capsule is defective if not within specifications.
72759
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-15
INSTRUMENTATION
Switches
Ignition Key Switch
TESTING
CAUTION
Disconnect battery cables from battery before testing ignition key switch with wires still connected to switch. 1. Disconnect battery cables, if testing ignition key switch with wires connected to switch. 2. With key switch in OFF position, there should be no continuity between switch terminals. 3. With key switch in RUN position, continuity will exist between switch terminals B to I. There should no continuity between terminal S and any other terminals. 4. With key switch in START, continuity will exist between terminals B to I and B to S. 5. Terminals are to make contact at angles shown and to stay in contact condition as switch is rotated toward START. 6. If ignition key switch tests bad, disconnect wire connections and remove switch. Test switch again, as in Steps 2-5, preceding. If switch tests good, wiring in harness is bad, There should be no continuity between any harness wires with key switch removed.
f e d c a b
B S I
72760
Key View a b c d e f - Key - Off - Continuity, B to I Terminals - Run - Continuity B to S Terminals - Start
Back View
index
Page 4D-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
b a
74061
Remote Control Mounted Style Switch Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI) Engines a - Switch Lanyard b - Leads (BLK/YEL) 1. Disconnect switch leads. 2. Test switch as follows. a. Connect an ohmmeter to leads. b. There should be no continuity with switch lanyard connected and continuity with switch lanyard disconnected.
74062
index
Remote Control Mounted Style Switch Carbureted Engines a - Switch Leads b - Leads (PUR)
Page 4D-17
INSTRUMENTATION
3. Disconnect switch leads. 4. Test switch as follows: a. Connect an ohmmeter to leads. b. There should be continuity with switch lanyard connected and no continuity with switch lanyard disconnected.
a b
72762
Toggle Style Switch a - Switch Cap b - Switch IMPORTANT: The BLK/YEL lead is not used. It should be well insulated and taped to harness. 5. Disconnect switch leads. 6. Connect an ohmmeter to switch leads. 7. Switch should have continuity with toggle in the RUN position and no continuity with toggle in the OFF position.
index
Page 4D-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
Start/Stop Switch
TESTING
WARNING
Disconnect battery leads at battery before testing. 1. Disconnect battery leads. 2. Check for continuity between the terminals on the start switch with a continuity meter.
72763
3. No continuity should exist. 4. Depress switch button and continuity should exist. 5. Check stop switch in the same manner. 6. If continuity exists when in the OPEN (not depressed) state, replace panel button.
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-19
INSTRUMENTATION
Buzzer
WARNING
The following test involves the use of electricity. Failure to follow appropriate procedures can cause burns or shock which can result in severe personal injury or death.
TESTING
1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON position without cranking the engine. The horn will sound if the system is working correctly. 2. If horn does not sound: a. Connect jumper wires as shown. b. If horn does not sound, replace it. 3. If horn worked in Step 3: a. Connect jumper wires as shown. b. Repeat Step 2. c. If horn sounds, problem is in TAN/BLUE wire back to engine or switches on engine.
74046
index
Page 4D-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
72764
3. With engine not running, meter should indicate full continuity. 4. Start engine. With engine running and engine oil pressure above 6 psi (41 kPa), meter should indicate no continuity.
b
72611
Seawater Cooled Model Shown, Closed Cooled Similar Location a - TAN Wire b - Water Temperature Switch 3. Remove switch.
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-21
INSTRUMENTATION
TESTING
1. Connect an ohmmeter between water temperature switch terminal (+) and hex (case) for ground () as shown.
b a
72765
WARNING
The following test involves the use of intense heat. Failure to follow appropriate procedures or warnings can cause burns which can result in severe personal injury. While performing the following test, observe these general precautions: Wear personal protective clothing such as rubber gloves, a non-flammable apron, and eye protection - preferably full face shield or safety glasses. The appropriate heat source should only be electric. Heat source should be operated by a qualified person. Be sure to follow all instructions of the manufacturer of the heat source. The heat source should be checked each time it is used to be sure it is functioning properly. The thermometer used in the test should be a high- temperature thermometer with a maximum reading of at least 300F (150C). Under no circumstances should the operator allow temperatures to exceed test specifications. Perform test only in a well ventilated area. Use a suitable container, such as metal, to hold the sand. Avoid use of glass containers unless the operator first confirms for himself/herself that the glass container is an appropriate high-temperature vessel. Because the components will reach high temperatures DO NOT handle materials or components until COMPLETELY cooled.
WARNING
Use only clean, dry sand such as used for general sandblasting purposes. Use of sand containing contaminants could result in hazards such as fire, short circuiting, hot-spots, or other hazards. 3. With an ohmmeter connected as outlined and using suitable container, thermometer and heat source, suspend sender with tip in sand.
index
Page 4D-22 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
e d
a c
72766
a b c d e
- Suitable Container - Thermometer - Heat Source - Water Temperature Switch - Ohmmeter Leads
5. As temperature rises, switch will close and ohmmeter will indicate continuity. Refer to chart below for specifications. Coolant Temperature Switch Opens 48952 Switch 87-86080 Switch 150-170F (66-77C) 175-195F (79-91C) Closes 190-200F (88-93C) 215-225F (102-107C)
72767
Switch Identification a - 48952 Switch With Red Mylar Sleeve b - 87-86080 Switch With Black Mylar Sleeve 6. Turn heat source off. Allow sand to cool. Note thermometer reading to ensure switch opens up at specified temperature. 7. Replace switch if switch fails to either open or close within the specified temperatures.
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-23
INSTRUMENTATION
INSTALLATION
1. Apply Loctite Pipe Sealant with Teflon to threads of water temperature switch. 2. Install switch in thermostat housing and tighten securely. 3. Connect TAN wire and coat connection with Liquid Neoprene.
b
72611
Seawater Cooled Model Shown, Closed Cooled Similar Location a - TAN Wire b - Water Temperature Switch 4. If equipped with closed cooling, refill closed cooling system with approved coolant. Refer to SECTION 6.
index
Page 4D-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTRUMENTATION
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4D-25
INSTRUMENTATION
index
Page 4D-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
ELECTRICAL SYSTEMS
Section 4E - Wiring Diagrams
Table of Contents
Wiring Colors for Mercury MerCruiser . . MCM Gasoline Engine Wiring Diagrams Starting and Charging Harness . . . . . Fuel and Ignition System Harnesses Quicksilver Instrumentation . . . . . . . . Dual Station Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4E-2 4E-4 4E-4 4E-16 4E-22 4E-24
4
E
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-1
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Index
Page 4E-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-3
WIRING DIAGRAMS
1 2
1 4
3
C
3 1 2
D
8 4 2 7
6 5
75566
Index
Page 4E-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
A - Ignition Components 1 - Distributor 2 - Timing Lead 3 - Shift Cutout Switch 4 - Ignition Coil B - Starting, Charging and Choke Components 1 - Alternator 2 - Electric Choke 3 - Ground Stud 4 - Starter Motor 5 - Oil Pressure Switch 6 - Fuel Pump 7 - Fuse 8 - Starter Slave Solenoid C - Audio Warning Components 1 - Oil Pressure Switch 2 - Drive Unit Gear Lube Monitor 3 - Water Temperature Sender D - Instrumentation Components 1 - Oil Pressure Sender 2 - Water Temperature Sender 3 - Trim Sender
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-5
WIRING DIAGRAMS
1
A
3
C
3 1 2
8 4 2 3 6 5
75547
Index
Page 4E-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
A - Ignition Components 1 - Distributor 2 - Timing Lead 3 - Shift Cutout Switch 4 - Ignition Coil B - Starting, Charging and Choke Components 1 - Alternator 2 - Electric Choke 3 - Ground Stud 4 - Starter Motor 5 - Oil Pressure Switch 6 - Fuel Pump 7 - Circuit Breaker 8 - Starter Slave Solenoid C - Audio Warning Components 1 - Oil Pressure Switch 2 - Drive Unit Gear Lube Monitor 3 - Water Temperature Sender D - Instrumentation Components 1 - Oil Pressure Sender 2 - Water Temperature Sender 3 - Trim Sender
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-7
WIRING DIAGRAMS
1 3
3
C
2 1 2 3
1 8
4
B
3 6 2 5
75549
Index
Page 4E-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
A - Ignition Components 1 - Distributor 2 - Timing Lead 3 - Ignition Coil B - Starting, Charging and Choke Components 1 - Alternator 2 - Electric Choke 3 - Ground Stud 4 - Starter Motor 5 - Oil Pressure Switch 6 - Fuel Pump 7 - Circuit Breaker 8 - Starter Slave Solenoid C - Audio Warning Components 1 - Oil Pressure Switch 2 - Drive Unit Gear Lube Monitor 3 - Water Temperature Sender D - Instrumentation Components 1 - Oil Pressure Sender 2 - Water Temperature Sender 3 - Trim Sender
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-9
WIRING DIAGRAMS
1 5 4
b
1 3
90 Amp Fuse
a
75462
Index
Page 4E-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
A - Audio Warning Components 1 - Oil Pressure Switch 2 - Drive Unit Oil Level B - Instrumentation Components 1 - Oil Pressure Sender 2 - Water Temperature Sender 3 - Trim Sender C - Charging and Starting Components 1 - Alternator 2 - Ground Stud 3 - Starter 4 - Circuit Breaker 5 - Starter Slave Solenoid a - Positive Power Wire To EFI System Harness b - Harness Connector To EFI System Harness c - Auxiliary Tachometer Lead
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-11
WIRING DIAGRAMS
1 5 4
b
1 3
90 Amp Fuse
2
C
a
75462
Index
Page 4E-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
A - Audio Warning Components 1 - Oil Pressure Switch 2 - Drive Unit Oil Level B - Instrumentation Components 1 - Oil Pressure Sender 2 - Water Temperature Sender 3 - Trim Sender C - Charging and Starting Components 1 - Alternator 2 - Ground Stud 3 - Starter 4 - Circuit Breaker 5 - Starter Slave Solenoid a - Positive Power Wire To EFI System Harness b - Harness Connector To EFI System Harness c - Auxiliary Tachometer Lead
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-13
WIRING DIAGRAMS
A
1
2 1
B
c
4 5
b
2 3 6
90 Amp Fuse
76061
Index
Page 4E-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
B - Instrumentation Components
1 - Oil Pressure Sender 2 - Trim Sender
a - Positive Power Wire To EFI System Harness b - Harness Connector To EFI System Harness c - Auxiliary Tachometer Lead
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-15
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Note: All BLACK wires with a ground symbol are interconnected within the EFI system harness. Note: Component position and orientation shown is arranged for visual clarity and ease of circuit identification. 3 18
8 4 12
9 10 2 7 11 16 17 1 5 14 13 6
15
75463
Index
Page 4E-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
1 - Fuel Pump 2 - Throttle Body 3 - Distributor 4 - Coil 5 - Electronic Spark Control (KS) Module 6 - Data Link Connector (DLC) 7 - Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor 8 - Knock Sensor 9 - Idle Air Control (IAC) 10 - Throttle Position (TP) Sensor 11 - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 12 - Electronic Control Module (ECM) 13 - Fuel Pump Relay 14 - Ignition/System Relay 15 - Fuse (15 Amp) Fuel Pump Fuse (15 Amp) ECM/DLC/Battery Fuse (10 Amp) ECM/Injector/Ignition/Knock Module 16 - Harness Connector To Starting/Charging Harness 17 - Positive (+) Power Wire To Engine Circuit Breaker 18 - Shift Cutout Switch
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-17
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Note: All BLACK wires with a ground symbol are interconnected within the EFI system harness. Note: Component position and orientation shown is arranged for visual clarity and ease of circuit identification. 3
8 4 12
9 10 2 7 11 16 17 1 5 14 13 6
15
75464
Index
Page 4E-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
1 - Fuel Pump 2 - Throttle Body 3 - Distributor 4 - Coil 5 - Electronic Spark Control (KS) Module 6 - Data Link Connector (DLC) 7 - Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor 8 - Knock Sensor 9 - Idle Air Control (IAC) 10 - Throttle Position (TP) Sensor 11 - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 12 - Electronic Control Module (ECM) 13 - Fuel Pump Relay 14 - Ignition/System Relay 15 - Fuse (15 Amp) Fuel Pump Fuse (15 Amp) ECM/DLC/Battery Fuse (10 Amp) ECM/Injector/Ignition/Knock Module 16 - Harness Connector To Starting/Charging Harness 17 - Positive (+) Power Wire To Engine Circuit Breaker
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-19
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Note: All BLACK wires with a ground symbol are interconnected within the EFI system harness. Note: Component position and orientation shown is arranged for visual clarity and ease of circuit identification. 22 21 17 7 9 10 20 6 13 11 18 19 1
(+) ()
5 12
2 8 15 14
16
76063
Index
Page 4E-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
1 - Fuel Pump 2 - Throttle Body 3 - Distributor 4 - Coil 5 - Manifold Air Temperature (MAT) Sensor 6 - Data Link Connector (DLC) 7 - Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor 8 - Knock Sensor 9 - Idle Air Control (IAC) 10 - Throttle Position (TP) Sensor 11 - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 12 - Electronic Control Module (ECM) 13 - Water Temperature Sender 14 - Fuel Pump Relay 15 - Ignition/System Relay 16 - Fuses (15 Amp) Fuel Pump, (15 Amp) ECM/DLC/Battery, (10 Amp) ECM/Injector/Ignition/Knock Module 17 - Oil Pressure Sensor 18 - Harness Connector To Starting/Charging Harness 19 - Positive (+) Power Wire To Engine Circuit Breaker 20 - Shift Plate (Alpha Models) 21 - Gear Lube Monitor 22 - Fuel Pressure Switch
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-21
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Quicksilver Instrumentation
Note: Connect wires together with screw and hex nut. Apply Quicksilver Liquid Neoprene to connection and slide rubber sleeve over connection. Note: Power for a second fused accessory panel may be taken from this connection. Load MUST NOT exceed 35-40 amps. Panel ground wire MUST BE connected to instrument terminal that has an 8 gauge BLACK (ground) harness wire connected to it. 8
NOTE 2
9 7
NOTE 1
NOTE 1
Index
Page 4E-22
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
- Tachometer - Audio Warning Buzzer (if Equipped) - Oil Pressure - Water Temperature - Battery Meter - Ignition Switch - Trim Indicator - To 12 Volt Source (PURPLE wire connection) - 20 Ampere Fuse
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
To Engine Harness
NOTE 1
74046
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-23
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Dual Station Wiring (Using a Neutral Safety Switch in Only One Remote Control)
1
GND SW 12V UNSW
L T
L T
L T
L T
SIG
PUR LT. BLU GRY PUR BLK BLK BLK YEL/RED GRY PUR
PUR
PUR
BLK
RED/PUR
B SI
1
L T GND SW UNSW 12V
2
L T GND 12V SEND SIG
3
L T GND 12V SEND
TAN
BLK
4
L T GND 12V SEND
BRN/WHT
ORN PUR PUR LT. BLU TAN BLK BLK YEL/RED RED/PUR BLK ORN GRY PUR BLK PUR PUR NOTE 2
BRN/WHT
6
72940
Note: BROWN/WHITE wire is taped back at instrument end. If installing on boat that is equipped with MerCruiser stern drive, BROWN/WHITE wire is connected to trim sender terminal block. If installing on MerCruiser Inboard, BROWN/WHITE wire is taped back at engine end, or it may be used for an accessory (limit 5 amperes). Note: An accessory fuse panel may be connected at this location. The combined current draw of the primary station and secondary station MUST NOT exceed 35 amperes. Note: Connect wires together with screw and hex nut. Apply Quicksilver Liquid Neoprene to connection and slide rubber sleeve over connection.
Index
Page 4E-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
A - Secondary Station
1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
- Stop -Start Panel - Tachometer - Oil Pressure - Water Temperature - Battery Meter - Ignition Switch - Tachometer - Oil Pressure - Water Temperature - Battery Meter - To Engine - 20 Ampere Fuse
B - Primary Station
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-25
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Dual Station Wiring (Using A Neutral Safety Switch In Both Remote Controls)
1
L T GND SW UNSW 12V
L T
L T
L T
SIG
LT. BLU
PUR
PUR
BLK
TAN
BLK
PUR
NOTE 3
YEL/RED
RED/PUR
B S I
1
L T GND SW UNSW 12V
2
L T GND 12V SEND SIG
3
L T GND 12V SEND
4
L T GND 12V SEND
BRN/WHT
7
ORN
BLK
YEL/RED
RED/PUR
PUR
PUR
LT. BLU
BLK
PUR
GRY
BLK
TAN
ORN
PUR
PUR
BLK
NOTE 2
YEL/RED YEL/RED
NOTE 3
BRN/WHT
YEL/RED
NOTE 3
72941
Note: BROWN/WHITE wire is taped back at instrument end. If installing on boat that is equipped with MerCruiser stern drive, BROWN/WHITE wire is connected to trim sender terminal block. If installing on MerCruiser Inboard, BROWN/WHITE wire is taped back at engine end, or it may be used for an accessory (limit 5 amperes). Note: An accessory fuse panel may be connected at this location. The combined current draw of the primary station and secondary station MUST NOT exceed 35 amperes. Note: Connect wires together with screw and hex nut. Apply Quicksilver Liquid Neoprene to connection and slide rubber sleeve over connection.
Index
Page 4E-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
A - Secondary Station 1 - Stop -Start Panel 2 - Tachometer 3 - Oil Pressure 4 - Water Temperature 5 - Battery Meter B - Primary Station 1 - Ignition Switch 2 - Tachometer 3 - Oil Pressure 4 - Water Temperature 5 - Battery Meter 6 - To Engine 7 - 20 Ampere Fuse
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-27
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Dual Station Wiring (Using a Neutral Safety Switch in Engine Wiring Harness)
A
1
L T GND SW UNSW 12V
L T
L T
L T
SIG
LT. BLU
PUR
PUR
BLK
NOTE 3
TAN
BLK
YEL/RED
NOTE 1
RED/PUR
B S I
1
L T GND SW UNSW 12V
2
L T GND 12V SEND SIG
3
L T GND 12V SEND
4
L T GND 12V SEND
BRN/WHT
7
ORN YEL/RED
BLK
BLK
PUR
PUR
LT. BLU
TAN
RED/PUR
PUR
GRY
BLK
ORN
PUR
PUR
BLK
NOTE 2
NOTE 1
BRN/WHT
YEL/RED
NOTE 3
72942
Note: BROWN/WHITE wire is taped back at instrument end. If installing on boat that is equipped with MerCruiser stern drive, BROWN/WHITE wire is connected to trim sender terminal block. If installing on MerCruiser Inboard, BROWN/WHITE wire is taped back at engine end, or it may be used for an accessory (limit 5 amperes). Note: An accessory fuse panel may be connected at this location. The combined current draw of the primary station and secondary station MUST NOT exceed 35 amperes. Note: Connect wires together with screw and hex nut. Apply Quicksilver Liquid Neoprene to connection and slide rubber sleeve over connection.
Index
Page 4E-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WIRING DIAGRAMS
A - Secondary Station
1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
- Stop -Start Panel - Tachometer - Oil Pressure - Water Temperature - Battery Meter - Ignition Switch - Tachometer - Oil Pressure - Water Temperature - Battery Meter - To Engine - 20 Ampere Fuse
B - Primary Station
Index
90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 4E-29
WIRING DIAGRAMS
Index
Page 4E-30 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
FUEL SYSTEM
Section 5A - Fuel Delivery System For Carbureted Engines
Table of Contents
Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacement Parts Warning . . . . . . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Supply Connections . . . . . . . . . . 5A-2 5A-2 5A-2 5A-2 5A-3 5A-3 5A-3 5A-3 Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel System Components . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Separating Fuel Filter . . . . . . . . . . Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vent Hose Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Carbureted Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5A-4 5A-4 5A-6 5A-7 5A-8 5A-8 5A-8
5
A
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5A-1
Identification
75523
a - Fuel Pump
Specifications
Description Pump Pressure Specification
3-7 PSI (21-48 kPa)
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Fuel Lines Fuel Fittings Into Adapter NOTE: Refer To Fuel Supply Connections Warning following this chart. lb-in. lb-ft 18 Nm 24
See Note
Index
Page 5A-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Tools
Description Fuel Pressure Connector (Carburetor) Fuel Pressure Gauge Part Number 91-18078 Obtain Locally
Precautions
WARNING
Always disconnect battery cables from battery BEFORE working on fuel system to prevent fire or explosion.
WARNING
Be careful when changing fuel system components; gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark or flame in the area. Wipe up any spilled fuel immediately.
WARNING
Make sure that no fuel leaks exist before closing engine hatch.
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without cooling water being supplied to seawater pickup pump, or pump impeller will be damaged and subsequent overheating damage may result.
WARNING
Avoid gasoline fire or explosion. Improper installation of brass fittings or plugs into fuel pump or fuel filter base can crack casting and/or cause a fuel leak. Apply #592 Loctite Pipe Sealant with Teflon to threads of brass fitting or plug. DO NOT USE TEFLON TAPE. Thread brass fitting or plug into fuel pump or fuel filter base until finger tight. Tighten fitting or plug an additional 1-3/4 to 2-1/4 turns using a wrench. DO NOT Overtighten. Install fuel line. To prevent overtightening, hold brass fitting with suitable wrench and tighten fuel line connectors securely. Check for fuel leaks.
Page 5A-3
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
WARNING
Boating standards (NMMA, ABYC, etc.) and Coast Guard regulations must be adhered to when installing fuel delivery system
GENERAL
The fuel tank is an integrated component of the boat. Refer to the special information on service and maintenance that you have received from the tank manufacturer. Only a few points related to function and safety are listed here. Refer to boating standards (NMMA, ABYC, etc.) and Coast Guard regulations for complete guidelines: All connections should be on the upper side of the tank. The drain plug at the lowest point on the tank serves to permit the removal of water and sediment. The filler pipe outer diameter should be at least 2 in. (51 mm). The tank breather pipe must have an inner diameter of at least 1/2 in. (13mm) and must be fitted with a swan neck to prevent water from entering the tank.
It is recommended that the exact route and length of the fuel lines be established at the first installation of the engine to prevent problems later in connecting them to the engine. All fuel lines must be well secured. The holes where the lines run through the bulkheads should be carefully rounded off or protected with rubber grommets. This prevents damage to the lines from abrasion. The following, but not limited to the following, additional fuel connection related points, applying to all engines unless otherwise stated, must be considered [Refer to boating standards (NMMA, ABYC, etc.) and Coast Guard regulations for complete guidelines]: 1. Fuel tank should be mounted below carburetor level (if possible) or gravity feed may cause carburetor fuel inlet needle to unseat and flooding may result. 2. Fuel pickup should be at least 1 in. (25mm) from the bottom of fuel tank to prevent picking up impurities. 3. Fuel lines used must be Coast Guard approved (USCG Type A1). Diameter of fittings and lines must not be smaller than 5/16 in. (8 mm) inside diameter (I.D.) 4. On Multi-Engine Installations: It is best to use a fuel pickup and supply line for each engine. If a single pickup and line is used, line must not be smaller than 1/2 in. (13mm) I.D.
Index
Page 5A-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
5. Larger diameter (than previously specified) lines and fittings must be used on installations requiring long lines or numerous fittings. 6. Fuel line(s) should be installed free of stress and firmly secured to prevent vibration and/ or chafing. 7. Sharp bends in fuel lines should be avoided. 8. A flexible fuel line must be used to connect fuel supply line to fuel inlet fitting on engine to absorb deflection when engine is running.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5A-5
d
a b c d e f - Fuel Line to Carburetor - Fuel Pump - Fuel Line to Fuel Pump - Water Separating Fuel Filter - Fuel Filter Base - Carburetor
75869
Index
Page 5A-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
a c
72678
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5A-7
Replacement
NOTICE Refer to Precautions in this section BEFORE proceeding.
1. Disconnect battery cables from battery. 2. Remove fuel filter from base. A filter wrench may be needed to loosen element. 3. Lubricate sealing ring of new filter with SAE engine oil. 4. Install new filter, tightening securely by hand. 5. Reconnect battery cables. 6. Make sure water is supplied to cooling system. 7. Start engine. 8. Check for fuel leaks.
a g b e f
75826
a b c d e f g
- Carburetor - Flame Arrestor - PCV Valve - Vent Hose - PCV Valve to Back Of Carburetor - Vent Hose - Valve Cover Fitting To Flame Arrestor - Valve Cover Fitting - Front of Engine
Index
Page 5A-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5A-9
Index
Page 5A-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
5
B
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-1
Identification
33049565 2301
a b
72680
2 Barrel MerCarb Carburetor Part Number Location a - Part Number b - Date Code Date Code Explanation: Example 2301 First Figure is Year: 2 = 1992, 3 = 1993, etc. Second Figure is Month: 2 = February, 3 = March, etc. X = October, Y = November, Z = December Third and Fourth Figures are Day of Month: 01 = First day, 02 = Second day, etc.
b
72779
Venturi Cluster Identification a - Identification Number (See Specifications) b - Accelerator Pump Discharge Holes
Index
Page 5B-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Precautions
WARNING
Always disconnect battery cables from battery BEFORE working on fuel system to prevent fire or explosion.
WARNING
Be careful when cleaning flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hose; gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark or open flame in area when cleaning flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hose.
WARNING
Be careful when changing fuel system components; gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark or flame in the area while changing fuel filter. Wipe up any spilled fuel immediately.
WARNING
Make sure no fuel leaks exist, before closing engine hatch.
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without cooling water being supplied to water pickup holes in gear housing, or water pump impeller will be damaged and subsequent overheating damage to engine may result.
Torque Specifications
Description Carburetor To Manifold Fuel Line to Carburetor Fuel Inlet Filter Nut lb-in. lb-ft 20 18 18 Nm 27 24 24
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-3
Specifications
Engine Model Carburetor Type Carburetor Number Float Level Float Drop Pump Rod (Location) Choke Setting Choke Unloader Idle Mixture Screw Float Weight Main Jet Size Power Valve Size Venturi Cluster ID Number Accelerator Pump Discharge Hole Size Fuel Pump Pressure NOTE: Measurement taken from gasket. NOTE: All measurements are +/ 1/64 in. (0.4 mm) 4.3L MerCarb 43mm 3310-807764 9/16 (14) See Notes 1-3/32 (27) See Notes Middle Hole Of Pump Arm 2 Marks Right Of Index Mark (Lean) 5/64 [.080] (2) 1-1/4 Turns Out 9 grams Maximum 1.55 mm 0.74 mm 472 0.035 (0.9) 3-7 psi (21-48 kPa)
Tools
Description Tachometer Universal Carburetor Gauge Float Gram Scale Part Number 91-59339 91-36392 Obtain Locally
Index
Page 5B-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-5
Exploded View
12 11 10 9 8 3 4 5 7 6 41 42 43 44 45 46
2 1
47 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 27 28 24 26 25
48
49
50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58
38 37
39
40
75842
Index
Page 5B-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-7
Models 4.3
JET SIZES
Jet Size 1.30 1.35 1.40 1.45 1.50 1.55 1.60 1.65 1.70 1.75 1.80 1.85 1.90 Quicksilver Part Number 3302-811849 3302-811850 3302-811851 3302-9050 3302-811852 3302-811853 3302-810923 3302-9058 3302-9055 3302-881854 3302-811855 3302-811856 3302-811857
POWER VALVES
Jet Size 0.74 0.90 Quicksilver Part Number 33029435 33029059
Index
Page 5B-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
____Turn Y Y Y Y N N N N
b
Needle and Seat Assemblies a - Spring Loaded Type Needle (Kit 3302-9029) b - Solid Type Needle (Kit 3302-9407)
72290
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-9
a b c
73131
a - Full Accelerator Pump Stroke b - 0.5 cc Less Fuel per Stroke c - 1.0 cc Less Fuel per Stroke When installing the 3-hole lever, remove any metal ball that may have been placed in the accelerator pump well to limit pump travel. Also, ensure that the duration spring on the accelerator pump is stock and hasnt had coils removed. Ensure that the correct venturi cluster is being used.
Description
This MerCarb carburetor is a two bore carburetor that has a separate fuel feed for each venturi. This model is equipped with an electric choke. A removable venturi cluster (secured to float bowl assembly) has the calibrated main well tubes and pump jets built into it. The venturi cluster is serviced as a unit. The serviceable main metering jets are bleeds to properly meter the correct fuel / air mixture to the engine.
Index
Page 5B-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Maintenance
Flame Arrestor
NOTICE Refer to Precautions in this section, BEFORE proceeding.
REMOVAL
1. Remove nut. 2. Remove sealing washer. 3. Remove flame arrestor cover. 4. Remove crankcase ventilation hose from flame arrestor and starboard rocker arm cover. 5. Remove Positive Crankcase Vent (PCV) hose to carburetor tube and port rocker arm PCV Valve connection. 6. Remove flame arrestor.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-11
INSTALLATION
1. Install flame arrestor. 2. Install crankcase ventilation hose to flame arrestor and starboard rocker arm cover. 3. Install positive crankcase vent (PCV) hose from port rocker arm PCV valve connection to carburetor tube. 4. Install carburetor cover. 5. Install sealing washer and nut. Tighten securely.
a b
f h g
c
a b c d e f g h - Nut - Sealing Washer - Carburetor - Cover (Depending On Model) - Crankcase Ventilation Hose - Flame Arrestor - Positive Crankcase Vent (PCV) Hose (On Carburetor) - Positive Crankcase Vent (PCV) Hose
75844
Index
Page 5B-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
REMOVAL
1. Remove fuel line from fuel inlet filter nut. 2. Remove fuel inlet filter nut and small gasket. 3. Remove large gasket. 4. Remove filter. 5. Remove spring. 6. Remove small gasket from inside filter nut.
c d
a
72406
a b c d e f
- Fuel Line - Fuel Inlet Filter Nut - Gasket (Larger) - Gasket (Small) - FIlter - Spring
CLEANING
1. Clean filter nut and spring in solvent and dry with compressed air.
INSTALLATION
1. Install spring in carburetor body. 2. Install filter, open end to inlet filter nut. 3. Install small gasket inside filter nut. 4. Install large gasket over filter nut threads. 5. Install fuel inlet filter nut. Torque nut to 18 lb-ft (24 Nm). IMPORTANT: Hold filter nut with wrench while tightening fuel line. 6. Install fuel line. Torque to 18 lb-ft (24 Nm).
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-13
Choke Inspection
The choke does not require any periodic maintenance. However, if a choke malfunction is suspected, do the following: 1. With engine turned OFF, remove flame arrestor. 2. Open and close choke several times to check for binding, loose or disconnected linkages or other signs of damage. 3. If choke or linkage binds or sticks, clean with carburetor choke cleaner. IMPORTANT: Choke valve and shaft and lever assembly is not serviceable. If valve and/or shaft and lever assembly is worn or damaged, air horn assembly must be replaced.
Adjustments
NOTICE Refer to Precautions in this section BEFORE proceeding.
Accelerator Rod
1. Loosen idle speed screw until it no longer contacts idle cam.
a
72284
Index
Page 5B-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
2. With throttle valves completely closed, measure from flame arrestor mounting surface to top of pump rod.
72682
a - See Specifications 3. Carefully bend pump rod (where shown) to obtain specified dimension.
b
72683
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-15
Choke Setting
Normal choke setting: mark on cover is set 2 index marks clockwise from larger, center index mark. If choke adjustment is necessary: 1. Loosen choke cover retaining screws. 2. Adjust as shown. 3. Tighten screws securely.
a c d b d
d
a b c d - Scribed Mark - More Choke - Less Choke - 3 Retaining Screws
72403
Choke Unloader
1. Hold throttle valves completely open. 2. Gently press down on choke plate. 3. Using an .080 in. [5/64 in.] (0.2 mm) drill rod, slide rod between upper edge of choke plate and air horn assembly. Rod should just slide through.
a b c
72684
Index
Page 5B-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
b a
72685
a
72284
a - Idle Speed Screw b - Idle Cam IMPORTANT: DO NOT turn idle mixture needle tightly against seat (in the following step), as damage to seat and/or needle may result. 2. Turn idle mixture needle in until lightly seated, then loosen needle 1-1/4 turns.
a
72281
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-17
EMISSIONS CARBURETOR
Sealed Carburetor Mixture Screw The carburetor on this engine has a seal on the carburetor mixture screw. This seal prevents adjustment of the fuel mixture setting.
CAUTION
Do not remove mixture screw seal and/or attempt to adjust fuel mixture setting. Tampering with the mixture setting on this engine could affect the exhaust emissions level, thus voiding the emissions certification. This seal should only be removed by an authorized dealer or emissions testing agency.
Replacing Carburetor
NOTICE Refer to Precautions in this section, BEFORE proceeding. IMPORTANT: First follow the steps in 8 Point Carburetor Check List to decide if the problem is with the carburetor. 1. Remove the battery cables. 2. Remove the carburetor. 3. Clean gasket surfaces. 4. Use a new gasket and install new carburetor. 5. Hold the carburetor filter nut with a wrench and tighten fuel line fitting securely. 6. Reconnect or install choke wires, vent hoses and flame arrestor. 7. Adjust carburetor and throttle cable.
Index
Page 5B-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Repair
NOTICE Refer to Precautions in this section BEFORE proceeding.
Removal
IMPORTANT: Carburetor problems are, in many cases, caused by the presence of dirt, water or other foreign matter in carburetor. To aid in diagnosis, carefully remove carburetor from engine without draining fuel from bowl. Contents of fuel bowl may then be inspected for contamination as carburetor is disassembled. 1. Remove battery cables. 2. Remove crankcase ventilation and PCV hose from flame arrestor. 3. Remove flame arrestor. IMPORTANT: Place a clean cloth in bores of carburetor to prevent dirt and foreign material from falling into bores. 4. Turn fuel supply off at fuel tank. 5. Disconnect throttle cable from carburetor. 6. Remove fuel line from fuel inlet nut, using wrench to stabilize fuel inlet nut. 7. Disconnect electric choke. 8. Remove carburetor attaching nuts and washers and remove carburetor. IMPORTANT: Place a clean cloth over intake manifold opening to prevent dirt or foreign material from entering manifold. 9. Remove and discard gaskets.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-19
Disassembly
IMPORTANT: Before performing any service on carburetor, it is essential that carburetor be placed in a holding fixture to prevent possible damage to throttle valves. The following is a step-by-step procedure for completely overhauling the carburetor removed from engine. Complete overhaul is not always necessary. You should perform only those steps required to repair the carburetor malfunction. Read the instructions carefully to prevent unnecessary steps.
CHOKE HOUSING
1. Remove choke cover.
a
72403
b
72401
AIR HORN
1. Remove fuel inlet filter nut, washers, spring, and filter. 2. Remove accelerator pump rod retaining clip.
Index
Page 5B-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
3. Pivot rod (as required) until retaining ear on rod and slot in pump shaft and lever assembly align, allowing rod to be pulled out.
a b
a - Accelerator Pump Rod b - Retainer Clip c - Pump Shaft and Lever Assembly 4. Remove idle cam screw.
72283
b a
72282
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-21
5. Remove choke rod by pivoting rod (as required) until retaining ear on rod and slot in choke lever align, allowing rod to be pulled out.
72286
a - Choke Rod b - Choke Lever c - Slot 6. Remove air horn attaching screws. 7. Carefully lift air horn from float bowl assembly.
a a
a
a - Air Horn Attaching Screws
72280
b
a - Air Horn Assembly b - Float Bowl Assembly
72400
Index
Page 5B-22
9. Remove float hinge pin and lift float assembly from air horn.
a
72288
a - Float Hinge Pin b - Float Assembly 10. Check float weight as shown.
b
72122
a - Grams Scale b - Float 11. Remove air horn gasket and baffle.
b
a - Baffle b - Air Horn Gasket
72399
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-23
b
72287
b
72289
b
Needle and Seat Assemblies a - Spring Loaded Type Needle (Kit 3302-9029) b - Solid Type Needle (Kit 3302-9407)
72290
Index
Page 5B-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
14. Loosen accelerator pump screw. 15. Slide pump shaft and lever assembly (and washer) out of air horn. 16. Remove accelerator pump assembly.
c
72398
a - Set Screw b - Lever Assembly c - Pump Assembly 17. Remove retainer clip and washer from pump shaft and lever assembly, then remove accelerator pump assembly.
b c a
72409
FLOAT BOWL
1. Remove accelerator pump return spring from pump well.
72402
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-25
72404
a - Power Valve Assembly b - Gasket (Not Shown) 3. Remove main metering jets.
b
72291
a - Main Metering Jets b - Gaskets (Not Shown) IMPORTANT: Use care when removing venturi cluster to prevent damaging brass tubes which protrude from bottom of cluster. DO NOT REMOVE TUBES. These tubes are permanently pressed into the venturi cluster and are not replaceable. 4. Remove venturi cluster screws and carefully lift cluster and venturi gasket straight up.
a b
72397
Index
Page 5B-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
5. Using needle-nose pliers, remove accelerator pump check ball spring retainer. Turn float bowl over to remove spring and check ball.
b
a - Spring Retainer b - Spring and Check Ball (Not Shown)
72407
IMPORTANT: Use extreme care when handling carburetor body to prevent damaging throttle valves. 1. Remove idle mixture adjusting needle and spring.
a b
72293
a - Idle Mixture Adjusting Needle b - Spring 2. Remove idle speed adjustment screw and spring, if replacement is necessary.
b a
72395
a - Idle Speed Screw b - Spring IMPORTANT: DO NOT remove throttle valves. If any of the throttle parts are found to be worn or damaged, complete carburetor body assembly MUST BE replaced. Assembly can be cleaned in carburetor cleaner.
Page 5B-27
Index
CAUTION
To avoid damage to carburetor DO NOT leave carburetor in immersion type carburetor cleaner for more than two hours. IMPORTANT: DO NOT clean float bowl gasket surfaces with a gasket scraper or knife, as sealing bead will be damaged and float bowl replacement will be necessary.
CAUTION
The float assembly, float needle, accelerator pump plunger and fuel filter MUST NOT BE immersed in carburetor cleaner, as they will swell, harden and/or distort.
c d
a b c d - Accelerator Pump Plunger - Float Needle - Fuel Filter - Float Assembly
a
72410
WARNING
Avoid personal injury by always wearing safety goggles when using compressed air. 1. Clean all metal parts in a commercial carburetor cleaner until all deposits have been removed. Follow cleaner manufacturers instructions for proper cleaning and rinsing procedure. Dry parts with compressed air. 2. Using compressed air, blow out all passages in carburetor to remove any foreign material. 3. Wipe off all parts that cannot be cleaned in carburetor cleaner with a clean, dry cloth. 4. Carefully inspect all carburetor parts for wear and damage. Pay particular attention to the following: a. Float Needle and Seat: If float needle or seat is worn or damaged, replace with new needle and seat assembly. IMPORTANT: Float needle and seat are factory matched and tested and should be replaced as a set only. b. Float Assembly and Hinge Pin: Check float density (to see if it is saturated with fuel) by comparing weight of float with specifications. If weight is high, float assembly must be replaced. Check hinge pin and holes for wear.
Index
Page 5B-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
c. Fuel and Air Passages: Passages must be perfectly clean for proper carburetor operation. d. Accelerator Pump Plunger and Return Spring: Inspect pump plunger cup, pump plunger spring (on pump assembly) and return spring. e. Power Piston Spring: Check power piston spring for weakness or distortion. f. Idle Mixture Needle: Inspect idle mixture needle. If damaged, needle must be replaced.
g. Levers and Linkages: Check levers, links and rods for wear. h. Throttle Valve and Shaft: Check throttle shaft for excessive looseness in throttle body. Ensure throttle valve and shaft open and close completely. Throttle body assembly must be replaced if throttle valve and shaft are worn or damaged. i. Choke Valve and Shaft and Lever Assembly: Check shaft and lever assembly for excessive looseness in air horn assembly. Check choke valve and shaft and lever assembly for binding through entire operating range, making sure valve opens and closes completely. Air horn assembly must be replaced if choke valve and shaft and lever assembly are worn or damaged. Inspect Casting for visible damage. Inspect gasket surfaces. Inspect accelerator pump plunger well for scoring or deposits.
j.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-29
Reassembly
CARBURETOR BODY
IMPORTANT: DO NOT force idle mixture needle against seat as damage to needle and/or seat will result. 1. Screw idle mixture needle and spring into throttle body until they lightly seat, then back out needle 1-1/2 turns as a preliminary idle mixture setting.
a b
72293
a - Idle Mixing Adjusting Needle b - Spring 2. Thread idle speed adjustment screw and spring into throttle lever.
b a
72395
Index
Page 5B-30 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
FLOAT BOWL
IMPORTANT: Place float bowl and throttle assemblies in holding fixture to prevent throttle valves from being damaged. 1. Install check ball, spring, and retainer in passage. Push retainer firmly into slots.
c b a
72408
a
72296
72397
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-31
4. Install flat washer and new fiber washer on center screw. Lockwashers and flat washers are used on outer screws. Tighten screws evenly and securely. IMPORTANT: Do not damage the fiber washer. A damaged washer will cause improper fueling.
a b c d b
72405
a b c d
- Center Screw - Outer Screws - Fiber Washer - Lock Washer and Flat Washer
b
72291
a - Main Metering Jets b - Gaskets (Not Shown) 6. Install power valve with new gasket. Tighten securely.
a
72404
Index
Page 5B-32 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
72402
AIR HORN
IMPORTANT: Accelerator pump assembly MUST BE installed correctly. If pump assembly is installed incorrectly, top of pump assembly will contact air horn casting. 1. If accelerator pump assembly was removed from pump lever, secure pump assembly to pump lever with washer and retainer clip.
b a
72409
a - Pump Assembly b - Retainer Clip c - Pump Lever 2. Insert pump shaft and lever assembly (and washer) into air horn. 3. Align indexed hole in pump lever with shaft and lever assembly and slide shaft all the way into lever so that shoulder on shaft is hitting lever. 4. Tighten set screw securely.
b c
a - Set Screw b - Lever Assembly c - Pump Assembly
72398
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-33
b
72289
a - Needle Seat b - Gasket c - Screwdriver IMPORTANT: Float needle and needle seat are factory matched and tested and should be replaced as a set only. 6. Place needle assembly in needle seat.
b
72287
72399
b
a - Baffle b - Gasket
Index
Page 5B-34 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
8. Install float assembly and hinge pin. Pivot float assembly up and down on hinge pin to ensure it moves freely.
a
a - Float Assembly b - Float Hinge Pin
72297
FLOAT LEVEL
1. Turn air horn upside down. Pivot float assembly up and down on hinge pin to ensure it moves freely. IMPORTANT: Before checking float level, raise float and allow it to fall; however, DO NOT force downward by hand. 2. Measure float level using Universal Carburetor Gauge (91-36392). Measure from gasket to toe of float.
a
a - Measure From This Point (Dot) To Gasket
72298
72687
a - Measurement With 2 Piece Solid Inlet Needle - 3/8 in. (10 mm) b - Measurement with Spring Loaded Inlet Needle - 11/32 in. (9 mm)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-35
a
72688
a - Bend Float Arm at This Point 4. Visually check float alignment after adjustment.
FLOAT DROP
1. Hold air horn right side up to allow float to hang free. 2. Measure float drop using Universal Carburetor Gauge (91-36392). Measure from gasket (air horn) to dot on float.
72689
a - Measurement - 15/16 in. (24 mm) 3. Bend float assembly tang, as shown, to obtain specified dimension.
72690
a - Float Assembly Tang 4. Recheck BOTH float level and float drop.
Index
Page 5B-36 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
5. Place air horn on float bowl, making sure accelerator pump is correctly positioned in fuel well. Lower air horn straight down to install.
b
72400
a - Air Horn Assembly b - Float Bowl Assembly 6. Install seven short and one long air horn attaching screws. Tighten screws evenly and securely.
a a a
a - Air Horn Attaching Screws 7. Place end of choke rod in choke lever and collar assembly.
72280
72299
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-37
a b
72392
a - Idle Cam b - Choke Rod 9. Secure idle cam (with choke rod installed on cam) on float bowl assembly, using screw. Ensure that cam is free to move without binding.
b a
a - Screw b - Idle Cam c - Choke Rod 10. Place accelerator pump rod in hole in pump shaft and lever assembly.
72282
72393
Index
Page 5B-38 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
11. Insert other end of accelerator pump rod into hole in throttle lever and secure with retainer clip.
a
a - Accelerator Pump Rod b - Throttle Lever c - Retainer Clip
72283
CHOKE HOUSING
1. Install choke housing on air horn. Tighten screws securely. 2. Install choke lever. Tighten screw securely.
b a
72401
a - Choke Housing b - Choke Housing Attaching Screws c - Choke Lever 3. Install choke cover. Make sure hook on end of choke coil engages with choke lever. 4. Adjust choke cover until index marks align as shown. Tighten screws securely.
a c b d
72403
Index
a b c d
- Scribed Mark - More Choke (Richer) - Less Choke (Leaner) - Cover Screws
Page 5B-39
Installation
1. Thoroughly clean gasket surfaces and install new gaskets. 2. Place new carburetor base gasket on intake manifold. 3. Install carburetor and secure with nuts and washers. Torque to 132 lb-in. (15 Nm). 4. If fuel inlet filter nut was disturbed, remove, clean all threads with brush and carburetor cleaner or Quicksilver Leveler, and replace. 5. Connect fuel line to fuel inlet filter nut. Hold filter nut with wrench, tighten fuel line fitting securely. 6. Connect electric choke wires to choke cover. 7. Install throttle cable. Refer to SECTION 2. 8. Install flame arrestor, crankcase ventilation and PCV hose. 9. Reconnect battery cables to battery. 10. Ensure that water is supplied to cooling system. 11. Start engine. 12. Check for gasoline leaks. If leaks exist, STOP ENGINE IMMEDIATELY and recheck connections. 13. Adjust idle speed and idle mixture.
Index
Page 5B-40 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5B-41
Index
Page 5B-42 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
FUEL SYSTEMS
Section 5C - Weber 4 Barrel Carburetor
5
C
Table of Contents
Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-2 Carburetor Metering Rod And Jet Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-2 Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-4 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-4 Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-5 Replacement Parts Warning . . . . . . . . . . 5C-5 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-6 Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-6 Fuel Supply Connections . . . . . . . . . . 5C-6 Eight Point Carburetor Checklist . . . . . . . . . 5C-7 Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-8 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-10 Important Service Information . . . . . . . . . 5C-11 Adjustable Accelerator Pump Lever . 5C-11 Hard Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-11 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flame Arrestor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Inlet Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Accelerator Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Float Drop . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Float Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Electric Choke . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Idle Speed and Mixture . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacing Carburetor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5C-12 5C-12 5C-13 5C-14 5C-14 5C-16 5C-17 5C-18 5C-18 5C-19 5C-19 5C-19 5C-21 5C-32 5C-33 5C-44
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-1
Identification
a
a - Weber Identification Number Location NOTICE For information and procedures on troubleshooting, refer to SECTION 1C.
75682
e
Three Step Metering Rod a - Piston b - Metering Rod c - Spring d - Jet e - Piston Cover
73732
Index
Page 5C-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
METERING JETS
The metering jets in this carburetor are as shown.
a
a - Three Step Metering Rod Jet
73728
a b
a - Metering Rod b - Steps (3)
b b
73726
b
73730
73735
a
a - Cover
73725
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-3
a b
73737
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Carburetor To Manifold Fuel Line To Carburetor Fuel Inlet Filter Nut lb-in. 132 lb-ft 18 18 Nm 15 24 24
Specifications
Engine Model Carburetor Type Mercury Number (Manufacturer Number) Primary Jet Size Secondary Jet Size Metering Rod Number Metering Rod Spring Color Float Level Float Drop Pump Rod Hole Location Accelerator Pump Choke Pull Off Electric Choke Setting Idle Mixture Screw Setting
1 Measurement
4.3LH Alpha and Bravo WFB 3310-807826 (9666S) .092 in. .089 in. 16-686457 Green 1-9/32 in. (33 mm) 2 in. (51 mm) Third Hole From End 7/16 in. (11 mm) 1 1.28 (32.5) Lean - Counterclockwise Rich - Clockwise
1-1/4 Turns
Index
Page 5C-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Tools
Description Universal Carburetor Gauge Tachometer Universal Carburetor Stand Torx Screwdriver (15, 20, 25)1 Part Number 91-36392 91-59339 Obtain Locally
1 : Weber carburetors will have a star shaped socket in the head of some screws. A TORX screwdriver must
be used on this type of screw. The sizes used are numbers 15, 20 and 25.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-5
Precautions
WARNING
Always disconnect battery cables from battery BEFORE working on fuel system to prevent fire or explosion.
WARNING
Be careful when cleaning flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hose: gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark or open flame in area when cleaning flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hose.
WARNING
Be careful when changing fuel system components: gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark or open flame in area while changing fuel filter. Wipe up any spilled fuel immediately.
WARNING
Make sure no fuel leaks exist, before closing engine hatch.
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without cooling water being supplied to water pickup holes in gear housing or water pickup inlet, or water pump impeller will be damaged and subsequent overheating damage to engine may result.
WARNING
Avoid gasoline fire or explosion. Improper installation of brass fittings or plugs into fuel pump or fuel filter base can crack casting and/or cause a fuel leak. Apply #592 Loctite Pipe Sealant with Teflon to threads of brass fitting or plug. DO NOT USE TEFLON TAPE. Thread brass fitting or plug into fuel pump or fuel filter base until finger tight. Tighten fitting or plug an additional 1-3/4 to 2-1/4 turns using a wrench. DO NOT OVERTIGHTEN. Install fuel line. To prevent over-tightening, hold brass fitting with suitable wrench and tighten fuel line connectors securely. Check for fuel leaks.
Index
Page 5C-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
3. Are idle mixture screws set correctly? Y (Engines with Thunderbolt V ignition must have module locked in base timing mode). 4. What is the idle mixture screw setting? 5. Is the engine idle speed (rpm) correct? 6. Is primary venturi cluster discharging fuel (by 2000 rpm)? 7. Is a good stream of fuel being discharged by both pump injector nozzles? (When throttle lever is pumped with engine off). 8. Does the engine flood at idle?
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-7
Exploded View
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
Index
Page 5C-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
1-Air Deflector (2) 2-Screw (2) 3-Cover, Metering Rod (2) 4-Metering Rod Assembly (2) 5-Spring, Metering Rod (2) 6-Fuel Inlet Fitting 7-Sealing Washer 8-Screw 9-Linkage Rod, Choke Pull-Off 10-Screw 11-Air Horn (Carburetor Top) 12-Filter, Fuel Inlet (2) 13-Gasket (2) 14-Seat, Fuel Inlet (2) 15-Needle Valve, Fuel Inlet (2) 16-Pin (2) 17-Float (2) 18-Secondary Venturi Cluster (2) 19-Baffle Plate, Float Bowl (2) 20-Screw (4) 21-Primary Venturi Cluster (2) 22-Gasket (2) 23-Jet, Primary Fuel (2) 24-Screw (2) 25-Fuel Pump Injector Housing 26-Gasket 27-Check-Spring 28-Screw and Clip 29-Electric Choke Assembly 30-Retainer, Choke 31-Idle Mixture Screw (2) 32-Spring, Idle Mixture Screw (2) 33-Gasket, Carburetor Base 34-Linkage Rod, Choke Plate 35-S-Link 36-Accelerator Pump Lever 37-Screw 38-Linkage Rod, Accelerator Pump 39-Wire Clip 40-Wire Clip 41-Gasket 42-Screw (4) 43-Gasket (2) 44-Jet, Secondary Fuel (2) 45-Secondary Air Valve and Weight Assembly 46-Plunger Washer 47-Plunger Guide 48-Accelerator Pump 49-Spring, Accelerator Pump 50-Float Bowl/Body (Carburetor Bottom)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-9
Description
Weber WFB carburetor is unique in design, as the main body and flange are cast as a one piece unit. This, along with the bowl cover, make up the two piece construction that is made of light, durable aluminum to dissipate heat. There are two separate float circuits. Each float circuit supplies fuel to a primary low speed circuit and a primary and secondary high speed circuit. The bowls are vented to the inside of the air horn. A connecting vent passage affects the balance of the air pressure between the two bowls. The float needle valves are installed at an angle to provide the best possible seating action on the needles. This also provides better needle response to float movement. The high speed circuits use staged step-up rods in the main metering jets to control the amount of fuel admitted to the nozzles. The position of the step-up rod is controlled by manifold vacuum applied to the vacuum piston. A primary air bleed located in the venturi cluster prevents a rich condition or bog as the high speed circuit is reactivated after deceleration. Small L shaped metal tabs, called distribution tab(s), are attached to some venturi clusters and protrude into the air stream at the proper location to aid distribution of fuel on selected applications.
Index
Page 5C-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
a b c
70472
Hard Starting
If a hard starting condition exists, after engine has not been operated for a period of time, proceed with the following: 1. Before starting engine, remove flame arrestor then operate throttle to see if choke closes. 2. If choke is stuck open, check choke and choke linkage on both sides of carburetor for cause of sticking. Possible paint or interference to rod or linkage. 3. Check for any paint or binding on choke rod linkages. 4. Make sure choke is getting 12 volts. 5. Make sure choke opens all the way after 3 minute running.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-11
Maintenance
Flame Arrestor
NOTICE Refer to Precautions, in this section, BEFORE proceeding.
c f
a b d d
e e
Flame Arrestor with Carburetor Cover (Typical) a - Nut b - Sealing Washer c - Cover d - Clamps e - Crankcase Ventilation Hose f - Flame Arrestor
71372
REMOVAL
1. Remove nut. 2. Remove sealing washer. 3. Remove carburetor cover. 4. Remove crankcase ventilation hoses from flame arrestor and rocker arm covers. 5. Remove flame arrestor.
INSTALLATION
1. Install flame arrestor. 2. Install crankcase ventilation hoses to flame arrestor and rocker arm covers. 3. Install carburetor cover. 4. Install sealing washer. 5. Install nut. Tighten securely.
Index
Page 5C-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
a b
70447
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-13
Adjustments
NOTICE Refer to Precautions in this section BEFORE proceeding.
Accelerator Pump
IMPORTANT: Refer to Important Service Information in this section, regarding the three accelerator pump linkage holes and placement of linkage rod. 1. Loosen idle speed screw until it no longer contacts throttle lever.
70474
a b
a - Idle Speed Screw b - Throttle Lever
70473
Index
Page 5C-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
2. Accelerator pump is set at 7/16 in. (11 mm), which is measured from the carburetor top to the bottom of the S-link as shown.
70472
3. Adjustment of accelerator pump is done by bending the linkage as necessary to achieve the proper dimension as stated above.
a
70473
a - Bend Here
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-15
Float Drop
1. Measure float drop from bottom side of carburetor top to toe of float (lowest part). It must be set at 2 in. (51 mm).
a
a - Drop Measurement 2. If float drop is not correct, hold hinge pin firmly and bend tab, as needed.
70469
IMPORTANT: Do not put pressure on fuel needle valve and seat while bending tab or damage may result.
a
a - Float b - Tab (Bend)
70470
Index
Page 5C-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Float Level
1. Measure float level from bottom side of carburetor top (with gasket in place) to toe of float as shown. It must be set at 1-9/32 in. (33 mm).
b a
70468
a - Float Level Measurement b - Gasket 2. If float level requires adjustment, hold hinge pin firmly and bend float arm shown, as needed. IMPORTANT: Do not put pressure on fuel needle valve and seat while bending tab, or damage may result.
70468
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-17
Electric Choke
The electric choke should be set with marks aligned.
75862
a - Carburetor Body Mark b - Choke Marks 1. Loosen choke housing screws 2. Adjust choke by turning.
Index
Page 5C-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
3. Using a jumper wire, connect the ignition system timing lead 13 (PUR/WHT wire) to a good engine ground (). This locks the ignition module into the Base Timing Mode. 4. Start engine and allow it to reach normal operating temperature. Place the remote control lever in forward gear, idle position. 5. Adjust idle speed to recommended rpm. 6. Stop engine. Readjust cable barrel and reinstall the throttle. IMPORTANT: Be sure to disconnect the jumper wire from the ignition system test terminal before attempting to resume normal operations. If the jumper wire is left in place, the ignition module will operate in the Base Timing Mode. This means that the additional timing advance features would not be functioning. 7. Remove the jumper wire from the timing terminal.
Replacing Carburetor
NOTICE Refer to Precautions in this section BEFORE proceeding. IMPORTANT: First follow the steps in 8 Point Carburetor Check List to decide if the problem is with the carburetor. 1. Remove the battery cables. 2. Remove the carburetor. 3. Clean gasket surfaces. 4. Use a new gasket and install new carburetor. 5. Hold the carburetor filter nut with a wrench and tighten fuel line fitting securely. 6. Reconnect or install choke wires, vent hoses and flame arrestor. 7. Adjust carburetor and throttle cable.
Repair
NOTICE Refer to Precautions in this section BEFORE proceeding.
Removal
IMPORTANT: Carburetor malfunctions are often caused by the presence of dirt, water or other foreign matter. To aid in diagnosis, carefully remove carburetor from engine without draining fuel from bowl. Contents of fuel bowl may then be inspected for contamination as carburetor is disassembled. 1. Turn off fuel supply at fuel tank. 2. Remove carburetor cover. Remove crankcase ventilation hoses from flame arrestor, then remove flame arrestor. IMPORTANT: Place a clean cloth in bores of carburetor to prevent dirt and foreign material from falling into bores.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-19
3. Disconnect throttle cable attaching hardware from throttle bracket and throttle lever anchor studs. Remove throttle cable.
b d
d a c
a b c d - Throttle Cable - Bracket - Attaching Hardware - Anchor Studs
71097
4. Remove fuel line and carburetor attaching hardware. Remove carburetor and throttle bracket. Discard gasket.
a b
75862
75863
a - Fuel Line b - Attaching Hardware c - Throttle Bracket IMPORTANT: Cover intake manifold to prevent entry of dirt or foreign material through openings. 5. Place a clean cloth over intake manifold openings.
Index
Page 5C-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Disassembly
The following is a step-by-step procedure for completely overhauling carburetor after removal from engine. In many cases, however, complete overhaul is not necessary and, in these cases, only the steps required to repair the carburetor malfunction should be performed. Read the instructions carefully to prevent doing unnecessary steps. IMPORTANT: Before performing any service on carburetor, it is essential that carburetor be placed in a holding fixture to prevent possible damage to throttle valves. 1. Remove wire clip to disconnect accelerator pump linkage.
b a
70390
a - Wire Clip b - Accelerator Pump Linkage Rod 2. Remove wire clip and disconnect electric choke link rod from choke plate lever. IMPORTANT: Metering rods should always be removed before separating top and bottom halves of carburetor. 3. Loosen (not necessary to remove, depending on amount of service required) metering rod cover screws. Turn or remove cover to expose metering rod.
c a b
71094
71095
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-21
IMPORTANT: Be careful not to mix metering rods when removing them. 4. Carefully lift metering rod assemblies straight out.
70396
a - Metering Rod Assembly(s) 5. Remove metering rod springs. IMPORTANT: Metering rod springs are color coded and should not be interchanged with other carburetors.
70397
a - Spring(s) 6. Remove nine screws to separate top and bottom halves of carburetor.
a
a - Screw(s)
70398
Index
Page 5C-22 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
70399
8. Slide pin out to remove the float. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to mix up floats after removal.
b b
a
a - Pin(s) b - Float(s) 9. Remove inlet needle from seat.
70400
IMPORTANT: Be careful not to mix up inlet needles and seats after removal.
a b b
a - Inlets Needle(s) b - Seat(s)
70401
70446
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-23
10. Remove seat, gasket and inlet filter. IMPORTANT: Be careful not to mix up seats after removal.
a b c
70447
a - Seat b - Gasket c - Inlet Filter 11. Remove gasket from top of carburetor.
70448
b a
a - Accelerator Pump b - Accelerator Pump Lever c - Retaining Screw
70449
Index
Page 5C-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
b c
70450
a - Accelerator Pump b - Plunger Guide c - Plunger Washer (Not Visible In This View) 14. Remove accelerator pump spring from bottom half of carburetor.
b
a - Accelerator Pump Spring b - Carburetor Bottom
70451
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-25
IMPORTANT: Before removing venturi clusters, it is important to note which clusters are equipped with a distribution tab. This distribution tab arrangement varies from one carburetor to another.
70452
a - Distribution Tab(s) - Location And Total Number May Vary 15. Remove two screws that secure primary venturi cluster.
70453
a - Screw(s) - Two On Each Side b - Primary Venturi Cluster(s) 16. Remove primary venturi cluster by lifting straight up.
70454
Index
Page 5C-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
70455
a - Gasket, Primary Venturi Cluster 18. Remove two screws that secure secondary venturi clusters.
b
a - Screw(s) - Two Each Side b - Secondary Venturi Cluster(s)
70456
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-27
70457
70458
a - Gasket, Secondary Venturi Cluster 21. Remove secondary air valve and weight assembly by lifting it straight out.
70459
Index
Page 5C-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
b
70460
70461
a - Pump Jet Housing 24. Remove gasket from beneath pump jet housing.
70462
a - Gasket, Pump Jet Housing 25. Remove check-ball and check-spring from hole beneath pump jet housing.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-29
IMPORTANT: Check ball spring is tapered. Ensure tapered end is down during reassembly.
70463
a - Ball Location
b
70464
a - Check Ball b - Check Spring 26. Remove float bowl baffle plates, if necessary.
70465
a - Baffle Plate IMPORTANT: Do not mix up the primary and secondary jets. Make note of the jet sizes and their location before removal to be certain that during reassembly they are installed in the carburetor side from which they were removed. NOTE: If jets are difficult to remove, place a screwdriver of the correct width in the jet slot and lightly tap the end of the screwdriver with a hammer.
Index
Page 5C-30 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
70466
a - Primary Fuel Jet b - Secondary Fuel Jet IMPORTANT: Before removing mixture screws, check and note the number of turns from the fully seated position. Do NOT mix up the two screws. 28. Remove mixture screws.
b
a - Idle Mixture Screw b - Spring, Idle Mixture Screw
70467
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-31
CAUTION
Avoid damage to carburetor. Do not leave carburetor in immersion-type cleaner for more than two hours. IMPORTANT: Do not immerse metering rod springs in carburetor cleaner; the color, if not natural metal, may be removed. Clean separately as needed. 1. Clean metal carburetor parts in a commercial, immersion-type cleaner, until all deposits have been removed. Follow manufacturer s instructions of cleaner being used for proper cleaning and rinsing procedures.
CAUTION
Avoid personal injury. Always wear safety glasses when using compressed air. 2. Blow out passages with compressed air. Do not drill through passages. IMPORTANT: DO NOT use a wire or drill to clean jets, passages, or tubes in carburetor, as this may enlarge orifices and seriously affect carburetor calibration. 3. Wipe all parts that cannot be cleaned in immersion cleaner with a clean, dry cloth. 4. Carefully inspect all carburetor parts for damage or wear; pay particular attention to the following: a. Idle mixture screws - Replace if damaged or worn. b. Fuel inlet needle valve and seat - Replace with new needle and seat if worn or damaged. c. Casting surfaces - Inspect accelerator pump plunger well for scoring or deposits. Replace worn or corroded components. d. All linkage rods and levers - Replace if worn or damaged. e. Accelerator pump and plunger parts - Replace pump and parts if worn or damaged. f. Float assembly and hinge pin - Float weight of each should be the same. Replace either if fuel can be heard inside when shaken. Check hinge pin and holes for wear. Replace components if worn or defective.
g. Throttle valves and shafts - Check for binding (through entire operating range, making sure valves open and close completely) or for looseness in carburetor body. IMPORTANT: DO NOT remove throttle valves. If any of the throttle parts or float bowl/carburetor body shaft bores are found to be worn or damaged, carburetor replacement is required. h. Choke valve and shaft/lever assembly - Check shaft and lever for excessive looseness in air horn. Check choke valve and shaft/lever assembly for binding through entire operating range. Air horn assembly must be replaced if choke valve and shaft/lever are worn. 5. Check that choke pull-off diaphragm plunger retracts when vacuum is applied to unit, and that it holds vacuum (plunger remains seated if vacuum is maintained).
Index
Page 5C-32 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Reassembly
1. Install mixture screws (needles) with springs in place. Turn idle mixture screws in (clockwise) until LIGHTLY seated, then loosen 1-1/4 turns if previous settings were not noted on disassembly. IMPORTANT: Do not turn idle mixture screws tightly against seat, as damage to seat and/or needle may result.
b
a - Idle Mixture Screw b - Spring, Idle Mixture Screw 2. Install the primary and secondary jets. Tighten securely.
70467
IMPORTANT: Be sure that primary and secondary jets are installed in the appropriate location. Be sure that the size matches the same size recorded during disassembly.
70466
a - Primary Fuel Jet b - Secondary Fuel Jet 3. Install the float bowl baffle plates, if previously removed.
70465
a - Baffle Plate
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-33
4. Into bore beneath pump jet housing location, install check-ball and then check-weight or, if so equipped, check-ball and check-spring. IMPORTANT: If your carburetor had a ball and weight combination, replace with ball and weight. If your carburetor used a ball and spring combination, replace with ball and spring.
b
70463
c b
70464
a b c d
70462
Index
Page 5C-34 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
70461
a - Pump Jet Housing 7. Install two screws that secure pump jet housing. Tighten securely.
b
70460
a - Screws b - Pump Jet Housing 8. Install the secondary air valve and weight assembly.
70459
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-35
IMPORTANT: Before installing venturi clusters, it is important to note which clusters were equipped with a distribution tab. This distribution tab arrangement varies from one carburetor to another.
70452
a - Distribution Tab(s) Location And Total Number May Vary 9. Position the secondary venturi cluster gaskets.
70458
a - Gasket, Secondary Venturi Cluster 10. Install the secondary venturi clusters.
70457
Index
Page 5C-36 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
b
a - Screws (Two On Each Side) b - Secondary Venturi Cluster(s) 12. Position the primary venturi cluster gaskets.
70456
70455
a - Gasket, Primary Venturi Cluster 13. Install the primary venturi clusters.
a a
70454
a - Gasket, Primary Venturi Cluster (One Not Visible In This View) b - Primary Venturi Cluster
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-37
70453
a - Screws (Two Each Side) b - Primary Venturi Cluster(s) 15. Install the accelerator pump spring into bottom half of carburetor.
b
a - Accelerator Pump Spring b - Carburetor Bottom
70451
Index
Page 5C-38 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
16. Install accelerator pump in top of carburetor housing, after placing washer and guide in position.
70450
a - Accelerator Pump b - Plunger Guide c - Plunger Washer (Not Visible In This View) 17. Connect accelerator pump lever to pump rod using the S-link. 18. Secure pump lever with pivot screw. Tighten securely. Check to ensure lever actuates the accelerator pump.
c d
a
a b c d
70449
70448
Index
a - Gasket
Page 5C-39
20. Install inlet filter in bottom of inlet seat. 21. Install inlet seat with gasket in place. Tighten securely.
a b c
70447
a - Seat b - Gasket c - Inlet Filter IMPORTANT: If using existing needles and seats, be sure to reinstall them as matched sets, as noted during disassembly. 22. Install appropriate inlet needles into inlet seats.
70401
b
70446
Index
Page 5C-40
IMPORTANT: If using existing floats, be sure to reinstall them on the same side as removed. 23. Install floats using hinge pins.
b b
a
a - Pin(s) b - Floats(s)
70400
70399
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-41
25. Ensure gasket is properly positioned between the two parts and secure the top to bottom with screws (nine total). Tighten securely.
a
a - Screw(s)
70398
70397
a - Spring(s) IMPORTANT: If using existing metering rods, be sure that they are reinstalled in the same side from which removed during disassembly. 26. Carefully install metering rod assemblies in the appropriate holes. Push down lightly on metering rods to ensure that plunger will spring up and down.
70396
a - Metering Rod Assembly(s) IMPORTANT: Some carburetors are equipped with air deflectors that are attached to the screw that holds down the metering rod covers. Be sure to reinstall the deflectors if your model carburetor requires them.
Index
Page 5C-42 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
27. Position metering rod covers (and air deflectors, if equipped) over metering rods and install screws. Tighten securely.
c a b
71094
71095
a - Screws b - Metering Cover(s) c - Air Deflectors (If Equipped) 28. Reconnect accelerator pump linkage rod to hole in accelerator pump lever where originally connected. Secure using wire clip.
a b
70390
a - Accelerator Pump Linkage Rod b - Wire Clip 29. Connect electric choke link rod to choke plate lever. Secure using wire clip. 30. Refer to Installation and install carburetor.
Installation
1. Place appropriate new gasket on intake manifold. 2. If equipped, install adaptor or wedge plate, depending on model. Place appropriate new gasket on top.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-43
3. Install carburetor and throttle bracket with attaching hardware. Torque fasteners to 132 lb-in. (15 Nm).
b a
75862 75863
Index
Page 5C-44 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
4. Install fuel line. To prevent over-tightening, hold fuel inlet filter nut with suitable wrench and tighten fuel line connector securely.
b a
b
75862
a - Fuel Line b - Fuel Line Connector c - Fuel Inlet Filter Nut 5. Refer to SECTION 2. Install and adjust throttle cable following instructions appropriate to your power package. 6. Install flame arrestor and tighten nut securely. 7. Installing positive battery cable to positive (+) battery terminal. Tighten clamp securely. 8. Install negative battery cable to negative () battery terminal. Tighten clamp securely. 9. Turn on fuel supply at fuel tank. 10. Start engine and check for gasoline leaks. If leaks exist, STOP ENGINE IMMEDIATELY and recheck connections. 11. Adjust idle speed and idle mixture, as previously outlined under Adjustments.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-45
Index
Page 5C-46 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5C-47
Index
Page 5C-48 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
FUEL SYSTEM
Section 5D - Sav1 Emission Fuel System With Weber 4 Barrel Carburetor
Table of Contents
Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Replacement Parts Warning . . . . . . . . . . Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Carburetor Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . Carburetor Adjustment Specifications . . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Special Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Carburetor Top Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sealed Idle Mixture Screws . . . . . . . . Piston Bore of Emissions Model . . . . Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Flame Arrestor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) 5D-2 5D-2 5D-2 5D-2 5D-3 5D-3 5D-4 5D-4 5D-5 5D-5 5D-5 5D-6 5D-6 5D-7 5D-7 5D-7 5D-8 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Ported Vacuum Switch and Carburetor Vacuum Circuit for Correct Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . Service Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) Valve . . . . . . . . . . . Removing Seals From Idle Mixture Screws . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installing New Seals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Carburetor Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ported Vacuum Switch Installation . . Emissions System Connections . . . . Propane Assisted Idle Set Procedure Test Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Emissions Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5D-8 5D-9 5D-11 5D-11 5D-11 5D-12 5D-12 5D-13 5D-13 5D-15 5D-18 5D-19
5
D
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-1
Identification
The SAV1 Emissions version of the Weber WFB carburetor has vacuum fittings on the front side.
a
a - Vacuum Fittings
73701
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Carburetor to Manifold Fuel Line to Carburetor Fuel Inlet Filter Nut lb-in. 132 lb-ft 18 18 Nm 15 24 24
Special Tools
Mercury Marine Special Tools Description Universal Carburetor Gauge Tachometer Part Number 91-36392 91-59339
Index
Page 5D-2 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
Other Special Tools Description Universal Carburetor Stand TORX Screwdrivers (15, 20 & 25) Propane Bottle [14 oz. (400 grams)] Propane Enrichment Kit (Various Suppliers) Ported Vacuum Switch (PVS) Socket Wrench (Various Suppliers) Special Tool Suppliers: (1) Kent-Moore Part Number (2) Snap-On Part Number (3) OTC Part Number NOTE: Weber carburetors will have a star shaped socket in the head of some screws. A TORX screwdriver must be used on this type of screw. The sizes used are numbers 15, 20 and 25. (1) J26911 (2) YA7148 (3) 7148 (1) No P/N (2) S9842A (3) 7267 Obtain Locally Part Number
Engine Specifications
Model Thermostat Ignition Timing Idle Speed in Neutral Propane Idle Speed (See Procedure) MCM 4.3LH 160F (71C) 10 BTDC 775 rpm 850 rpm
Carburetor Specifications
NOTICE Unit Of Measurement: U.S. Inches (Millimeters) All measurements are +/ 1/64 in. (0.4 mm) Mercury Number (Manufacturer Number) 3310-860076 (9667S) Metering Rod Number Metering Rod Spring Color Natural
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-3
Description
The Emissions system is designed to lower exhaust emissions to meet regulations. It consists of the following items: a Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) circuit, a Ported Vacuum Switch (PVS) circuit and a specially designed Weber WFB carburetor. Weber WFB carburetor is unique in design, as the main body and flange are cast as a one piece unit. This, along with the bowl cover, make up the two piece construction which is made of light, durable aluminum to dissipate heat. There are two separate float circuits. Each float circuit supplies fuel to a primary low speed circuit and a primary and secondary high speed circuit. The bowls are vented to the inside of the air horn. A connecting vent passage effects a balance of the air pressure between the two bowls. The float needle valves are installed at an angle to provide the best possible seating action on the needles. This provides better needle response to float movement, also. The PVS circuit is used in conjunction with the idle circuit. When the engine is cold, the PVS circuit is closed. This shuts off a metered air-bleed to the idle circuit, to maintain a rich idle circuit for warm-up. Once the engine warms up [approximately 128F (54C)], the PVS opens, allowing a metered amount of air to be mixed into the idle circuit. This leans the idle circuit to the proper operating air-fuel ratio. The high speed circuits use staged step-up rods in the main metering jets to control the amount of fuel admitted to the nozzles. The position of the step-up rod is controlled by manifold vacuum applied to the vacuum piston. A primary air bleed located in the venturi cluster prevents a rich condition or bog as the high speed circuit is reactivated after deceleration. Small L shaped metal tabs, called distribution tab(s), are attached to some venturi clusters and protrude into the air stream at the proper location to aid distribution of fuel on selected applications. The PCV circuit ventilates crankcase vapors (unburned gases) back into the intake manifold to be burned again.
Index
Page 5D-4 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
Special Notes
IMPORTANT: Disassembly and repair of the SAV1 Emissions carburetor is basically the same as the other Weber WFB carburetors. There are some internal and external differences that are noted following:
a
a - Vacuum Fittings
73701
a
Typical a - Screw Seals
71798
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-5
73737
Precautions
WARNING
Always disconnect battery cables from battery BEFORE working on fuel system to prevent fire or explosion.
WARNING
Be careful when cleaning flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hose: gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark or open flame in area when cleaning flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hose.
WARNING
Be careful when changing fuel system components: gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark or open flame in area while changing fuel filter. Wipe up any spilled fuel immediately.
WARNING
Make sure no fuel leaks exist, before closing engine hatch.
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without cooling water being supplied to water pickup holes in gear housing or water pickup inlet, or water pump impeller will be damaged and subsequent overheating damage to engine may result.
Index
Page 5D-6 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
Maintenance
Flame Arrestor
Maintenance for the flame arrestor is the same as standard engine (Refer to SECTION 5C). The only difference in the flame arrestor on an engine with the Bodensee Emissions system is in the vent hose bracket. This bracket has a fitting on one side only.
71798
71797
a b c d
- Stud - Vent Hose Bracket - Vent Hose To Starboard Valve Cover - NO VENT HOSE ON THIS SIDE
Fuel Filter
Maintenance for fuel inlet filters is the same as standard engine (See SECTION 5C.).
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-7
a
71925
Troubleshooting
NOTE: Review the Description section of this manual for an understanding of system operation, before troubleshooting the carburetor. Do not assume that a problem exists inside the carburetor without first eliminating other engine system components as potential problem areas. Be sure to check the following items: Engine operating temperature (Proper Thermostat - See Engine Specification Chart). Correct ignition timing (See Engine Specification Chart). Cylinder compression. Ported Vacuum Switch (PVS) functioning properly.
Use the following procedure to check for a faulty Ported Vacuum Switch (PVS):
Index
Page 5D-8 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
Checking Ported Vacuum Switch and Carburetor Vacuum Circuit for Correct Operation
NOTE: The engine must be cold before performing the first 4 steps. 1. Start engine. Disconnect the hose from the carburetor at the location shown.
73733
2. Plug the hose with your finger. You should not feel vacuum on the hose at this time.
73734
3. Allow engine to run and warm up to normal operating temperature. 4. Disconnect the hose again and check for vacuum. If PVS is functioning properly, there should be vacuum present at this time. If vacuum is not present, ensure that hoses are properly connected and are not cracked or plugged. 5. Proceed to check the carburetor vacuum circuit. 6. Reconnect rear hose to carburetor. NOTE: The engine must be warm before performing the next step. 7. Start engine and allow it to reach normal operating temperature.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-9
73738
IMPORTANT: Ensure that engine is running at 775 rpm or below. This ensures that the carburetor is not running on the Off-Idle circuit. 9. Connect a tachometer to the engine. 10. Plug the vacuum ports on the front of the carburetor. Be sure to only plug one port at a time. When vacuum port is covered, the engine rpm should increase. 11. Repeat test on the other port. If vacuum is not present, a vacuum port may be plugged. Clean vacuum ports and repeat the entire test.
73740
73739
12. When test is complete and PVS is determined to be functioning properly, reconnect all hoses in vacuum circuit.
Index
Page 5D-10 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
Service Procedures
Checking Positive Crankcase Ventilation (PCV) Valve
1. Start engine and allow it to reach normal operating temperature. 2. Remove PCV valve from valve cover. Plug the opening with your finger. A vacuum should be felt. 3. Stop the engine. 4. Shake the valve to ensure that the internal components are free to move.
73743
WARNING
Avoid fire or explosion. Using a cutting wheel to cut the seals will cause sparks, which will ignite any fuel that is present. Ensure that there is no fuel present and that carburetor is removed from engine prior to cutting the seals from the carburetor idle mixture screws. 1. Remove carburetor from the engine. 2. Drain all fuel from the carburetor. 3. Using a cutting wheel, make a cut on both sides of the seal casing. 4. Using a suitable device, pry the plug from the inside of the seal. Once the plug is removed, the idle mixture screw can be removed and the seal casing can be removed.
a
a - Cutting Wheel
73744
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-11
a b
a - Opening In Plug b - Tab On Cup
73789
Carburetor Installation
1. Place new gasket on adapter plate. 2. Install carburetor and throttle bracket and secure with new attaching hardware. Torque fasteners to 132 lb-in. (15 Nm). 3. Connect fuel line. To prevent over-tightening, hold fuel inlet nut with a suitable wrench and tighten fuel line connector securely.
a b
75862
75863
Weber 4 Barrel Starboard Front a - Fuel Line b - Attaching Hardware c - Throttle Bracket
Index
Page 5D-12 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
CAUTION
Be careful not to break off fittings when installing the ported vacuum switch (PVS) in the following step. NOTE: A special tool is available to install the PVS. Refer to the Tool Chart at the beginning of this manual. 1. If removed, install ported vacuum switch (PVS) into reducer bushing. Apply Loctite Pipe Sealant with Teflon to threads before installing. Tighten PVS securely and position the fittings toward back of engine as shown.
b a
a - Reducer Bushing b - Ported Vacuum Switch (PVS)
71913
a
71925
73701
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-13
c c d a
71924
d b
73702
a
a b c d - Ported Vacuum Switch - Hoses (Switch To Y-Fitting) - Hoses (To Front Side Of Carburetor) - Hose (Y-Fitting To Back Side Of Carburetor)
IMPORTANT: The hose that runs from the T-Fitting to the back side of the carburetor must be routed beneath the throttle linkage as shown in the following illustration. Ensure that the hose does not rub against linkage.
b a
71916
71917
Index
Page 5D-14 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
WARNING
Avoid fire or explosion. Observe the following precautions when performing this procedure. Do not operate the engine without the flame arrestor installed, above the speeds listed in this procedure. Propane is extremely flammable and explosive. Ensure that the following test is performed in a well ventilated area with the engine hatch open. Ensure that there is no spark or open flame in the test area. Do not start the flow of propane until the hose has been placed into the carburetor and the engine has been started. Keep a fire extinguisher available when performing this test.
NOTE: This test must be performed any time the carburetor has been disassembled and internal components have been disturbed or the idle mixture screws have been tampered with. The test should also be performed if other component parts of the emissions system have been altered, repaired or replaced. IMPORTANT: Ensure that the PVS is functioning properly before performing this procedure. 1. As a starting point, set both idle mixture screws at 1 turn out from the fully seated position. 2. Start engine and allow it to warm up to normal operating temperature. If engine has been run above idle speed, allow engine to idle for 3 to 5 minutes to stabilize the engine. 3. Remove flame arrestor. 4. Insert special Y-Adapter hoses into carburetor as shown. Place the hoses behind the choke plate to help hold them in place.
73731
5. Connect the hose from the propane bottle valve to the Y-Fitting.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-15
6. With engine idling at normal operating temperature, press the propane flow button on the valve. Slowly begin opening the propane metering valve until maximum engine rpm is reached. When too much propane is added, engine rpm will decrease. Fine tune the metering valve to obtain the highest rpm.
b
a - Propane Flow Valve b - Propane Metering Valve
73673
7. With propane still flowing, adjust the idle speed screw (not the mixture screws) to obtain 850 rpm. Again, fine tune the propane metering valve to obtain the highest engine rpm. If there has been a change in the maximum rpm, readjust the idle speed screw to 850 rpm. 8. Release the propane flow valve and allow engine speed to stabilize. Slowly adjust the mixture screws by equal amounts, pausing between adjustments to allow engine speed to stabilize, to achieve 775 rpm.
73722
Index
Page 5D-16 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
9. Press the propane flow valve. Engine rpm should increase to 850 rpm. If it does not, repeat steps 5 through 7.
73662
10. If after performing the above procedure several times, the correct results can still not be obtained, check the following: PVS not working properly. Incorrect float level. Vacuum leaks.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-17
11. Once the idle speed and mixture adjustment is correct, install the seal plugs over mixture screws. Ensure the opening in plug snaps into the tab in the cup.
c b
73789
71798
a - Screw Seal b - Tab In Cup c - Opening In Cup 12. Reinstall the flame arrestor.
Test Equipment
The following equipment, provided by the Dealer or Inspector, is needed to perform an emissions test on this engine: Test Probes. Test Probe Collector. Exhaust System Analyzer.
b a
73723
Index
Page 5D-18 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
Emissions Testing
b a
71926
a - Exhaust Test Probes (2) b - Exhaust Elbow Adapter Fittings (2) 1. Remove plugs from both exhaust elbows.
75319
Typical a - Plugs (Port And Starboard Elbows) 2. Install exhaust elbow adapter fittings into elbows. Apply Loctite Pipe Sealant with Teflon to threads that go into elbow. Tighten securely.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-19
75319
b
71923
75324
Index
Page 5D-20 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
4. When exhaust emissions test is complete, remove test probes and adapter fittings and reinstall the plugs. Apply Perfect Seal to threads before installing. Torque to 150 lb-in. (17 Nm). NOTICE to INSTALLER Your engine is equipped with special design features and special tuning to minimize emission output from the engine. You should follow: Recommended maintenance schedules particularly the ignition system Proper engine tuning procedures to ensure these features remain in good operating order. Proper steps to maintain the engine within specification.
The instructions in the Emissions Kit provide the necessary information to properly convert the engine to meet the applicable SAV1 Regulations. There is another item within the regulation that is beyond the control of Mercury Marine. This item is related to the fuel filling system on the boat. The requirements for the fuel filler neck are as follows: Must be designed so that it is impossible to use a fuel nozzle with an outside diameter of more than 23.6 mm. The filler neck shall be durable and designed so that modifications are not possible. A durable, legible plate shall be mounted on the boat near the fuel filler neck. This plate shall read UNLEADED GASOLINE ONLY.
Any questions about the fuel filler neck requirement and availability would be directed to the boat manufacturer.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5D-21
Index
Page 5D-22 90-861328-1 NOVEMBER 1999
FUEL SYSTEM
Section 5E - Fuel Delivery System For Electronic Fuel Injection
Table of Contents
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Replacement Parts Warning . . . . . . . . . . Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Supply Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fuel Delivery System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cool Fuel System Exploded View . . . . . Fuel System Flow Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . Throttle Body Injection . . . . . . . . . . . . 5E-2 5E-2 5E-2 5E-2 5E-2 5E-3 5E-3 5E-4 5E-4 5E-5 5E-6 5E-6 Water Separating Fuel Filter . . . . . . . . . . Water Separating Fuel Filter Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cool Fuel System Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Vacuum and Vent Hose Routing . . . . . . . Throttle Body EFI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5E-7 5E-8 5E-8 5E-8 5E-10 5E-11 5E-13 5E-15 5E-15
5
E
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5E-1
Specifications
Description Pump Pressure Specification
30 PSI (207 kPa)
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Fuel Lines Fuel Fittings lb-in. lb-ft 18 Nm 24
See Note
Tools
Description Fuel Pressure Gauge Part Number Obtain Locally
Index
Page 5E-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Precautions
WARNING
Always disconnect battery cables from battery BEFORE working on fuel system to prevent fire or explosion.
WARNING
BE CAREFUL while working on fuel system; gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark and/or open flames in the area. Wipe up any spilled fuel immediately.
WARNING
Make sure that no fuel leaks exist before closing engine hatch.
WARNING
Avoid Fire or Explosion: Fuel injection system is pressurized during operation. Use care when removing water separating fuel filter. Fuel could spray on hot engine causing fire or explosion. Allow engine to cool down before attempting to remove the water separating fuel filter in the following procedure. Also, hold a clean shop towel over the water separating fuel filter when removing it to help avoid fuel spraying on the engine.
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without water flowing through seawater pickup pump, as pump impeller may be damaged and subsequent overheating damage to engine or sterndrive unit may result.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5E-3
WARNING
Boating standards (NMMA, ABYC, etc.) and Coast Guard regulations must be adhered to when installing fuel delivery system. The Fuel Tank is an integrated component of the boat. Refer to the special information on service and maintenance, which you have received from the tank or boat manufacturer. All fuel lines must be well secured. The holes where the lines run through the bulkheads should be carefully rounded off or protected with rubber grommets. This prevents damage to the lines from abrasion. The following, but not limited to the following, additional fuel connection related points, applying to all engines unless otherwise stated, must be considered. Refer to boating standards (NMMA, ABYC, etc.) and Coast Guard regulations for complete guidelines. 1. Fuel pickup should be at least 1 in. (25mm) from the bottom of fuel tank to prevent picking up impurities. 2. Fuel lines used must be Coast Guard approved (USCG Type A1). 3. On Multi-Engine Gasoline Installations: It is best to use a fuel pickup and supply line for each engine. If a single pickup and line is used, line must not be smaller than 1/2 in. (13mm) I.D. 4. Larger diameter (than previously specified) lines and fittings must be used on installations requiring long lines or numerous fittings. 5. Fuel line(s) should be installed free of stress and firmly secured to prevent vibration and/ or chafing. 6. Sharp bends in fuel lines should be avoided. 7. A flexible fuel line must be used to connect fuel supply line to fuel inlet fitting on engine to absorb deflection when engine is running.
Index
Page 5E-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
1 24 2 3 6 4 23 9 10 5 23 22 12 13 14 12 11 7 8
16 15 18 20 19 17 21
75708
Exploded View Component List 1 - Bracket 2 - Cover Base 3 - Screw and Washer (2) 4 - Fuel Pressure Regulator 5 - Return Fuel Line 6 - Retaining Ring 7 - O-Rings (2) 8 - Fuel Line To Throttle Body 9 - Gasket 10 - Drain Plug 11 - Stepped Screw 12 - O-Rings (4) 13 - Elbow 14 - Fuel Cooler 15 - Fuel Pump Wiring Harness 16 - Retainer Bracket 17 - Nut (2) 18 - Electric Fuel Pump 19 - Inlet Fitting 20 - Fuel Line Inlet 21 - Cover 22 - Filter 23 - Seawater Hoses (Hose Clamps Not Shown) 24 - Vacuum Hose
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5E-5
i a c g
d f
74871
All Throttle Body Fuel Injection Is Similar a - Diaphragm Rupture Line To Flame Arrestor b - Fuel Pressure Regulator c - Fuel Cooler d - Electric Fuel Pump e - Water Separating Fuel Filter f - Fuel From Tank g - Direction Of Water Flow h - Throttle Body Unit i - Fuel Line To Throttle Body j - Excess Fuel Return To Water Separating Fuel Filter
Index
Page 5E-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
c b d g e f h j
l
a b c d e f g h i j k l - Top Cover (If Equipped) - Insulator Plate - Fuel Return Line from Regulator - Brass Fitting - Fuel Line to Fuel Pump - Brass Fitting - Fuel Filter Mounting Bracket - Nut - Fuel Inlet Fitting - Plug - Water Separating Fuel Filter - Bottom Cover (If Equipped)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5E-7
CAUTION
If boat is to remain in the water, the seacock, if equipped, must remain closed until engine is to be restarted to prevent water from flowing back into seawater cooling system. If boat is not fitted with a seacock, water inlet hose must be disconnected and plugged to prevent water from flowing into cooling system and/or boat. As a precautionary measure, attach a tag to the ignition switch or steering wheel with the warning that the seacock must be opened or the water inlet hose reconnected prior to starting the engine 3. Close seacock, if equipped. If boat is not equipped with a seacock, remove and plug the seawater inlet hose. 4. Drain seawater system. Refer to SECTION 1B. 5. Disconnect seawater hoses from fuel cooler.
Index
Page 5E-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
75533
a - Filter Adapter b - Fuel Lines 7. Disconnect the fuel line from the throttle body. 8. Remove the cover from the cool fuel system. 9. Disconnect the fuel pump electrical connector. 10. Disconnect the vacuum hose connected to the pressure regulator. 11. Remove the two upper engine mount bracket nuts retaining fuel cooler bracket to the engine. 12. Carefully remove the cool fuel system assembly.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5E-9
Disassembly
NOTE: Retain all fasteners and hardware unless instructed otherwise. 1. Remove the two nuts from the Cool Fuel retaining bracket studs. Lift the retainer bracket and cooler/pump assembly from the cover base. IMPORTANT: To prevent loss of the stepped screw used to secure the cooler-tothrottle body fuel line, a retainer ring is provided. Do not remove the retainer or stepped screw.
b a b c d
a b c d e f
75708
e c f
75708
- Fuel Line O-Rings - Fuel Line, Cooler-to-Throttle Body - Fuel Cooler - Stepped Screw - Loosened To Accept Fuel Line - Retainer Ring - Stepped Screw - Torqued
2. Disconnect the fuel lines from the assembly. 3. Disconnect the elbow fitting and fuel pump from the cooler assembly. 4. Remove the elbow fitting from the fuel pump (to allow replacement of O-rings during assembly). 5. Remove the two screws retaining the fuel pressure regulator to the fuel cooler. 6. Remove the regulator. 7. Remove and retain the seawater drain plug and seal from the cooler.
Index
Page 5E-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Reassembly
1. Install the small filter (conical side DOWN) in the orifice of the new fuel cooler where the fuel pressure regulator mounts. 2. Install the regulator onto the cooler using the two screws with washers. Torque the screws to 53 lb-in. ( 5.8 Nm). 3. Using wrench to stabilize the fitting, connect the fuel line to the regulator. Tighten securely.
d e c
a b a
75708
a b c d e
- Filter - Fuel Cooler Orifice - Pressure Regulator - Screw and Washer - Fuel Line
4. Install the throttle body fuel line as follows: a. Install two (of six) O-rings onto the cooler-to-throttle body fuel line where it attaches to the cooler, if not already present. b. Completely loosen, but do NOT remove, the stepped screw that retains the fuel line. c. Lubricate the two fuel line O-rings with a small amount of liquid dish soap (obtain locally). d. Insert the fuel line into the cooler orifice. Hand tighten the special screw. e. Torque the stepped screw to 81 lb-in. (9 Nm).
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5E-11
IMPORTANT: To prevent loss of the stepped screw used to secure the cooler-tothrottle body fuel line, a retainer ring is provided. Do not remove the retainer or stepped screw.
b a b c d
a b c d e f g
75708
e c f
75708
- Fuel Line O-Rings - Fuel Line, Cooler-to-Throttle Body - Fuel Cooler - Stepped Screw - Loosened To Accept Fuel Line - Retainer Ring - Stepped Screw - Torqued - Retainer Ring
5. Install the fuel pump to the cooler as follows: a. Install the remaining four (of six) O-rings on the fuel pump / cooler elbow fitting as shown. b. Lubricate O-rings for the elbow fitting with a small amount of liquid dish soap (obtain locally). c. Install the elbow in the fuel pump. d. Install the fuel pump with elbow fitting in the cooler assembly.
d c b
75708
a b c d
Index
Page 5E-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
6. Position the completed fuel cooler assembly in the cover base. 7. Apply a thin, even coating of Thermal Grease on all of the retainer bracket inside surfaces where it contacts the cooler and the fuel pump when installed.
b a
a - Retainer Bracket b - Thermal Grease 8. Install the retainer bracket over the cooler and fuel pump. Apply Loctite 242 to the threads of the mounting studs. Torque the two nuts to 50 lb-in. (5.6 Nm). 9. Install and securely tighten the seawater drain plug.
Installation
1. If removed, reinstall the fuel filter assembly and secure using the two self locking nuts. Tighten securely. 2. Using wrench to stabilize brass filter nut, connect the fuel lines to the fuel filter adapter. Tighten securely.
75533
a - Filter Assembly b - Fuel Lines c - Lock Nuts 3. Route the fuel lines as needed and place the Cool Fuel assembly on the engine mount studs. Install the two engine mounting nuts. Torque to 30 lb-ft (41 Nm). 4. Install the cooler-to-throttle body fuel line as follows: a. Route the fuel line to the back side of engine.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5E-13
b. Using wrench to stabilize brass filter nut, connect the fuel line to the throttle body fitting at location shown. Tighten securely.
a
75806
a - Fuel Line, Fuel Cooler-to-Throttle Body b - Fuel Fitting 5. Install distributor cap (if removed). 6. Connect vacuum line to fuel pressure regulator. 7. Attach engine harness electrical connector to fuel pump harness connector.
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without cooling water being supplied to seawater pickup pump, or pump impeller will be damaged and subsequent overheating damage may result. 8. Connect seawater hoses to Cool Fuel system. Tighten hose clamps securely. 9. Unplug and connect seawater inlet hose. Open seacock, if equipped. 10. Unplug and connect fuel tank supply inlet hose. Tighten hose clamp securely. Open fuel shutoff valve, if equipped.
CAUTION
When installing battery, be sure to connect POSITIVE (+) battery cable to POSITIVE (+) battery terminal FIRST, and NEGATIVE () battery cable to NEGATIVE () battery terminal LAST. If battery cables are reversed, or connection order is reversed, electrical system damage will result. 11. Clean battery cable clamps and terminals and reconnect cables (see CAUTION listed above). Secure each cable clamp when connecting. Coat terminals with a battery terminal anti-corrosion spray to help retard corrosion. 12. Start the engine and check for fuel and water leaks. Stop the engine immediately if any leaks exist. Make necessary corrections. 13. Install cool fuel system cover.
WARNING
Make sure no leaks exist before closing engine hatch.
Index
Page 5E-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
i h
f g
a - Throttle Body b - Cool Fuel Assembly c - Diaphragm Rupture Hose - Fuel Pressure Regulator on Cool Fuel Assembly To Side of Flame Arrestor d - Vent Hose - PCV Valve to Flame Arrestor e - PCV Valve f - Vent Hose - Valve Cover Fitting To Throttle Body g - Valve Cover Fitting h - Flame Arrestor i - Front of Engine
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5E-15
Index
Page 5E-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
FUEL SYSTEMS
Section 5F - Fuel Injection Descriptions And System Operation
Table of Contents
Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Service Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Visual/Physical Inspection . . . . . . . . . Basic Knowledge and Tools Required Electrostatic Discharge Damage . . . . Diagnostic Information . . . . . . . . . . . . Wiring Harness Service . . . . . . . . . . . Wiring Connector Service . . . . . . . . . . Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ECM Self-Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostic Code Tool With Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . Intermittent Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reading Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Scan Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . EFI Diagnostic Circuit Check . . . . . . . Scan Tool Use With Intermittents . . . Non-Scan Diagnosis of Driveability Concerns (With No Codes Set) . . . . 5F-2 5F-3 5F-5 5F-5 5F-5 5F-5 5F-5 5F-5 5F-6 5F-7 5F-8 5F-9 5F-9 5F-9 5F-10 5F-11 5F-11 5F-11 5F-12 Electronic Control Module (ECM) and Sensors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Computers and Voltage Signals . . . . Analog Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Digital Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Control Module (ECM) . . . . . . Speed Density System . . . . . . . . . . . . ECM Input and Sensor Descriptions . Spark Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . High Energy Ignition with Ignition Control (IC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Modes Of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Base Ignition Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Base Ignition Timing (Continued) . . . Results of Incorrect Operation . . . . . . Fuel Metering System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cool Fuel Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Modes of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Throttle Body Injection Components . 5F-13 5F-13 5F-13 5F-13 5F-14 5F-15 5F-16 5F-17 5F-22 5F-22 5F-23 5F-24 5F-25 5F-25 5F-26 5F-26 5F-26 5F-26 5F-28
5 F
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-1
Special Tools
Part Number J-34029-A (Note 1 and 2) Tool Name High Impedance Multimeter (DVM) Vacuum Pump with Gauge - 20 In. Hg Minimum Unpowered Test Light Injector Harness Test Light Harness Test Adapter MerCruiser Scan Tool Version 3.4 (English) Code Mate Tester Timing Light Fuel Pressure Gauge Kit Quicksilver Digital Diagnostic Terminal (DDT) Description Minimum 10 megohm input impedance required on all voltage ranges. As ammeter, accurately measures low value current flow. As ohmmeter, reads 0-200 ohms, 2/20/200 k, 2/20 m. Gauge monitors manifold engine vacuum. Hand pump used to check fuel pressure regulator. Used to check circuit wiring, short to ground or voltage. Visually indicates injector electrical impulses from the ECM. Allows multi-meter connections with wiring harness. Displays problem codes stored in the ECM. It also allows monitoring of various circuits and components in the fuel injection system. Allows for test firing injectors. Tool can read MEFI 1 and MEFI 3 ECM. Flashes light to display problem codes. Used to check ignition timing. Must have inductive signal pickup. Used to check fuel system pressure. Kit includes 91-803135 Test Port Adaptor Kit and 91-806901 TBI Pressure Valve. Displays problem codes stored in the ECM. It also allows monitoring of various circuits and components in the fuel injection system. Displays problem codes stored in the ECM. It also allows monitoring of various circuits and components in the fuel injection system. Tool can read MEFI 1 and MEFI 3 ECM. Displays problem codes stored in the ECM. It also allows monitoring of various circuits and components in the fuel injection system. Used to set Ignition timing. Plug connects to DLC. Used to perform fuel system pressure test. Allows connection of Fuel Pressure Gauge.
94050m
91-823686A2
91-803999
84-822560A2
DDT Adaptor Harness EFI Timing Tool Fuel Shutoff Tool Fuel Line Connector
Index
Page 5F-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Service Precautions
The following requirements must be observed: Before removing any ECM system component, disconnect the negative battery cable. Never start the engine without the battery being solidly connected. Never separate the battery from the on-board electrical system while the engine is running. Never separate the battery feed wire from the charging system while the engine is running. When charging the battery, disconnect it from the boats electrical system. Ensure that all cable harnesses are connected solidly and that battery connections are thoroughly clean. Never connect or disconnect the wiring harness at the ECM when the ignition is switched ON. Before attempting any electric arc welding, disconnect the battery leads and the ECM connector(s). When steam cleaning engines, do not direct the steam cleaning nozzle at ECM system components. If this happens, corrosion of the terminals or damage of components can take place. Use only the test equipment specified in the diagnostic charts, since other test equipment may either give incorrect results or damage good components. All voltage measurements using a voltmeter require a digital voltmeter with a rating of 10 megohms input impedance.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-3
When a test light is specified, a low-power test light must be used. DO NOT use a highwattage test light. While a particular brand of test light is not suggested, a simple test, as shown below, on any test light will ensure it to be safe for system circuit testing. Connect an accurate ammeter (such as the high impedance digital multimeter) in series with the test light being tested, and power the test light ammeter circuit with the vehicle battery.
a - Test Light b - Battery c - Ammeter IMPORTANT: If the ammeter indicates LESS than 3/10 amp. current flow (.3 A or 300 mA), the test light is SAFE to use. If the ammeter indicates MORE than 3/10 amp. current flow (.3 A or 300 mA), the test light is NOT SAFE to use. NOTE: Using a test light with 100 mA or less rating may show a faint glow when test actually states no light. w When using a DVOM to perform voltage measurements, turn the ignition OFF when connecting the DVOM to the circuitry to be tested.
CAUTION
To reduce the chance of personal injury and/or property damage, the following instructions must be carefully observed: proper service and repair are important to the safety of the service technician and the safe, reliable operation of all MerCruiser Electronic Fuel Injection equipped engines. If part replacement is necessary, the part must be replaced with one of the same part number or with an equivalent part. Do not use a replacement part of lesser quality. The service procedures recommended and described in this service manual are effective methods of performing service and repair. Some of these procedures require the use of tools specially designed for the purpose. Accordingly, anyone who intends to use a replacement part, service procedure or tool, which is not recommended by the system manufacturer, must first determine that neither his safety nor the safe operation of the engine will be jeopardized by the replacement part, service procedure or tool selected. It is important to note that this manual contains various Cautions and Notes that must be carefully observed in order to reduce the risk of personal injury during service or repair, or the possibility that improper service or repair may damage the engine or render it unsafe. It is also important to understand that these Cautions and Notes are not exhaustive, because it is impossible to warn of all the possible hazardous consequences that might result from failure to follow these instructions.
Index
Page 5F-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
General Information
Introduction
The following manual has been prepared for effective diagnosis of the MerCruiser Electronic Fuel Injection system. All information, illustrations and specifications contained in this manual are based on the latest product information available at the time of publication approval. The right is reserved to make changes at any time without notice. An understanding of the material contained herein and in subsequent publications issued when necessary, will assist service personnel in properly maintaining the quality to which MerCruiser engine control systems are built.
Visual/Physical Inspection
A careful visual and physical inspection must be performed as part of any diagnostic procedure. This can often lead to fixing a problem without further steps. Inspect all vacuum hoses for correct routing, pinches, cuts, or disconnects. Be sure to inspect hoses that are difficult to see. Inspect all the wires in the engine compartment for proper connections, burned or chafed spots, pinched wires, or contact with sharp edges or hot exhaust manifolds. This visual/physical inspection is very important. It must be done carefully and thoroughly.
Diagnostic Information
The diagnostic charts and functional checks in this manual are designed to locate a faulty circuit or component through logic based on the process of elimination. The charts are prepared with the requirement that the system functioned correctly at the time of assembly and that there are no multiple failures.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-5
73048
3. Splice two wires together using splice clips and rosin core solder.
73048
4. Cover splice with heat shrink sleeve to insulate from other wires.
73048
Index
Page 5F-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-7
Abbreviations
in. hg BARO BAT B+ CKT CONN CYL DEG DIAG DIST DLC DTC DVOM ECM ECT EEPROM HEI EMI ENG GND GPH IAC IAT IC Inches Of Mercury Barometric Pressure Battery Positive Terminal, Battery or System Voltage Battery Positive Circuit Connector Cylinder Degrees Diagnostic Distributor Data Link Connector Diagnostic Trouble Code Digital Volt Ohm Meter Engine Control Module Engine Coolant Temperature Electronic Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory High Energy Ignition Electromagnetic Interference Engine Ground Gallons Per Hour Idle Air Control Intake Air Temperature Ignition Control IGN INJ kPa KS KV MAP MIL mSec N/C N/O PROM RAM REF HI REF LO ROM SLV SW TACH TERM TP V VAC WOT Ignition Injection Kilopascal Knock Sensor System Kilovolts Manifold Absolute Pressure Malfunction Indicator Lamp Millisecond Normally Closed Normally Open Programmable Read Only Memory Random Access Memory Reference High Reference Low Read Only Memory Slave Switch Tachometer Terminal Throttle Position Volts Vacuum Wide Open Throttle
Index
Page 5F-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
ECM Self-Diagnostics
The ECM performs a continual self-diagnosis on certain control functions. This diagnostic capability is complemented by the diagnostic procedures contained in this manual. The ECMs language for communicating the source of a malfunction is a system of diagnostic codes. The codes are two digit numbers that can range from 12 to 51. When a malfunction is detected by the ECM, a code is set and the Malfunction Indicator Lamp is illuminated.
As a bulb and system check, the lamp will come ON with the key on and the engine not running. When the engine is started, the light will turn OFF. If the lamp remains ON, the selfdiagnostic system has detected a problem. If the problem goes away, the light will go out in most cases after ten seconds, but a code will remain stored in the ECM. When the lamp remains ON while the engine is running, or when a malfunction is suspected due to a driveability problem, EFI Diagnostic Circuit Check must be performed. These checks will expose malfunctions which may not be detected if other diagnostics are performed prematurely.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-9
Reading Codes
The provision for communicating with the ECM is the Data Link Connector (DLC) connector. It is part of the EFI engine wiring harness, and is a 10-pin connector, which is electrically connected to the ECM. It is used in the assembly plant to receive information in checking that the engine is operating properly before it leaves the plant. The code(s) stored in the ECMs memory can be read either through a scan tool, (a diagnostic scanner that plugs into the DLC connector), or by counting the number of flashes of the Malfunction Indicator Lamp when the diagnostic code tool is installed and SERVICE mode is selected.
73053
DLC Connector Once the diagnostic code tool has been connected, the ignition switch must be moved to the ON position, with the engine not running. At this point, the Malfunction Indicator Lamp should flash Code 12 three times consecutively. This would be the following flash sequence: flash, pause, flash-flash, long pause, flash, pause, flash-flash, long pause, flash, pause, flash-flash. Code 12 indicates that the ECMs diagnostic system is operating. If Code 12 is not indicated, a problem is present within the diagnostic system itself, and should be addressed by consulting the appropriate diagnostic chart in Diagnostics. Following the output of Code 12, the Malfunction Indicator Lamp will indicate a diagnostic code three times if a code is present, or it will simply continue to output Code 12. If more than one diagnostic code has been stored in the ECMs memory, the codes will be output from the lowest to the highest, with each code being displayed three times. If a scan tool is used to read the codes, follow the manufacturer s instructions. SERVICE MODE When the diagnostic code tool is installed at the Data Link Connector (DLC) and the selector switch is set at SERVICE, the system will enter what is called the SERVICE mode. In this mode the ECM will: 1. Display a Code 12 by flashing the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (indicating the system is operating correctly). 2. Display any stored codes by flashing the Malfunction Indicator Lamp. Each code will be flashed three times, then Code 12 will be flashed again. 3. Holds ignition advance steady. NORMAL MODE Engines can be monitored in the normal mode. Certain parameters can be observed without changing the engine operating characteristics.
Index
Page 5F-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Scan Tools
The ECM can communicate a variety of information through the DLC connector. This data is transmitted at a high frequency which requires a scan tool for interpretation. With an understanding of the data which the tool displays, and knowledge of the circuits involved, the tool can be very useful in obtaining information which would be more difficult or impossible to obtain with other equipment. Scan tools do not make the use of diagnostic charts unnecessary, nor can they indicate exactly where a problem is in a particular circuit. Diagnostic tables incorporate diagnosis procedures using a scan tool where possible or a Diagnostic Code Tool (non-scan) if a scan tool is unavailable.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-11
Index
Page 5F-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Analog Signals
An analog signal is continuously variable. This means that the signal can be any voltage within a certain range. An analog signal usually gives information about a condition that changes continuously over a certain range. For example, in a marine engine, temperature is usually provided by an analog signal. There are two general types of sensors that produce analog signals: the 3-wire and the 2-wire sensor. THREE-WIRE SENSORS (MAP AND TP) The following figure shows a schematic representation of a 3-wire sensor. All 3-wire sensors have a reference voltage, a ground and a variable wiper. The lead coming off of the wiper will be the signal to the Engine Control Module (ECM). As this wiper position changes, the signal voltage returned to the computer also changes.
b c d
3-Wire Sensor a - Typical Sensor b - ECM c - Voltage Out d - Signal Input e - Sensor Ground
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-13
TWO-WIRE SENSOR (ECT) The following figure is the schematic of a 2-wire type sensor. This sensor is basically a variable resistor in series with a fixed-known resistor within the computer. By knowing the values of the input voltage and the voltage drop across the known resistor, the value of the variable resistor can be determined. The variable resistors that are commonly used are called thermistors. A thermistor s resistance varies inversely with temperature.
b a c d e
2-Wire Sensor a - Typical Sensor b - ECM c - Signal Sensor d - 5 Volt e - Sensor Ground
Digital Signals
Digital signals are also variable, but not continuously. They can only be represented by distinct voltages within a range. For example, 1 V, 2 V or 3 V would be allowed, but 1.27 V or 2.65 V would not. Digital signals are especially useful when the information can only refer to two conditions - YES and NO, ON and OFF, or HIGH and LOW. This would be called a digital binary signal. A digital binary signal is limited to two voltage levels. One level is a positive voltage, the other is no voltage (zero volts). As you can see in the following figure, a digital binary signal is a square wave.
d a c
e f
g h b
Index
Page 5F-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
The computer uses digital signals in a code that contains only ones and zeros. The high voltage of the digital signal represents a one (1), and no voltage represents a zero (0). Each zero and each one is called a bit of information, or just a bit. Eight bits together are called a word. A word, therefore, contains some combination of eight binary code bits: eight ones, eight zeros, five ones and three zeros, and so on. Binary code is used inside a computer and between a computer and any electronic device that understands the code. By stringing together thousands of bits, computers can communicate and store an infinite variety of information. To a computer that understands binary, 11001011 might mean that it should reset engine rpm at a lower level. Although the computer uses 8-bit digital codes internally and when talking to another computer, each bit can have a meaning. SWITCH TYPES Switched inputs (also known as discretes) to the computer can cause one bit to change, resulting in information being communicated to the computer. Switched inputs can come in two types: they are pull-up and pull-down types. Both types will be discussed. With a pull-up type switch, the ECM will sense a voltage when the switch is CLOSED. With the pull-down switch, the ECM recognizes the voltage when the switch is OPEN. Discretes can also be used to inform a computer of FREQUENCY information. PULSE COUNTERS For the computer to determine frequency information from a switched input, the computer must measure the time between voltage pulses. As a number of pulses are recorded in a set amount of time, the computer can calculate the frequency. The meaning of the frequency number can have any number of meanings to the computer. An example of a pulse counter type of input is the distributor reference pulse input. The computer can count a train of pulses, a given number of pulses per engine revolution, and determine the rpm of the engine.
72801 76358
MEFI-1 ECM
MEFI-3 ECM
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-15
ECM FUNCTION The ECM supplies 5 or 12 volts to power various sensors or switches. This is done through resistances in the ECM which are so high in value that a test light will not light when connected to the circuit. In some cases, even an ordinary shop voltmeter will not give an accurate reading because its resistance is too low. Therefore, the use of a 10 megohm input impedance digital voltmeter is required to assure accurate voltage readings. MEMORY There are three types of memory storage within the ECM: ROM, RAM and EEPROM. Read Only Memory (ROM) is a permanent memory that is physically soldered to the circuit boards within the ECM. The ROM contains the overall control programs. Once the ROM is programmed, it cannot be changed. The ROM memory is non-erasable, and does not need power to be retained. Random Access Memory (RAM) is the microprocessor scratch pad. The processor can write into, or read from, this memory as needed. This memory is erasable and needs a constant supply of voltage to be retained. Electronic Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory (EEPROM) is the portion of the ECM that contains the different engine calibration information that is specific to each marine application.
Index
Page 5F-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
c d a b f g h e i
q s r
k j
a b c d e f g h i
- System Relay - Distributor For REF rpm - Discrete Switches (Audio Warning) - Knock Module - Knock Sensor - TP - MAP - ECT - IAT
j k l m n o p q r s
- Serial Data - Audio Warning Buzzer - Fuel Injectors - IAC Motor - Ignition Control Module - Fuel Pump Relay - Fuel Pump - Inputs - Outputs - ECM
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-17
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor is a thermistor (a resistor which changes value based on temperature) immersed in the engine coolant stream. Low coolant temperature produces a high resistance, while high temperature causes low resistance.
a c
a - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor b - Harness Connector c - Locking Tab
73052
The ECM supplies a 5 volt signal to the ECT through a resistor in the ECM and measures the voltage. The voltage will be high when the engine is cold, and low when the engine is hot. By measuring the voltage, the ECM knows the engine coolant temperature. Engine coolant temperature affects most systems the ECM controls. A failure in the ECT circuit should set Code 14. Remember, this code indicates a failure in the coolant temperature sensor circuit, so proper use of the chart will lead to either repairing a wiring problem or replacing the sensor. MANIFOLD ABSOLUTE PRESSURE (MAP) SENSOR The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor is a pressure transducer that measures the changes in the intake manifold pressure. The pressure changes as a result of engine load and speed change, and the MAP sensor converts this to a voltage output.
a
73046
a
Earlier Style Later Style a - Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor
A closed throttle on engine coast-down would produce a relatively low MAP output voltage, while a wide open throttle would produce a high MAP output voltage. This high output voltage is produced because the pressure inside the manifold is the same as outside the manifold, so 100% of outside air pressure is measured. When manifold pressure is high, vacuum is low. The MAP sensor is also used to measure barometric pressure under certain conditions, which allows the ECM to automatically adjust for different altitudes. The ECM sends a 5 volt reference signal to the MAP sensor. As the manifold pressure changes, the electrical resistance of the MAP sensor also changes. By monitoring the sensor output voltage, the ECM knows the manifold pressure. A higher pressure, low vacuum (high voltage) requires more fuel, while a lower pressure, higher vacuum (low voltage) requires less fuel. The ECM uses the MAP sensor to control fuel delivery and ignition timing.
Index
Page 5F-18
KNOCK SENSOR
On MEFI 1, the knock sensor is mounted on the lower right side of the engine block. MEFI 3 models do not have a knock sensor module mounted on the engine; it is located internal to the ECM.
73051
When abnormal engine vibrations (spark knock) are present, the sensor produces a voltage signal which is sent to the KS Module and then to the ECM. The ECM uses this signal to aid in calculating ignition timing.
b a
c e
d
Knock Sensor System a - Electronic Control Module (ECM) b - 12 Volts Battery Positive c - 8-12 Volts d - Knock Sensor e - Knock Sensor Module The KS module monitors the knock sensor s AC voltage signal on terminal E. If no spark knock is present, an 8-10 volt signal is sent to the ECM by the KS modules terminal C. If spark knock is present, the module will remove this 8-10 volt signal to the ECM. The ECM will then retard the ignition spark timing to control the spark knock. If the circuit going to the modules E terminal opens or shorts to ground, the KS module cannot remove the 8-10 volt signal to the ECM and no spark retard will occur. The ground circuit for the KS module is connected to terminal D. If this circuit is open, the module cannot remove the 8-10 volt signal to the ECM either and spark knock cannot be controlled.
CAUTION
The correct Knock Sensor and KS module for an engine must be used or a spark knock may not be detected causing sever engine damage.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-19
73049
If the TP circuit is open, the ECM will set a Code 21. If the TP circuit is shorted, and a trouble Code 21 will be set. A problem in any of the TP circuits will set a Code 21. Once a trouble code is set, the ECM will use a default value for TP.
Index
Page 5F-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DISTRIBUTOR REFERENCE (DIST REF) The distributor reference (engine speed signal) is supplied to the ECM by way of the Dist Ref Hi line from the High Energy Ignition (HEI). This pulse counter type input creates the timing signal for the pulsing of the fuel injectors, as well as the Ignition Control (IC) functions. This signal is used for a number of control and testing functions within the ECM. DISCRETE SWITCH INPUTS Several discrete switch inputs are utilized by the system to identify abnormal conditions that may affect engine operation. These switches are used in conjunction with the ECM to detect critical conditions to engine operation. The switches which are used with the fuel injection system to detect critical engine operation parameters are: Switch Oil Pressure Gear Lube Monitor Level on Sterndrive Normal State N/O (With Pressure) N/O (When Full)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-21
Spark Management
High Energy Ignition with Ignition Control (IC)
The Electronic Fuel Injection is controlled by an Engine Control Module (ECM). This module is the nerve/decision center of the system. It uses all the information it gathers to manage ignition spark, delivering increased fuel economy and maximum engine performance. The system uses inputs from sensors to make decisions on the amount of spark advance or retard allowed. The system has been designed to control ignition advance and retard electronically by the ECM. In order for the ECM to properly calculate spark advance, it must always know at what speed the engine is running. The engine speed signal is accomplished by a circuit within the distributor module which converts the pickup coil voltage to a square wave reference signal that can be used by the ECM. This square wave engine speed reference signal is known as REF HI. With MEFI 1, the ECM must also have something to compare the REF HI value against. Therefore, an additional line is provided between the ECM and the distributor module that is known as REF LO. These two lines, between the ECM and the distributor, provide a precise indication of engine speed. With MEFI 1, the two other lines between the ECM and distributor that control the Ignition Control (IC) operation are known as the bypass and IC circuits.
Index
Page 5F-22 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Modes Of Operation
DISTRIBUTOR MODULE MODE (MEFI 1 ONLY) The ignition system operates independent of the ECM. The distributor module module in the distributor maintains a base ignition timing and is able to advance timing to a total of 27 degrees. This mode is in control when a Code 42 is detected while engine is running and will have a noticeable effect on engine operation. The following describes IC operation during cranking and when the engine starts running. To help understand how IC circuits operate, a relay with a double set of contact points is shown in the IC module (refer to the figures Ignition Control Mode and ECM Control Mode). Solid state circuitry is used in the module, but showing the relay makes it easier to visualize how the IC module functions. During cranking, the relay is in the de-energized position (see figure Distributor Module Mode). This connects the pickup coil to the base of the transistor via the signal converter. When the pickup coil applies a positive voltage to the transistor, the transistor turns ON. When voltage is removed, the transistor turns OFF. When the transistor turns ON, current flows through the primary winding of the ignition coil. When it turns OFF, the primary current stops and a spark is developed at the spark plug. A small amount of advance is built into the IC module via a timing circuit, in case the engine remains in the ignition module timing mode. With the relay de-energized, a set of contacts (shown closed) would ground the IC line signal. ECM CONTROL MODE The ECM control mode controls the ignition timing. The ECM calculates the desired ignition timing based on information it gets from its input sensors. (MEFI 1) When the engine rpm reaches a predetermined value (for this example, 300 rpm), the ECM considers the engine running and applies five volts on the bypass line to the IC module. This energizes the relay and causes the contacts from the pickup coil as well as the grounding contacts for the IC line to open (see figure ECM Control Mode). This connects the IC line to the base of the transistor, and bypasses the ignition module timing control. The IC system is now controlled by the IC signal from the ECM and the time at which the spark occurs can be determined by a variable time circuit in the ECM.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-23
f a b
j h i
d l e
k m
o p
f a b
j h i
d e
k l m
q r
Index
Page 5F-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
Open or Grounded REF HI Line - This line provides the ECM with engine speed information. If this line is open or grounded, the ECM will not know that the engine is cranking or running and will not run. Open or Grounded REF LO Line - This wire is grounded in the ignition module and provides a reference ground from the ignition module to the ECM. The ECM compares reference ground with reference high voltage. If this circuit is open, or grounded at any other location than through the module, it may cause poor performance.
Modes of Operation
The ECM looks at voltages from several sensors to determine how much fuel to give the engine. The fuel is delivered under one of several conditions, called modes. All the modes are controlled by the ECM and are described below. STARTING MODE When the ignition switch is turned to the crank position, the ECM turns ON the fuel pump relay and the fuel pump builds up pressure. The ECM then checks the Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor and Throttle Position (TP) sensor and determines the proper air/fuel ratio for starting. The ECM controls the amount of fuel delivered in the starting mode by changing how long the injectors are turned ON and OFF. This is done by pulsing the injectors for very short times. CLEAR FLOOD MODE If the engine floods, it can be cleared by opening the throttle half way (50%). The ECM discontinues fuel injector pulsation as long as the throttle is between 50 to 75 % and the engine rpm is below 300. If the throttle position becomes more than 75% or less than 50%, the ECM returns to the starting mode.
Index
Page 5F-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
RUN MODE When the engine is started and rpm is above 300, the system operates in the run mode. The ECM will calculate the desired air/fuel ratio based on these ECM inputs: rpm, Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor, and Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor . Higher engine load (from MAP) and colder engine temperature (from ECT) requires more fuel, or a richer air/fuel ratio. ACCELERATION MODE The ECM looks at rapid changes in Throttle Position (TP) and provides extra fuel by increasing the injector pulse width. FUEL CUTOFF MODE No fuel is delivered by the injectors when the ignition is OFF, to prevent dieseling. Also, fuel pulses are not delivered if the ECM receives no distributor reference pulses, which means the engine is not running. The fuel cutoff mode is also enabled at high engine rpm, as an overspeed protection for the engine. When cutoff is in effect due to high rpm, injection pulses will resume after engine rpm drops slightly. DECELERATION MODE The IAC is similar to a carburetor dashpot. It provides additional air when the throttle is rapidly moved to the idle position to prevent the engine from dying.
REV-LIMIT MODE
A fuel cutoff function is enabled at higher engine rpm. When the ECM senses that the engine has exceeded its specified maximum rpm, no fuel is delivered by the injectors. After the rpm drops below the specified maximum rpm, the ECM will resume fuel delivery.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-27
Index
Page 5F-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
d e
a c
b
73766
a b c d e f g
- Throttle Body - Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve - Throttle Position (TP) Sensor - Fuel Meter Cover - Fuel Damper - Fuel Meter Body - Fuel Injector (2)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-29
FUEL INJECTORS The injector assembly is a solenoid operated device, controlled by the ECM, that meters pressurized fuel to the intake manifold. The ECM energizes the injector solenoid, which opens a ball valve, allowing fuel to flow past the ball valve, and through a recessed flow director plate. The director plate has six machined holes that control the fuel flow, generating a conical spray pattern of finely atomized fuel at the injector tip. Fuel is directed at the throttle, causing it to become further atomized before entering the intake manifold.
a b c d
73773
a b c d
FUEL PRESSURE REGULATOR The pressure regulator is a diaphragm-operated relief valve with fuel pump pressure on one side, and regulator spring pressure on the other. The regulator s function is to maintain a constant pressure differential across the injectors at all times. The regulator is located on the cool fuel assembly. Refer to Fuel Delivery System for Electronic Fuel Injection Section of this manual.
a
a - Fuel Pressure Regulator
71716
Index
Page 5F-30 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
FUEL DAMPER The fuel damper acts as an equalization device to reduce the pressure spikes caused by the fuel injectors.
76499
a - Fuel Damper IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE The purpose of the IAC valve assembly is to control engine idle speed, while preventing stalls due to changes in engine load. The IAC valve, mounted in the throttle body, controls bypass air around the throttle valves.
72800
a
IAC Valve Air Flow Diagram a - IAC Valve b - EFI Throttle Body c - Air Flow By moving a conical valve known as a pintle, IN, toward the seat (to decrease air flow), or OUT, away from the seat (to increase air flow), a controlled amount of air moves around the throttle valve. If rpm is too low, more air is bypassed around the throttle valve to increase it. If rpm is too high, less air is bypassed around the throttle valve to decrease it.
Page 5F-31
Index
The ECM moves the IAC valve in small steps, called counts. These can be measured by scan tool test equipment, which plugs into the DLC. During idle, the proper position of the IAC valve is based on engine rpm. If the rpm drops below specification and the throttle valve is closed, the ECM senses a near stall condition and calculates a new valve position to prevent stalling. Engine idle speed is a function of total air flow into the engine based on IAC valve pintle position + throttle valve stop screws and PCV. Controlled idle speed is programmed into the ECM, which determines the correct IAC valve pintle position to maintain the desired idle speed for all engine operating conditions and loads. The minimum idle air rate is set at the factory with stop screws. This setting allows enough air flow by the throttle valves to cause the IAC valve pintle to be positioned a calibrated number of steps (counts) from the seat during controlled idle operation. If the IAC valve is disconnected and reconnected with the engine running, the idle speed may be wrong. In this case, the IAC valve can be reset by doing the following: turn off engine, wait ten seconds, and restart engine.
Index
Page 5F-32 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5F-33
Index
Page 5F-34 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
FUEL SYSTEM
Section 5G - Fuel Injection Disassembly And Reassembly
Table of Contents
Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5G-2 Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5G-3 Flame Arrestor And Throttle Body . . . . . 5G-4 Exploded Views - Throttle Body EFI . . . 5G-7 Throttle Body Body And Adapter . . . . 5G-7 Throttle Body Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . 5G-8 Fuel Pressure Relief Procedure . . . . . . . 5G-9 Throttle Body EFI Components . . . . . . . 5G-9 Fuel Meter Cover Assembly . . . . . . . . 5G-9 Fuel Injectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5G-11 Throttle Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5G-13 Throttle Body Adapter Plate . . . . . . . . Engine Control Module (ECM) . . . . . . Knock Sensor (KS) Module (MEFI 1 Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Throttle Position (TP) Sensor . . . . . . . Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve . . . . . . . . Knock Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5G-17 5G-18 5G-19 5G-20 5G-21 5G-22 5G-23 5G-25
5
G
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-1
Precautions
WARNING
Always disconnect battery cables from battery BEFORE working on fuel system to prevent fire or explosion.
WARNING
Be careful when cleaning flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hose; gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark or open flame in area when cleaning flame arrestor and crankcase ventilation hose.
WARNING
Be careful when changing fuel system components; gasoline is extremely flammable and highly explosive under certain conditions. Be sure that ignition key is OFF. DO NOT smoke or allow sources of spark or open flame in the area while changing fuel filter(s). Wipe up any spilled fuel immediately.
WARNING
Be sure that the engine compartment is well ventilated and that no gasoline vapors are present to avoid the possibility of fire.
WARNING
Make sure no fuel leaks exist, before closing engine hatch.
CAUTION
Fuel pressure MUST BE relieved before servicing high pressure component in the fuel system.
CAUTION
DO NOT operate engine without cooling water being supplied to water pickup holes in gear housing, or water pump impeller will be damaged and subsequent overheating damage to engine may result. The following information MUST BE adhered to when working on the fuel system: Always keep a dry chemical fire extinguisher at the work area. Always install new O-rings when assembling fuel pipe fittings. DO NOT replace fuel pipe with fuel hose. DO NOT attempt any repair to the fuel system until instructions and illustrations relating to that repair are thoroughly understood. Observe all Notes and Cautions.
Index
Page 5G-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Throttle Body to Adapter TP Sensor IAC Valve MAP Sensor Knock Sensor to Block Intake Manifold to Plenum Fuel Line Connections Fuel Meter Cover Assembly Screws Fuel Inlet and Return Lines ECT Sensor Flame Arrestor Cover Bracket Flame Arrestor Clamp 28 23 150 18 20 20 44-62 12-16 lb-in. lb-ft 15 Nm 19 2 2 5-7 16.3-21.7 17 24 3 31
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-3
3 1 28 27 9
14
21 22 23
18
13
1 - Cover 2 - Decal Set 3 - Washer 4 - Nut (1/4-20) 5 - Flame Arrestor 6 - Stud 7 - Breather Hose 8 - Elbow (90 degree) 9 - Grommet 10 - Screw (5/16-18 x 2-1/4 in.) 11 - Adapter Assembly - TBI 12 - Gasket 13 - Gasket 14 - Screw (5/16-18 x 3/4 in.) 15 - Map Sensor
16 - Screw (#10-24 x 1/2 in.) 17 - Clip 18 - Stud Kit 19 - Bolt 20 - Washer 21 - Connector 22 - Washer 23 - Nut (5/16-24) 24 - Shaft 25 - Washer 26 - Plate 27 - Valve - PVC 28 - Hose - PVC (3\8 in I.D.) 29 - Connector 30 - Hose (7/32 in. I.D.)
Index
Page 5G-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
REMOVAL
NOTICE Refer to Precautions at front of this section BEFORE proceeding. 1. Remove the flame arrestor cover.
b c
76543
76501
a - Flame Arrestor
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-5
INSTALLATION
1. Replace components. Tighten all fasteners securely.
a b
76543
a b c d e
Index
Page 5G-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
3 5 4
5
76500
6 7
75841
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
- Throttle Body - Screws (3) - Gasket - Throttle Body Adapter - Screws (4) - Gasket - Intake Manifold
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-7
2 3
4 5 7 6 8 9
10
11 12
13 20
13 14 15 18 19 1 - Cap Screw 2 - Cover Assembly 3 - Fuel Pressure Regulator 4 - Cover Assembly Gasket 5 - Upper O-Ring 6 - Fuel Meter Outlet Gasket 7 - Fuel Injector (2) 8 - Fuel Filter (2) 9 - Lower O-Ring 10 - Screw 16
73766
17
11 - Body 12 - Throttle Body To Fuel Meter Body Gasket 13 - Throttle Body 14 - Throttle Position (TP) Sensor 15 - Screws (2) 16 - Seal 17 - O-Ring 18 - Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve 19 - Screws (2) 20 - Fuel Inlet
Index
Page 5G-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
CAUTION
DO NOT remove the four screws securing the pressure regulator to the fuel meter cover. The fuel pressure regulator includes a large spring under heavy compression which, if accidentally released, could cause personal injury.
REMOVAL
1. Remove the flame arrestor from the throttle body. 2. Disconnect electrical connectors to fuel injectors. (Squeeze plastic tabs and pull straight up.) 3. Remove the fuel meter cover screw assemblies. 4. Remove fuel meter cover assembly.
d a
b e
73767
a b c d e
- Fuel Meter Cover - Fuel Damper - Gaskets (Regulator Passages) - Screws - Fuel Meter Outlet Gasket
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-9
INSTALLATION
1. Install new pressure regulator seal, fuel meter outlet passage gasket, and cover gasket. 2. Install fuel meter cover assembly. 3. Install attaching screws, precoated with appropriate locking compound to threads. (Short screws are next to injectors.) 4. Torque screws to 28 lb-in. (3 Nm). 5. Connect electrical connectors to fuel injectors. 6. With engine OFF, and ignition ON, check for leaks around gasket and fuel line couplings.
73767
a b c d
- Fuel Meter Cover - Pressure Regulator Assembly - Gaskets (Regulator Passages) - Screws
Index
Page 5G-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Fuel Injectors
NOTICE Refer to Precautions at front of this section BEFORE proceeding.
REMOVAL
NOTE: Use care in removing fuel injectors to prevent damage to the electrical connector and nozzle. IMPORTANT: The fuel injector is an electrical component. DO NOT soak in any liquid cleaner or solvent, as damage may result. 1. Remove flame arrestor and fuel meter cover as outlined in this section. 2. Using a screwdriver carefully pry up on fuel injector to remove it from the fuel meter body (Use a screwdriver or rod under the the screwdriver when prying up. Leave old gasket in place to prevent damage to fuel meter body).
73770
73772
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-11
INSTALLATION
1. Install new lower O-rings on fuel injectors. Lubricate O-rings using a water soap solution.
b a c d
73766
a b c d
2. Install upper O-rings in fuel meter body. Lubricate O-rings with water soap solution. 3. Install fuel injectors into the fuel meter body. Align the raised lug on the injector base with the notch in fuel meter cavity.
73771
NOTE: The electrical terminals of the injectors should be parallel with throttle shaft. 4. Install gasket and fuel meter cover, torque screws to 28 lb-in. (3 Nm) and flame arrestor as outlined in this section. 5. Connect electrical connections to fuel injectors. 6. With engine OFF, and ignition ON, check for leaks around gasket and fuel line couplings.
Index
Page 5G-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Throttle Body
REMOVAL
CAUTION
Ensure that fuel pressure is relieved before removing the fuel inlet and return lines. IMPORTANT: DO NOT allow the TP sensor, fuel pressure regulator, fuel injectors and IAC valve to come into contact with solvent or cleaner. These components should be removed prior to immersion in solvent. 1. Remove the flame arrestor from the throttle body.
e
76543
d
a b c d e - Flame Arrestor Cover - Flame Arrestor - Throttle Body Unit - Gasket - Throttle Body Adapter
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-13
75867
3. Disconnect the electrical connections from the TP sensor, IAC and fuel injectors. (Squeeze plastic tabs on injectors and pull straight up).
a
a - Electrical Connections 4. Remove fuel inlet and outlet lines from throttle body. 5. Remove screws retaining the throttle body to adapter plate.
73750
NOTE: Place a shop rag over the intake manifold opening to prevent debris from entering intake manifold.
Index
Page 5G-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
INSTALLATION
1. Install fuel injectors and fuel meter body. 2. Install a new gasket on adapter plate. 3. Install throttle body on adapter plate and torque the screws 30 lb-ft (40 Nm).
e
76543
d
a b c d e - Flame Arrestor Cover - Flame Arrestor - Throttle Body Unit - Gasket - Throttle Body Adapter
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-15
75867
5. Move throttle from idle to WOT and check that the throttle movement is not binding. 6. Connect the fuel inlet and return lines. Torque to 23 lb-ft (31 Nm). 7. Connect TP sensor, IAC, and fuel injectors connections. 8. Turn key to ON position and check for fuel leaks around the inlet and return line connections. 9. Start engine and check for fuel leaks.
Index
Page 5G-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
REMOVAL
IMPORTANT: Place a clean shop towel over the intake manifold opening to prevent foreign material from entering the engine. 1. Remove flame arrestor. 2. Remove throttle body. 3. Remove screws and throttle body adapter from the intake manifold. 1
3 4 5
76500
6 7
75841
Typical 1 - Throttle Body 2 - Screws (3) 3 - Gasket 4 - Throttle Body Adapter 5 - Screws (4) 6 - Gasket 7 - Intake Manifold
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-17
a c
d b
MEFI 1
c
72801 76253
MEFI 3
NOTE: Connectors are reversed between MEFI 1 and MEFI 3. a - Electrical Bracket b - ECM c - J1- Electrical Connector d - J2- Electrical Connector
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect J1 and J2 electrical connectors at engine control module (ECM). 2. Remove ECM from electrical bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Mount new ECM to electrical bracket. 2. Connect J1 and J2 electrical connectors to the ECM.
Index
Page 5G-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
72801
REMOVAL
1. Remove Knock Sensor from electrical bracket. 2. Disconnect electrical connector at Knock Sensor (KS) Module.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect electrical connector to the Knock Sensor (KS) Module. 2. Mount KS Module to electrical bracket.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-19
REMOVAL
NOTE: Handle the ECT carefully as any damage to it will affect operation of the system. 1. Disconnect electrical connector at Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor.
a
72799
a - Thermostat Housing b - Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor 2. Remove ECT from thermostat housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Install ECT in thermostat housing. Tighten hand tight plus 2-1/2 turns maximum. 2. Connect electrical connector to ECT.
Index
Page 5G-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector from Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor.
b e
a
a b c d e
c d
75840
- Electrical Connector - Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor - Clip - Screw - Intake Manifold
INSTALLATION
1. Install seal on MAP sensor. 2. Install MAP sensor on intake manifold using clip and screw. Torque screw to 44-62 lb-in. (5-7 Nm). 3. Connect electrical connector to MAP sensor.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-21
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector at Throttle Position (TP) Sensor. 2. Remove TP sensor from throttle body.
b
a - Throttle Body b - Throttle Position (TP) Sensor c - Screws
73758
INSTALLATION
IMPORTANT: If the TP sensor is to be replaced with a new unit, be sure to secure it in place with the new screws that are included in the service package. 1. Install TP sensor to throttle body using screws with washers and Loctite 242 applied to threads. Torque screws to 20 lb-in. (2 Nm).
a
b
b c
73758
a - Throttle Body b - Screws With Lockwashers c - Seal 2. Connect electrical connector to TP sensor. 3. Install throttle body, throttle linkage and flame arrestor. Refer to Throttle Body. 4. Start engine and check for TP sensor output voltage. It should be approximately .7 V at idle and 4.5 V at WOT.
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
Page 5G-22
REMOVAL
1. Remove flame arrestor, throttle cable and throttle body. 2. Disconnect electrical connector at Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve.
b
73754
a - Throttle Body b - Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve 3. Remove IAC from throttle body.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-23
INSTALLATION
IMPORTANT: If installing a new IAC valve, be sure to replace it with the correct IAC valve pintle shape and diameter are designed for the specific application. 1. Install new O-ring on IAC valve.
c b d
a b c d - Throttle Body - Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve - O-Ring - Screws
73766
2. Install IAC valve in throttle body using screws. Torque to 20 lb-in. (2 Nm). 3. Connect electrical connector to IAC valve.
b
73754
a - Throttle Body b - Idle Air Control (IAC) Valve 4. Reset IAC valve pintle position after reconnecting negative () battery cable. a. Turn ignition key ON for ten seconds. b. Turn ignition key OFF for ten seconds. c. Restart engine and check for proper idle operation.
Index
Page 5G-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Knock Sensor
NOTICE Refer to Service Precautions at front of this section BEFORE proceeding.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect electrical connector at knock sensor located just ahead of starter motor.
a
73757
INSTALLATION
IMPORTANT: If installing a new knock sensor, be sure to replace it with an identical part. knock sensors are very sensitive and designed for each specific application. IMPORTANT: In the following step, it is very important that the knock sensor be torqued to the precise specification. Incorrect torquing will result in unsatisfactory performance. DO NOT use sealer on threads. IMPORTANT: Ensure that the knock sensor is installed in the upper location on the Y-fitting. 1. Install knock sensor in engine block. Torque to 12-16 lb-ft (16-22 Nm).
a
73756
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-25
Index
Page 5G-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5G-27
Index
Page 5G-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
FUEL SYSTEMS
Section 5H - Fuel Injection System Troubleshooting
Table of Contents
Scan Tool Normal Specifications . . . . . . Important Preliminary Checks . . . . . . . . . Before Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Visual / Physical Check . . . . . . . . . . . . Intermittents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hard Start Symptom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Surges and/or Chuggles Symptom . . . . Lack of Power, Sluggish or Spongy Symptom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5H-2 5H-3 5H-3 5H-3 5H-4 5H-5 5H-7 5H-9 Detonation / Spark Knock Symptom . . . Hesitation, Sag, Stumble Symptom . . . . Cuts Out, Misses Symptom . . . . . . . . . . . Rough, Unstable or Incorrect Idle, Stalling Symptom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Poor Fuel Economy Symptom . . . . . . . . Dieseling, Run-On Symptom . . . . . . . . . . Backfire Symptom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5H-11 5H-13 5H-15 5H-17 5H-20 5H-22 5H-23
5
H
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-1
Scan Tool Normal Specifications (Idle / Warm Engine / Closed Throttle / Neutral)
Scan Position rpm Desired rpm Coolant Temp. Manifold Air Temp. Throttle Position Throttle Angle MAP Baro Bat Spark Advance Knock Retard Idle Air Control IAC Minimum IAC Position Idle Air Control Follower Injector Pulse Width rpm rpm F( C) F ( C) Volts 0-100 % Volts or kPa Volts or kPa Volts Degrees Degrees Counts (Steps) Counts (Steps) Counts (Steps) msec. Units Displayed Typical Data Value 600-700 rpm 600 or 650 rpm - Depends on Model 2 150-170 F (66-77 C) Varies with Ambient Temperature .4 to .8 Volts 0-1% 1-3 Volts or (45-55 kPa) (Depends on Vacuum and Baro Pressure) 3-5 Volts (Depends on Altitude and Barometric Pressure) 12.0-14.5 Volts -10 to 30 0 0-40 Counts 0-40 Counts 0 Counts 2-3 msec. 2.53.5 msec. (Depends on Water/Air Temperature) 1-2 GPH(3.7-7.5 L/h) Varies Varies with Software revision in ECM OK OK OFF
Injector On Time Cranking msec. Fuel Consumption Time From Start Memory Calibration Check Sum Oil Press/IO Level 1 Engine Overtemp Lanyard Stop Mode
1: 2:
GPH (L/h) 0:00:00-1092:00 Calibration and Check Sum OK/LO OK/Overheating OFF/ON
MCM will read I/O Level and MIE will read Trans. Refer to Engine and Tune-Up Specifications.
Index
Page 5H-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Verify the customer complaint and locate the correct symptom in the table of contents. Check the items indicated under that symptom.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-3
Intermittents
IMPORTANT: Problem may or may not turn ON the Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) or store a DTC. DO NOT use the Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) tables for intermittent problems. The fault must be present to locate the problem. Most intermittent problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. Perform careful visual/physical check. Check for the following conditions: Poor mating of the connector halves, or a terminal not fully seated in the connector body (backed out or loose). Improperly formed or damaged terminals and/or connectors.
All connector terminals in the problem circuit should be carefully checked for proper contact tension. Poor terminal to wire connection (crimping).This requires removing the terminal from the connector body to check. Refer to Wiring Harness Service in the Description and System Operation section.
The vessel may be driven with a Digital Multimeter connected to a suspected circuit. An abnormal voltage when malfunction occurs is a good indication that there is a fault in the circuit being monitored. A scan tool (see Special Tools for part numbers) can be used to help detect intermittent conditions. The scan tools have several features that can be used to locate an intermittent condition. The following features can be used in finding an intermittent fault: The Record feature or choosing not to erase data can be triggered to capture and store engine parameters within the scan tool when the malfunction occurs. This stored information can then be reviewed by the service technician to see what caused the malfunction. To check loss of DTC memory, disconnect TP sensor and idle engine until the MIL comes ON. A trouble code should be stored and kept in memory when ignition is turned OFF. If not, the ECM is faulty. When this test is completed, make sure that you clear the DTC 22 from memory. An intermittent MIL with no stored DTC may be caused by the following: Ignition coil shorted to ground and arcing at ignition wires or plugs. MIL wire to ECM shorted to ground. Poor ECM grounds, Go to ECM wiring diagrams. Check for an electrical system interference caused by a sharp electrical surge. Normally, the problem will occur when the faulty component is operated. Check for improper installation of electrical options such as lights, ship to shore radios, sonar, etc. Check that knock sensor wires are routed away from spark plug wires, ignition system components and charging system components. Check for secondary ignition components shorted to ground, or an open ignition coil ground (coil mounting brackets). Check for components internally shorted to ground such as starters, alternators or relays.
Index
Page 5H-4
All Ignition Control (IC) module wiring should kept away from the alternator. Check all wires from the ECM to the ignition control module for poor connections.
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
OBD
Step 5
OBD
Step 6
OBD
Step 7
OBD Step 10
Step 8 Step 9
Step 14
Step 13
10
Step 11
Step 13
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-5
11
Step 14
Step 12
12 13 14
Step 15
15
Step 16
16
Step 17
17
OBD
Step 18
18
OBD
Index
Page 5H-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Step 7
Step 8
OBD
Step 9
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-7
Step 10
10
Step 11
11
Step 12
12
Step 13
13
Step 14
14
Step 15 Step 16
15
16
OBD
Index
Page 5H-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Step 5
Step 6
Step 7
Step 8
Step 9
Step 10
10
OBD
Step 11
Page 5H-9
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Step 12
12
Step 13
13
OBD
Step 14
14
Step 15 Step 16
15
16
Step 17
17
OBD
Step 18
18
OBD
Index
Page 5H-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Step 7
OBD Step 9
Step 8 Step 10
Step 10
OBD
10
OBD
Step 11
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-11
Step 12
12
Step 13
13
OBD
Step 14
14
Step 15
OBD
15
OBD
Index
Page 5H-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Step 7
Step 8
OBD
Step 9
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-13
OBD
10 11
12
Step 13
13
Index
Page 5H-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Step 7 Step 8
OBD
Step 9
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-15
Step 10
10
Step 11
11
Step 12
12
OBD
Index
Page 5H-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Step 7
Step 8
OBD
Step 9
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-17
Step 10
10
Step 11
11
Step 12
12
Step 13
13
Step 14
14
Step 15
15
OBD
Step 16
Index
Page 5H-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Step 17
17
Step 18
18
Step 19 Step 20
19
20
OBD
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-19
1. Check operators driving habits. Are excessively heavy loads being carried? Is operator accelerating too much, too often? System normal Was a problem found? 1. Check flame arrestor for dirt or being plugged. 2. Check for fuel leaks. Was a problem found? 1. Check for proper fuel pressure. Refer to Table A-4 in General System Diagnostics section. Was fuel pressure 30 psi for EFI or 3-7 psi for carbureted engines? 1. Check for proper operation of Ignition Control (IC) circuit and the Knock Sensor (KS) circuit. Was a problem found? 1. Remove spark plugs, check for wet plugs, cracks, wear, improper gap, burned electrodes or heavy deposits. Refer to Distributor Ignition System. NOTE: If spark plugs are gas or oil fouled, the cause of the fouling must be determined before replacing the spark plugs. Were spark plugs damaged? 1. Visual (physically) check vacuum hoses for splits, kinks and improper connections and routing. Was a repair required? 1. Check engine compression for being low. Was a problem found?
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Step 7
Step 8
Index
Page 5H-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
10
OBD
Step 11
11
OBD
Step 12
12
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-21
OBD
Step 4
OBD
Step 5
OBD
Step 6
OBD
Step 7
OBD
Index
Page 5H-22 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Backfire Symptom
Step Action Yes No PROCEED TO Definition: Fuel ignites in the intake manifold, or in the exhaust system, making loud popping noise. 1 2 3 Was the On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check performed? Was visual/physical check performed? 1. Check flame arrestor for proper installation. Was a problem found? 1. Check for proper fuel pressure. Refer to Table A-4 in General System Diagnostics section. Was fuel pressure 30 psi for EFI or 3-7 psi for carbureted engines? 1. Check the injector connections. Correct as necessary. Was a problem found? 1. Check fuel injectors. Refer to Injector Balance Test in General System Diagnostics section. Was a problem found? 1. Check for proper operation of Ignition Control (IC) circuit and the Knock Sensor (KS) circuit. Was a problem found? 1. Check integrity of the primary and secondary wiring. 2. Check routing of the wiring. 3. Check condition of IC module, pick-up coil, distributor cap, rotor and spark plug wires. Was a problem found? 1. Check ignition coil for cracks or carbon tracking. Were cracks or carbon tracks found? Step 2 Step 3 OBD Visual/Physical Check
Step 4
Step 5
Step 6
Step 7
Step 8
Step 9
OBD
Step 10
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-23
10
Step 11
11
Step 12
12
Step 13
13
Step 14
14
Step 15
15
OBD
Index
Page 5H-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5H-25
Index
Page 5H-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
FUEL SYSTEMS
Section 5I - Diagnostics
Table of Contents
Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Diagnostic Circuit Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . Scan Tool Normal Specifications . . . . Diagnostic Trouble Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . ECM Connector and EFI Symptoms Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . J-1 Circuits with MEFI 1 . . . . . . . . . . . J-2 Circuits with MEFI 1 . . . . . . . . . . . J-1 Circuits with MEFI 3 . . . . . . . . . . . J-2 Circuits with MEFI 3 . . . . . . . . . . . Wiring System Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . MEFI 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MEFI 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . General Diagnostic Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chart A-1 No MIL or No DLC Data . Chart A-2 MIL ON Steady Will Not Flash DTC 12 . . . . . . . . . . . . Chart A-3 Engine Cranks But Will Not Run . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chart A-4 Fuel System Diagnosis . . Chart A-5 Fuel System Electrical Test Chart A-6 EFI System / Ignition Relay Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . Chart A-7 Ignition System Check . . . Chart A-8 Idle Air Control (IAC) Functional Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . Discrete Input Circuit Check Non-Scan Only . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5I-2 5I-4 5I-4 5I-5 5I-6 5I-6 5I-8 5I-10 5I-12 5I-14 5I-14 5I-18 5I-21 5I-21 5I-23 5I-25 5I-27 5I-29 5I-31 5I-33 5I-35 5I-41 5I-43 Clearing Trouble Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clearing Codes Using CodeMate Tester . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clearing Codes Using Scan Tool . . . . Diagnostic Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 14 Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 15 Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 21 Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 22 Throttle Position (TP) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 23 Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 25 Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 33 Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 34 Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . Code 41 Ignition Control (IC) Circuit Code 42 Ignition Control (IC) Circuit Code 43 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit Code 44 Knock Sensor (KS) Circuit Code 45 Ignition Coil Driver Fault . . Code 51 Calibration Memory Failure Code 52 EEPROM Failure . . . . . . . . Code 61 Fuel Pressure (FP) Circuit . Code 62 Fuel Pressure (FP) Sensor Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5I-48 5I-48 5I-48 5I-49 5I-49 5I-52 5I-54 5I-57 5I-60 5I-62 5I-64 5I-67 5I-70 5I-72 5I-74 5I-77 5I-80 5I-82 5I-83 5I-84 5I-87
5
I
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-1
DIAGNOSTICS
Special Tools
Part Number J-34029-A (Note 1 and 2) Tool Name High Impedance Multimeter (DVM) Vacuum Pump with Gauge - 20 In. Hg Minimum Unpowered Test Light Injector Harness Test Light Harness Test Adapter MerCruiser Scan Tool Version 3.4 (English) Code Mate Tester Timing Light Fuel Pressure Gauge Kit Quicksilver Digital Diagnostic Terminal (DDT) Description Minimum 10 megohm input impedance required on all voltage ranges. As ammeter, accurately measures low value current flow. As ohmmeter, reads 0-200 ohms, 2/20/200 k, 2/20 m. Gauge monitors manifold engine vacuum. Hand pump used to check fuel pressure regulator. Used to check circuit wiring, short to ground or voltage. Visually indicates injector electrical impulses from the ECM. Allows multi-meter connections with wiring harness. Displays problem codes stored in the ECM. It also allows monitoring of various circuits and components in the fuel injection system. Allows for test firing injectors. Tool can read MEFI 1 and MEFI 3 ECM. Flashes light to display problem codes. Used to check ignition timing. Must have inductive signal pickup. Used to check fuel system pressure. Kit includes 91-803135 Test Port Adaptor Kit and 91-806901 TBI Pressure Valve. Displays problem codes stored in the ECM. It also allows monitoring of various circuits and components in the fuel injection system. Displays problem codes stored in the ECM. It also allows monitoring of various circuits and components in the fuel injection system. Tool can read MEFI 1 and MEFI 3 ECM. Displays problem codes stored in the ECM. It also allows monitoring of various circuits and components in the fuel injection system. Used to set Ignition timing. Plug connects to DLC. Used to perform fuel system pressure test. Allows connection of Fuel Pressure Gauge.
94050m
91-823686A2
91-803999
84-822560A2
DDT Adaptor Harness EFI Timing Tool Fuel Shutoff Tool Fuel Line Connector
Index
Page 5I-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-3
DIAGNOSTICS
Units Displayed rpm rpm F( C) F ( C) Volts 0-100 % Volts or kPa Volts or kPa Volts Degrees Degrees Counts (Steps) Counts (Steps) Counts (Steps) msec. msec. GPH (L/h) 0:00:00-1092:00 Calibration Check Sum OK/LO OK/Overheating OFF/ON
Typical Data Value 600-700 rpm 600 or 650 rpm (Depends on Model2) 150-170 F (66-77 C) Varies with Ambient Temperature .4 to .8 Volts 0-1% 1-3 Volts or (45-55 kPa) (Depends on Vacuum and Baro Pressure) 3-5 Volts (Depends on Altitude and Barometric Pressure) 12.0-14.5 Volts -10 to 30 0 0-40 Counts 0-40 Counts 0 Counts 2-3 msec. 2.53.5 msec. (Depends on Water/ Air Temperature) 1-2 GPH(3.7-7.5 L/h) Varies Varies with Software revision in ECM OK OK OFF
Index
Page 5I-4
2:
MCM will read I/O Level and MIE will read Trans. Refer to Engine and Tune-Up Specifications. 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-5
DIAGNOSTICS
CAUTION
Do not attempt to obtain these voltages by probing wires and connectors. Serious damage could result in loss of engine operation or wiring damage. Voltages can vary with battery conditions. In the following J-1 and J-2 Circuit/Symptom Charts only those pins which are used by the ECM are shown. Pin numbers not listed are not used. NOTE: All pins are not used on all models. IMPORTANT: The following conditions must be met before testing. 1. Engine at operating temperature. 2. Ignition on or engine running. 3. Scan tool not connected. THESE NOTES APPLY TO FOLLOWING ECM CONNECTOR AND SYMPTOM CHARTS. The B+ Symbol indicates a system voltage (battery). NOTE: 1 Battery voltage for first two seconds, then 0 volts. NOTE: 2 Varies with temperature. NOTE: 3 Varies with manifold vacuum. NOTE: 4 Varies with throttle movement. NOTE: 5 Less than .5 volt (500 mV).
J-1 Front Pin 32 Pin Input Connector a - Shaded Area Denotes Pin Connector Location Used On Terminal
Index
Page 5I-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
DTC
Possible Symptoms Poor Fuel Economy, Poor Performance Detonation Poor Performance, Exhaust Odor, Rough Idle rpm Reduction Power Reduction Mode Alarm Activation Lack Of Data From Other Engine (Dual Engine Only) Power Reduction Mode Alarm Activation Incorrect Idle, Poor Performance Poor Performance, Surge, Poor Fuel Economy, Exhaust Odor Poor Performance And Acceleration, Incorrect Idle No Start High Idle, Rough Idle, Poor Performance Exhaust Odor No Start Lack Of Power, Idle High No Start No Serial Data Incorrect Idle No Start Lack Of Performance,Exhaust Odor, Stall No Start Lack Of Power, Surge, Rough Idle, Exhaust Odor No Start
J1-1 J1-2 J1-4 J1-5 J1-6 J1-7 J1-9 J1-10 J1-11 J1-13 J1-14 J1-15 J1-16 J1-18 J1-19 J1-21 J1-29 J1-30 J1-31 J1-32
485 410 931 916 931 451 432 417 439 813 450 416 440 461 923 942 814 450 416 440
9.5V 1.95V
(NOTE 2)
43 14 None None None None 33 21 None 21,23 None 21 None None None None 33 None 33 None
B+ B+ 4.9V .62V
(NOTE 4)
B+ B+ 1.46V
(NOTE 3)
.62V
(NOTE 4)
B+ 0
(NOTE 5)
B+ 0
(NOTE 5)
0
(NOTE 5)
0
(NOTE 5)
5V B+ 5V 0 0 0
(NOTE 5)
5V B+ 5V 0 0 0
(NOTE 5)
0
(NOTE 5)
0
(NOTE 5)
5V B+
5V B+
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-7
DIAGNOSTICS
J-2 Rear 32 Pin Output Connector a - Shaded Area Denotes Pin Connector Location Used On Terminal Pin Function Injector Driver Ignition Control Ref. Low Not Used Ignition Control Ref. High Fuel Pump Relay Driver Coolant Over temp. IAC A Low IAC B Low Injector Ground Normal Voltage CKT Wire Color LT GRN RED/ BLK PUR/ WHT DK GRN/ WHT DK GRN RED YEL BLK/ WHT Ignition ON B+ 0
(NOTE 5)
Pin
Engine Running B+ 0
(NOTE 5)
DTC
Possible Symptoms
J2-5
468
None
J2-6
463
None
Poor Performance
J2-7
None
Not Used
J2-8
430
5V
1.6V
None
No Restart
0
(NOTE 1&5)
J2-9
465
B+
None
No Start
Power Reduction Mode or Improper Audio Warning Rough Unstable or Incorrect Idle Rough Unstable or Incorrect Idle Rough Running, Lack Of Power, Poor Performance
Index
Page 5I-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Engine Running 0
(NOTE 5)
DTC
Possible Symptoms
None None 42
Rough Running, Poor Idle, Lack Of Performance Rough Idle, Lack Of Power, Stalling Not Used Stall, Will Restart In Bypass Mode, Lack Of Power Lack Of Power, Fixed Timing Audio Warning System Activation Audio Warning System Activation Rough, Unstable or Incorrect Idle Rough, Unstable or Incorrect Idle Lamp Inoperative
B+ 0
(NOTE 5)
B+ 1.2V
424 31 31 441
0
(NOTE 5)
42 None
J2-29 J2-31
444 419
None None
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-9
DIAGNOSTICS
J-1 Front Pin 32 Pin Input Connector a - Shaded Area Denotes Pin Connector Location Used On Terminal Pin Function Injector Driver Ignition Coil Ignition Control Ref. Low ECM Ground ECM Ground MIL Lamp Ignition Control Signal IAC B Low IAC A Low Injector Driver ECM Ground Normal Voltage CKT Wire Color DK BLU WHT RED/ BLK BLK BLK BRN/ WHT WHT GRN/ WHT BLU/ BLK DK GRN BLK Ignition ON B+ Not Usable 0
(NOTE 5)
Pin
DTC
Possible Symptoms Rough Idle, Lack Of Power, Stalling Rough Running, Poor Idle, Lack of Performance Poor Performance
J1-1 J1-2
467 121
None 45
J1-3
453
None
0
(NOTE 5)
0
(NOTE 5)
No Start No Start Lamp Inoperative Stall, Will Restart In Bypass Mode, Lack Of Power Rough Unstable or Incorrect Idle Rough Unstable or Incorrect Idle Rough Idle, Lack Of Power, Stall Rough Running, Poor Idle, Lack Of Performance
0
(NOTE 5)
0
(NOTE 5)
0
(NOTE 5)
0
(NOTE 5)
0
(NOTE 5)
Index
Page 5I-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Engine Running B+
DTC
Possible Symptoms
J1-23
465
None
No Start
J1-24
424
0
(NOTE 5)
4.5V
42
Audio J1-26 Warning Horn J1-27 IAC B Low IAC A High Knock Sensor Signal Serial Data
29
None
Rough Unstable or Incorrect Idle Rough Unstable or Incorrect Idle Poor Fuel Economy, Poor Performance Detonation No Serial Data
444
None
J1-28
441
None
J1-30 J1-32
496 461
43, 44 None
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-11
DIAGNOSTICS
J-2 Rear 32 Pin Output Connector a - Shaded Area Denotes Pin Connector Location Used On Terminal Pin Function Battery Sensor Ground TP 5V Power Discrete Switch Discrete Switch Shift Switch Ignition Control Ref. High ECT Signal Fuel Pressure MAP Ground MAP 5V Reference Discrete Switch Normal Voltage CKT 440 813 416 114 585 923 Wire Color ORN BLK GRY BLU TAN/ WHT WHT PUR/ WHT YEL GRN BLK GRY BRN Ignition ON B+ 0
(NOTE 5)
Engine Running B+ 0
(NOTE 5)
Possible Symptoms No Start High Idle, Rough Idle, Poor Performance Exhaust Odor Lack Of Power, Idle High Incorrect Idle
5V 0
5V 0
J2-10
430
5V 1.95V
(NOTE 2)
1.6V 1.95V
(NOTE 2)
None
No Restart Poor Performance, Exhaust Odor, Rough Idle rpm Reduction Lack Of Performance,Exhaust Odor, Stall Lack Of Power, Surge, Rough Idle, Exhaust Odor
14 61, 62 33 33
3V 0
(NOTE 5)
3V 0
(NOTE 5)
5V
5V
Index
Page 5I-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Possible Symptoms Lack Of Data From Other Engine (Dual Engine Only) Incorrect Idle, Poor Performance
Poor Performance And Acceleration, Incorrect Idle Poor Performance, Surge, Poor Fuel Economy, Exhaust Odor Poor Fuel Economy, Exhaust Odor No Start
4.9V 5V B+
1.46V
(NOTE 3) (NOTE 2)
B+
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-13
DIAGNOSTICS
467 DK BLU INJECTOR TO INJECTOR FUSE 439 PNK/BLK 450 BLK/WHT 450 BLK/WHT
J2-21
INJECTOR DRIVER
J2-15
INJECTOR GROUND
J2-20
INJECTOR GROUND
J2-5
INJECTOR DRIVER
902 RED
J2-9
120 GRY
150 BLK
D C
441 BRN or BLU/WHT 442 RED or BLU/BLK 443 YEL or GRN/WHT 444 GRN/BLK 461 ORN/BLK 916 YEL
IAC COIL A HIGH IAC COIL A LOW IAC COIL B HIGH IAC COIL B LOW MASTER/SLAVE SERIAL DATA
B A
461 ORN/BLK
BLK 916 YEL 450 BLK/WHT K J H G 440 ORN F A B C D E 419 BRN/WHT J2-31 MALFUNCTION INDICATOR LIGHT 451 WHT/BLK J1-7 DIAGNOSTIC TEST TERMINAL
Index
Page 5I-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
MEFI 1 (Continued)
J1-19
SHIFT INTERRUPT
C B A 814 BLK
J1-31 J1-9
A B
814 BLK 410 YEL J1-2 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR SIGNAL
75602
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-15
DIAGNOSTICS
MEFI 1 (Continued)
J1-14 J1-30
IC MODULE
B C
423 WHT
B A
B A
E D C B A
IGNITION COIL
112 DK GRN
J2-11
OUT TO BUZZER (COOLANT OVERHEAT) OUT TO BUZZER (AUDIO WARNING SYSTEM SWITCHES) INPUT FROM AUDIO WARNING SYSTEM SWITCHES
31 TAN
J2-27
931 BRN
J1-6
121 WHT
75877
Index
Page 5I-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
MEFI 1 (Continued)
TO FUEL PUMP RELAY TO IGN COIL B+ 902 RED 902 RED 150 BLK TO KEY SWITCH 3 PNK TO INJECTORS 439 PNK/BLK 439 PNK/BLK
TO BATTERY POSITIVE (+) 2 RED 902 RED INJ/ECM FUSE 10A 30 86 85 87 J1-11 IGNITION FEED
2 RED
SYSTEM/IGNITION RELAY ECM BAT FUSE 15A 2 RED 440 ORN J1-16 BATTERY FEED BATTERY FEED
440 ORN
J1-32
A B C D E KNOCK MODULE 439 PNK/BLK 485 GRN 486 PUR 496 DK BLU J1-1 KNOCK SENSOR SIGNAL
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-17
DIAGNOSTICS
MEFI 3
From INJ/ ECM FUSE 10 AMP INJECTOR 481 BLK J1-1
467 DK BLU
468 DK GRN
J1-17
15A
150 BLK
441 BRN OR BLU/WHT IDLE AIR CONTROL (IAC) VALVE 442 RED OR BLU/BLK 443 YEL OR GRN/WHT 444 GRN/BLK
461 ORN
J1-32
SERIAL DATA
916 YEL 150 BLK DLC 450 BLK FROM ECM/BAT FUSE 15A
J2-21
MASTER/SLAVE
451 BLK/WHT
J2-22
440 ORN
419 BRN/WHT
J1-9
Index
Page 5I-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
ECM
87a 30 85 86 87
DIAGNOSTICS
MEFI 3 (Continued)
INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR SIGNAL
472 TAN
J2-30
813 BLK
813 BLK
J2-3
SENSOR GROUND
B
(TP)
C A
J2-26
416 GRY
J2-4
B
FUEL PRESSURE SENSOR (FP)
C A
813 BLK
475 GRN
J2-12
J2-19
814 BLK
J2-18
J2-11
496 DK BLU
J1-30
J2-7
150 BLK
906 TAN/WHT
J2-24
LUBE BOTTLE
150 BLK SHIFT SWITCH B A 207 PPL J2-9 SHIFT INTERRUPT SIGNAL 76098
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-19
ECM
J2-27
DIAGNOSTICS
TO B+ TO B+
B A
2 RED 2 RED
3 PNK
86
85
902 RED
DISTRIBUTOR 450 BLK WHT/GRN WHT/RED 450 BLK 450 BLK 439 PNK 430 PPL/WHT 902 RED 121 WHT J2-10 121 WHT J1-2 DIST. REF. IGN. COIL J1-5
J1-4
J1-20
+
IGNITION COIL
TEMP SENDER 121 WHT A 901 TAN 3 PNK TO IGN TO TEMP GAUGE TO TACH PUR TAN GRY B C C B A 208 BRN 585 TAN/WHT 29 DK GRN CONNECTOR HALVES TAN/BLU BLU/TAN YEL/BLK J2-20 J2-8 J1-26 LOAD ANTICIPATION TRANSMISSION OVERTEMP AUDIO WARNING CIRCUIT
F E D D E F
Index
Page 5I-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
ECM
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 1
461 ORN/BLK or ORN 450 BLK/WHT or BLK TO ECM 15A BATTERY FUSE TO ECM 15A BATTERY FUSE DLC CONNECTOR 450 BLK/WHT or BLK 451 WHT/BLK (BLK/WHT - Some Models) 450 BLK/WHT or BLK 450 BLK/WHT or BLK
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The on-board diagnostic system check must be the starting point for any diagnosis. Before using this procedure, check the ECM and engine grounds for cleanliness and tightness. The on-board diagnostic system check is an organized approach to identifying a problem created by an electronic engine control system malfunction.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
An intermittent may be caused by a poor connection, rubbed through wire insulation or a wire broken inside the insulation. Check for the following items: Poor connection or damaged harness. Inspect the ECM harness and connectors for improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, poor terminal to wire connection and damaged harness.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-21
DIAGNOSTICS
5.
Compare ECM data values displayed on the scan tool to the typical scan tool data values page. Troubleshooting Are The Displayed Values Normal Or Close To The Typical Values? a. Ignition ON, engine OFF. b. Install CodeMate Tester and switch it to Normal Mode. c. Observe the MIL. Is the MIL ON? a. With CodeMate Tester on Normal Mode. b. Ignition ON, engine OFF. c. Observe the MIL on the CodeMate Tester. Does the MIL Flash DTC 12? a. Switch CodeMate Tester to Service Mode. b. Ignition ON, engine OFF. c. Observe the MIL on the CodeMate Tester. Does the MIL Flash DTC 12? a. Switch CodeMate Tester to Normal Mode.
6.
Step 7.
Chart A-1
7.
Step 12.
Step 8.
8.
Step 9.
Chart A-2
9.
b. Attempt to start the engine. Did The Engine Start And Continue To Run? a. Ignition ON, Engine OFF. b. Switch CodeMate Tester to Service Mode. Are Any Additional DTC Stored? Does A Customer Complaint Or Driveability Problem Currently Exist? Check CKT 451 for a short to ground.
Step 10.
Chart A-3
10.
11. 12.
Index
Page 5I-22 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 1
461 ORN/BLK or ORN 450 BLK/WHT or BLK TO ECM 15A BATTERY FUSE TO ECM 15A BATTERY FUSE DLC CONNECTOR 450 BLK/WHT or BLK 451 WHT/BLK (BLK/WHT - Some Models) 450 BLK/WHT or BLK 450 BLK/WHT or BLK
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
When the CodeMate Tester is installed, it plugs into the DLC terminals F and E. It receives voltage through CKT 440 terminal F. Terminal E is ground through CKT 419. There should always be a steady MIL with the ignition ON and the engine stopped. The Engine Control Module (ECM) turns the MIL on by grounding the MIL driver circuit.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
An intermittent may be caused by a poor connection, rubbed through wire insulation or a wire broken inside the insulation. Check for the following items: Poor connection or damaged harness. Inspect the ECM harness and connectors for improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, poor terminal to wire connection and damaged harness.
If the engine runs OK, check for a faulty light bulb or an open in the MIL driver circuit (CKT 419). If the engine cranks but will not run, check for an open ECM ignition or battery feed or a poor ECM to engine ground.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-23
DIAGNOSTICS
3.
Using a test light connected to battery positive (B+), probe Step 11. terminal E of the DLC. Does The Test Light Illuminate? a. Ignition OFF. b. Disconnect ECM connectors.
Step 4.
4.
c. Using a DVOM, measure the resistance between ECM CKT 419 and DLC terminal E. Is The Resistance Less Than 1 ohm? Are you using a Scan Tool? Check the ECM / DLC fuse. Is The Fuse Good? a. Ignition OFF. b. Disconnect the ECM connectors.
Step 5.
Step 13.
5. 6.
Step 6. Step 7.
7.
c. Using a test light connected to ground, probe ECM CKT 440. Does The Test Light Illuminate? a. Ignition ON, engine 0FF.
Step 8.
Step 10.
8.
b. Using a test light connected to ground (), probe ECM Step 12. CKT 439. Does The Test Light Illuminate? Check the Ignition / Injection fuse. Is The Fuse Good? Locate and repair open or short to ground in CKT 440. Repair or replace faulty CodeMate Tester. If problem was no DLC data (using scan tool), check serial data CKT 461 for an open or short to ground or locate and repair faulty ECM grounds. Locate and repair open in CKT 419. Locate and repair short to ground in the battery feed circuit. Locate and repair short to ground in CKT 439. Verify Repair Chart A-6
Step 9.
Step 15.
Index
Page 5I-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 1
461 ORN/BLK or ORN 450 BLK/WHT or BLK TO ECM 15A BATTERY FUSE TO ECM 15A BATTERY FUSE DLC CONNECTOR 450 BLK/WHT or BLK 451 WHT/BLK (BLK/WHT - Some Models) 450 BLK/WHT or BLK 450 BLK/WHT or BLK
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
When the CodeMate Tester is installed, it plugs into the DLC terminals F and E. It receives voltage through CKT 440 terminal F. Terminal E is ground through CKT 419 from the ECM. There should always be a steady MIL with the ignition ON and the engine stopped. The Engine Control Module (ECM) turns the MIL ON by grounding the MIL driver circuit. When the diagnostic tests terminal on the DLC is grounded by jumping terminal B to terminal A, the ground circuit is completed. The MIL will flash a DTC 12 followed by any DTC stored in memory. A steady light suggests CKT 419 is shorted to ground or an open in CKT 451 from the ECM to the DLC.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
An intermittent may be caused by a poor connection, rubbed through wire insulation or a wire broken inside the insulation. Check for the following items: Poor connection or damaged harness. Inspect the ECM harness and connectors for improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, poor terminal to wire connection and damaged harness.
If the engine runs OK, check for a faulty light bulb or an open in the MIL driver circuit (CKT 419). If the engine cranks but will not run, check for an open ECM ignition or battery feed or a poor ECM to engine ground.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-25
DIAGNOSTICS
5.
Step 6.
Step 8.
Index
Page 5I-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
MEFI 3 J1-1
J2-21
J2-5
J1-17
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
In the Distributor Ignition (Dl) system and the fuel injector circuit, the supply voltage comes from the EFI system relay. From the EFI system relay, CKT 902 delivers supply voltage to the injector/ECM fuse, and to the ignition coil. After supply voltage passes through the injector/ECM fuse, it branches out into two separate CKTs 439. The ECM will control the opening and closing of the injectors through injector driver CKT 467 and CKT 468 by connecting them to ground.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
This chart assumes that battery voltage and engine cranking speed are OK, and there is adequate fuel in the tank. Water or foreign material in fuel system can cause a no start. A defective MAP sensor may cause a no start or a start and stall condition. To determine if the MAP sensor is causing the problem, disconnect the electrical connector. The ECM will then use a default value for the sensor. If the condition is corrected and the connections are OK, then replace the sensor. An intermittent may be caused by a poor connection, rubbed through wire insulation or a wire broken inside the insulation. Check for the following items: Poor connection or damaged harness. Inspect the ECM harness and connectors for improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, poor terminal to wire connection, and damaged harness. If above are all OK, refer to Hard Start in Troubleshooting section.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-27
DIAGNOSTICS
6.
Step 7.
Step 8.
Index
Page 5I-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
An intermittent may be caused by a poor connection, rubbed through wire insulation or a wire broken inside the insulation. Check for the following items: Poor connection or damaged harness. Inspect the ECM harness and connectors for improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, poor terminal to wire connection and damaged harness. Contaminated or dirty fuel may cause the fuel pump to seize, which will cause the fuel pump relay fuse to fail. The ability to maintain a constant fuel pressure is very critical in the driveability of fuel injection. If the fuel pressure drops below the specification of that application, multiple driveability problems may occur. The vessel may have to be operated under a load, or certain conditions, as the lack of fuel pressure may be intermittent.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-29
DIAGNOSTICS
pressure with pump running. The pressure may drop after the pump stops running, but should not drop immediately to 0 psi. Is fuel pressure below 25 psi (172 kPa)?
3.
Step 6.
4.
With engine still idling, connect an external vacuum source to the fuel pressure regulator and apply 10 Step 13. Step 11. inches of vacuum. Did fuel pressure drop by approximately 5 psi (34 kPa)? Was fuel pressure present at all? Does the system establish fuel pressure and then drop quickly to 0 psi?
a. Ignition OFF. b. Block fuel pressure line between the fuel pump and Step 6. Step 7. Chart A-5 Step 9.
5. 6.
7.
throttle body inlet fitting. c. Ignition ON. Does fuel pressure hold?
a. Ignition OFF. b. Block fuel return line. c. Ignition ON.
Step 10.
Step 8.
8.
Check for restricted fuel lines. Locate and repair leaking injector(s) or fuel line connections. Replace faulty fuel pressure regulator. Check for leaking pump fittings or lines, inlet filter, and low battery voltage. If OK, replace faulty fuel pump.
Problem is intermittent or fuel supply to engine is restricted or low. Verify Repair
Index
Page 5I-30 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
87a FUEL PUMP RELAY 30 85 86 87 450 BLK/WHT OR BLK 465 DK GRN/WHT
MEFI 1 J2-9
MEFI 3 J1-23
120 GRY
150 BLK
FUEL PUMP
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION
The fuel system circuit receives a supply voltage from the system relay CKT 902. The fuel system is protected by a 15 amp fuse. After the fuse, supply voltage is delivered by CKT 339 to fuel pump relay terminal 30. The fuel pump relay is turned on by the ECM by supplying voltage to CKT 465. The fuel pump relay will remain ON as long as the engine is running or cranking and the ECM is receiving reference pulses. If no reference pulses are present, the ECM de-energizes the fuel pump relay within 2 seconds after the ignition is turned ON or the engine is stopped.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
An intermittent may be caused by a poor connection, rubbed through wire insulation or a wire broken inside the insulation. Check for the following items: Poor connection or damaged harness. Inspect the ECM harness and connectors for improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, poor terminal to wire connections and damaged harness. Contaminated or dirty fuel may cause the fuel pump to seize, which will cause the fuel pump relay fuse to fail.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-31
DIAGNOSTICS
Step 9.
Step 10.
Index
Page 5I-32 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
IGNITION
86 30
85 87 902 RED
TO ECM
INJ/ECM/KS MODULE
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
Battery voltage is constantly supplied to terminal 30 of the system relay. When the ignition switch is moved to the RUN position, battery voltage is supplied to terminal 86 of the system relay. The pull-in coil is then energized creating a magnetic field which closes the contacts of the system relay. Voltage and current are then supplied to the ignition control module, injectors, ECM and fuel pump relay through terminal 87 CKT 902 of the system relay.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
An intermittent may be caused by a poor connection, rubbed through wire insulation or a wire broken inside the insulation. Check for the following items: Poor connection or damaged harness. Inspect the ECM harness and connectors for improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, poor terminal to wire connection and damaged harness. Contaminated or dirty fuel may cause the fuel pump to seize, which will cause the fuel pump relay fuse to fail.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-33
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
Page 5I-34 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 1 J2-23 J2-8 J2-24 J2-6 MEFI 3
HARNESS CONNECTOR
E D C B A
NOT USED 112 DK GRN 31 TAN 31 TAN 3 PNK 931 BRN TO IGN
931 BRN
121 WHT
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-35
DIAGNOSTICS
DISTRIBUTOR
WHT/GRN
WHT/RED
ECM
MEFI 1
439 PNK 430 PPL/WHT B+ 902 RED 121 WHT
MEFI 3
J2-10
121 WHT
+
IGNITION COIL
J1-2
MEFI 1
F E D
Index
Page 5I-36 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-37
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
Page 5I-38 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
11.
Check for spark from the coil wire as the test battery lead is removed? Step 16. Step 12. Is Adequate Spark Present? Replace ignition coil and recheck for spark using Steps 10. and 11. Step 13. Is Adequate Spark Present? Reinstall coil and check coil wire from distributor cap. If OK, replace ignition module. Check for faulty connections or open tach lead. If OK, replace ignition module and recheck for spark using Steps 10. and 11. Is Adequate Spark Present? Replace ignition coil. Is the rotating pole piece still magnetized? Replace faulty pick-up coil. Inspect distributor cap for water, cracks, etc. If OK, replace faulty distributor rotor. Check for open or short to ground in CKT 3, open CKT 902, open or short to ground in CKT 121. If OK, replace faulty ignition coil. Check ignition module ground. If OK, replace faulty ignition module. Replace distributor pole piece and shaft assembly. A mechanical repair will be necessary before continuing with this test. Locate and repair intermittent faulty connections. Verify Repair
12. 13.
14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. 23.
Step 15.
Verify Repair
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-39
DIAGNOSTICS
25.
Is There Spark at Coil? a. Substitute a new ignition coil. 27. b. Repeat above test. Is There Spark at Coil? 28. 29. 30. 31. 32. 33. Check IGN / INJ fuse. Is Fuse Good? Replace ignition sensor in distributor. Install new ignition coil. Repair CKT 430. Repair open CKT 439 to distributor. Replace fuse. Verify Repair Step 32. Step 33. Step 30. Step 31.
Index
Page 5I-40 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The ECM controls idle speed to a calibrated desired rpm based on sensor inputs and actual engine rpm. The ECM uses four (4) circuits to move the Idle Air Control (IAC) valve. The movement of the IAC valve varies the amount of air flow bypassing the throttle plates. The ECM controls idle speed by determining the position of the IAC valve.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
An intermittent may be caused by a poor connection, rubbed through wire insulation or a wire broken inside the insulation. Check for the following items: Poor connection or damaged harness. Inspect the ECM harness and connectors for improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, poor terminal to wire connection, and damaged harness. Check for vacuum leaks, disconnected or brittle vacuum hoses, cuts, etc. Examine manifold and throttle body gaskets for proper seal. Check for cracked intake manifold. Check for poor connections, opens, or short to grounds in CKTs 441, 442, 443, and 444. This may result in improper idle control. An IAC valve which is frozen and will not respond to the ECM, a throttle stop screw which has been tampered with, or a damaged throttle body or linkage may cause improper idle.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-41
DIAGNOSTICS
Verify Repair
Index
Page 5I-42 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 1 J2-23 J2-8 J2-24 J2-6 MEFI 3 J1-10 J2-10 J1-24 J1-3
HARNESS CONNECTOR
E D C B A
NOT USED 112 DK GRN 31 TAN 31 TAN 3 PNK 931 BRN TO IGN
931 BRN
121 WHT
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-43
DIAGNOSTICS
MEFI 3
DISTRIBUTOR
WHT/GRN
WHT/RED
ECM
MEFI 1
439 PNK 430 PPL/WHT B+ 902 RED 121 WHT
MEFI 3
J2-10
121 WHT
+
IGNITION COIL
J1-2
MEFI 1
F E D
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
Several discrete switch inputs are utilized by the fuel injection system to identify abnormal conditions that may affect engine operation. A pull-up switch is currently used in conjunction with the ECM to detect critical conditions to engine operation. If a discrete switch changes states from its normal at-rest position, that is normally open to closed (or closed to open), the ECM senses a change in voltage and responds by activating the audio warning system.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check engine oil and gear lube levels. An intermittent problem may be caused by a poor or corroded connection, rubbed through wire connection, or a wire that is broken inside the insulation.
Index
Page 5I-44 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
TESTING BUZZER
Step Key ON, Engine OFF. Does buzzer sound? Start engine. Does buzzer sound? a. Disconnect TAN/BLU or BLU wire at buzzer. 3. b. Key ON, Engine OFF. c. Touch TAN/BLU or BLU wire to ground (). Does buzzer sound? 4. 5. 6. Buzzer is working properly. Proceed to Testing Switches or Testing Circuits. Ensure that there is battery power (+) to the PUR wire going to buzzer. If there is, replace buzzer. Discrete switches may all be functioning properly. Proceed to check all discrete circuits to verify each works properly. Verify Repair. Verify Repair. Step 4. Step 5. Action Yes No
PROCEED TO
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-45
DIAGNOSTICS
PROCEED TO
PROCEED TO
3. 4.
Index
Page 5I-46 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
PROCEED TO
3. 4.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-47
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
Page 5I-48 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Diagnostic Testing
Code 14 (1 of 3): Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor Circuit
ECM
MEFI 1 J1-2 J1-29 MEFI 3 J2-11 J2-18
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor uses a thermistor to control the signal voltage to the ECM. The ECM applies a voltage on CKT 410 to the sensor. When the engine coolant is cold, the sensor (thermistor) resistance is high. Therefore, the ECM will see high signal voltage. As the engine coolant warms, the sensor resistance becomes less and the voltage drops.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If the harness appears to be OK, observe the ECT display on the scan tool while moving connectors and wiring harnesses related to the ECT sensor. A change in the ECT display will indicate the location of the fault. A scan tool displays engine coolant temperature in degrees celsius and fahrenheit. If the engine is cold (not running within 8 hours), the scan tool should display a ECT sensor value within a few degrees of outside air temperature. This may help aid in diagnosing a shifted coolant sensor. After engine is started, the temperature should rise steadily and then stabilize at operating temperature when the thermostat opens. Check harness routing for a potential short to ground in CKT 410.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-49
DIAGNOSTICS
4. 5.
Step 6.
Step 7.
Index
Page 5I-50 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-51
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 3 J2-11 J2-18
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) Sensor uses a thermistor to control the signal voltage to the ECM. The ECM applies a voltage on CKT 410 to the sensor. When the engine coolant is cold, the sensor (thermistor) resistance is high, therefore, the ECM will see high signal voltage. As the engine coolant warms, the sensor resistance becomes less, and the voltage drops.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If the harness appears to be OK, observe the ECT display on the scan tool while moving connectors and wiring harnesses related to the ECT sensor. A change in the ECT display will indicate the location of the fault. A scan tool displays engine coolant temperature in degrees celsius and fahrenheit. If the engine is cold (not running within 8 hours), the scan tool should display a ECT sensor value within a few degrees of outside air temperature. After engine is started, the temperature should rise steadily and then stabilize at operating temperature when the thermostat opens. Check harness routing for a potential short to ground in CKT 410.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
Page 5I-52 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-53
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
B B
C A
C A
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The Throttle Position (TP) Sensor provides a voltage signal that changes as throttle blades open or close. Signal voltage should vary from about .5 volts at idle to about 4.5 volts at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The TP signal is one of the most important inputs used by the Electronic Control Module (ECM) for fuel control and for most of the ECM controlled outputs.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If the harness appears to be OK, observe the TP sensor display on the scan tool while moving connectors and wiring harnesses related to the TP sensor. A change in the TP sensor display will indicate the location of the fault. The scan tool reads throttle position in voltage and percentage relative to the throttle blade opening With ignition ON, engine OFF, throttle blades closed (idle), the voltage should be 0.3-0.8 volts The voltage should steadily increase as the throttle is moved toward Wide Open Throttle (WOT). If DTC 34 is also set, check for a short to ground in CKT 416.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
Page 5I-54 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
5.
8.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-55
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
Page 5I-56 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 3 J2-3 J2-26 J2-4
C A
B
C
B
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The Throttle Position (TP) Sensor provides a voltage signal that changes as throttle blades open or close. Signal voltage should vary from about .5 volts at idle to about 4.5 volts at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). The TP signal is one of the most important inputs used by the Electronic Control Module (ECM) for fuel control and for most of the ECM controlled outputs.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If the harness appears to be OK, observe the TP sensor display on the scan tool while moving connectors and wiring harnesses related to the TP sensor. A change in the TP sensor display will indicate the location of the fault. The scan tool reads throttle position in voltage and percentage relative to the throttle blade opening With ignition ON, engine OFF, throttle blades closed (idle), the voltage should be 0.3-0.8 volts The voltage should steadily increase as the throttle is moved toward Wide Open Throttle (WOT). If DTC 34 is also set, check for a short to ground in CKT 416.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-57
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
Page 5I-58 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-59
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
B A
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor uses a thermistor to control the signal voltage to the ECM. The ECM applies a voltage on CKT 472 to the sensor. When the intake air is cold, the sensor (thermistor) resistance is high, therefore, the ECM will see high signal voltage. As the intake air warms, the sensor resistance becomes less, and the voltage drops. At normal engine operating temperature, 160-180F (71-82C), the voltage will measure about 1.5 to 2.0 volts.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If the harness appears to be OK, observe the IAT display on the scan tool while moving connectors and wiring harnesses related to the IAT sensor. A change in the IAT display will indicate the location of the fault. The scan tool displays intake air temperature in degrees Celsius and Fahrenheit. If the intake air is cold (not running within 8 hours), the scan tool should display a IAT sensor value within a few degrees of outside air temperature. This may help aid in diagnosing a shifted sensor. After engine is started, the temperature should rise steadily and then stabilize at operating temperature. If DTC 21 is also set, check for open ground CKT 813.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
Page 5I-60 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-61
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
B A
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The Intake Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor uses a thermistor to control the signal voltage to the ECM. The ECM applies a voltage on CKT 472 to the sensor. When the intake air is cold, the sensor (thermistor) resistance is high, therefore, the ECM will see high signal voltage. As the intake air warms, the sensor resistance becomes less, and the voltage drops. At normal engine operating temperature, 160-180F (71-82C), the voltage will measure about 1.5 to 2.0 volts.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If the harness appears to be OK, observe the IAT display on the scan tool while moving connectors and wiring harnesses related to the IAT sensor. A change in the IAT display will indicate the location of the fault. The scan tool displays intake air temperature in degrees celsius and fahrenheit. If the engine is cold (not running within 8 hours), the scan tool should display a IAT sensor value within a few degrees of outside air temperature. This may help aid in diagnosing a shifted sensor. After engine is started, the temperature should rise steadily and then stabilize at operating temperature. Check harness routing for a potential short to ground in CKT 472.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
Page 5I-62 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-63
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 1 J1-31 J1-9 J1-29 MEFI 3 J2-19 J2-27 J2-18
814 BLK
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor responds to changes in manifold pressure (vacuum). The ECM receives this information as a signal voltage that will vary from about 1.0-2.0 volts at idle to about 4.0-5.0 volts at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). If the MAP sensor fails, the ECM will substitute a default MAP value that will vary with rpm. A reference voltage of 5 volts is provided to the MAP sensor through CKT 416. CKT 814 is the ground circuit for the MAP sensor. MAP sensor CKT 432 will send a voltage signal to the ECM proportional to the manifold pressure.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If the harness appears to be OK, observe the MAP sensor display on the scan tool while moving connectors and wiring harnesses related to the MAP sensor. A change in the MAP sensor display will indicate the location of the fault. If the idle is rough or unstable, refer to Troubleshooting section for items which may cause an unstable idle. With the ignition ON, engine OFF, the manifold pressure is equal to atmospheric pressure and the signal voltage will be high. This information is used by the ECM as an indication of altitude and is referred to as BARO. Comparison of this BARO reading, with a known good MAP sensor, is a good way to check the accuracy of a suspect sensor. Reading should be the same, plus or minus 0.4 volt. If DTC 14 is also set, check for open in ground CKT 814.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
Page 5I-64 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
6.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-65
DIAGNOSTICS
Is trouble code 34 present? a. MAP sensor harness connector disconnected. b. Ignition ON engine OFF. 9. c. Connect DVOM from harness terminal A CKT 814 to harness terminal C CKT 416. Is voltage reading above 4 volts? 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. Repair low or unsteady vacuum problem. Trouble code is intermittent. Locate and repair intermittent faulty connections. Refer to Diagnostic Aids. Check for plugged or leaking sensor vacuum fitting. If OK, replace faulty MAP sensor. Locate and repair short to voltage in CKT 432 or faulty ECM connections. Locate and repair open in CKT 814 or repair faulty ECM connections.
Index
Page 5I-66 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 3
MANIFOLD PRESSURE (VACUUM)
814 BLK
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The Manifold Absolute Pressure (MAP) sensor responds to changes in manifold pressure (vacuum). The ECM receives this information as a signal voltage that will vary from about 1.0-2.0 volts at idle to about 4.0-5.0 volts at Wide Open Throttle (WOT). If the MAP sensor fails, the ECM will substitute a default MAP value that will vary with rpm. A reference voltage of 5 volts is provided to the MAP sensor through CKT 416. CKT 814 is the ground circuit for the MAP sensor. MAP sensor CKT 432 will send a voltage signal to the ECM proportional to the manifold pressure.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If the harness appears to be OK, observe the MAP sensor display on the scan tool while moving connectors and wiring harnesses related to the MAP sensor. A change in the MAP sensor display will indicate the location of the fault. If the idle is rough or unstable, refer to Troubleshooting section for items which may cause an unstable idle. With the ignition ON, engine OFF, the manifold pressure is equal to atmospheric pressure and the signal voltage will be high. This information is used by the ECM as an indication of altitude and is referred to as BARO. Comparison of this BARO reading, with a known good MAP sensor, is a good way to check the accuracy of a suspect sensor. Reading should be the same, plus or minus 0.4 volt. If DTC 14 is also set, check for open in ground CKT 814.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-67
DIAGNOSTICS
6.
7.
Index
Page 5I-68 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-69
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 3 J1-10 J2-10 J1-24 J1-3
TACH
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
When the system is running on the ignition module or in crank mode, there is no voltage on CKT 424, and the ignition module grounds CKT 423. The ECM expects to detect a low voltage on CKT 423 during this condition. If the ECM sees voltage, it sets Code 41 and will not go into the Ignition Control (IC) mode. When the rpm for IC is reached (about 300 rpm), and CKT 424 voltage applied, CKT 423 should no longer be grounded in the ignition module, and the voltage should be varying. If CKT 424 is open or grounded, the ignition module will not switch to IC mode. The CKT 423 voltage will be low and Code 42 will be set. If CKT 423 stays grounded, the IC module will switch to IC mode but, because the line is grounded, there will not be an IC signal and a trouble code 42 will be set.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If the engine starts and stalls, it may set a false DTC 41 or 42. Clear DTC and repair stalling condition.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
Page 5I-70 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-71
DIAGNOSTICS
ECM
MEFI 1 J2-23 J2-8 J2-24 J2-6
TACH
When the system is running on the ignition module or in crank mode, there is no voltage on CKT 424 and the ignition module grounds CKT 423. The ECM expects to detect a low voltage on CKT 423 during this condition. If the ECM sees voltage, it sets Code 41 and will not go into the Ignition Control (IC) mode. When the rpm for IC is reached (about 300 rpm), and CKT 424 voltage applied, CKT 423 should no longer be grounded in the ignition module, and the voltage should be varying. If CKT 424 is open or grounded, the ignition module will not switch to IC mode. The CKT 423 voltage will be low and Code 42 will be set. If CKT 423 stays grounded, the IC module will switch to IC mode but, because the line is grounded, there will not be an IC signal and a trouble code 42 will be set.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If the engine starts and stalls, it may set a false DTC 41 or 42. Clear DTC and repair stalling condition.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
Page 5I-72 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
4.
7.
8. 9. 10. 11.
Step 10.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-73
DIAGNOSTICS
TO SYSTEM RELAY
ECM
MEFI 1
KNOCK SENSOR MODULE 486 PUR 496 DK BLU 485 GRN
MEFI 3
J1-1 J1-30
KNOCK SENSOR
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
MEFI 1 Engine detonation or spark knock is sensed with a module that sends a voltage signal to the ECM. As the knock sensor detects engine knock, the voltage from the KS module to the ECM drops, and this signals the ECM to start retarding timing. The ECM will retard timing when knock is detected and rpm and engine coolant temperature are above a certain value. MEFI 3 Engine detonation or spark knock is detected with a sensor that sends a voltage signal to the ECM. As the knock sensor detects engine knock, the voltage output level increases and this signals the ECM to start retarding timing. The ECM will retard timing when knock is detected and rpm and engine coolant temperature are above a certain value. NOTE: MEFI 3 products do not have a knock module. The sensor connects directly to the ECM.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If CKT 496 is routed too close to secondary ignition wires, the KS module may see the interference as a knock signal, resulting in false timing retard.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared. NOTE: If there are abnormal mechanical engine noises (rattles or knocks), they may give a false DTC 43. If fuel octane is too low, a false DTC 43 may be set.
Index
Page 5I-74 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-75
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
Page 5I-76 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
TO SYSTEM RELAY
ECM
MEFI 3
KNOCK SENSOR MODULE 486 PUR 496 DK BLU 485 GRN
J1-30
KNOCK SENSOR
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
MEFI 1 Engine detonation or spark knock is sensed with a module that sends a voltage signal to the ECM. As the knock sensor detects engine knock, the voltage from the KS module to the ECM drops, and this signals the ECM to start retarding timing. The ECM will retard timing when knock is detected and rpm and engine coolant temperature are above a certain value. MEFI 3 Engine detonation or spark knock is detected with a sensor that sends a voltage signal to the ECM. As the knock sensor detects engine knock, the voltage output level increases and this signals the ECM to start retarding timing. The ECM will retard timing when knock is detected and rpm and engine coolant temperature are above a certain value. NOTE: MEFI 3 products do not have a knock module. The sensor connects directly to the ECM.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. If CKT 496 is routed too close to secondary ignition wires, the KS module may see the interference as a knock signal, resulting in false timing retard.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared. NOTE: if fuel octane is too high, a false DTC 44 may be set.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-77
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
Page 5I-78 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-79
DIAGNOSTICS
B+
902 RED
+
IGNITION COIL
121 WHT
121 WHT
TO IGN TEMP SENDER 121 WHT A 901 TAN 3 PNK B C 208 BRN 585 TAN/WHT 29 DK GRN
F E D
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
On MEFI 3 product, the coil driver circuitry is integrated into the ECM. When the engine is running, a diagnostic check of the coil drive circuitry is constantly taking place. If the diagnostic system detects excessive current to the coil through CKT 121, a fault code will set although the engine should continue to operate.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage. Shorted CKT 121 or tach lead in harness. Damaged ignition coil or improper coil. The ignition system is calibrated for Mercury approved coils only.
Index
Page 5I-80 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Code 45 (2 of 2):
Step Action Was the On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check Performed? a. Ignition ON, engine OFF. 2. b. Using DVOM, measure voltage at coil positive (+) terminal. Is Voltage Greater Than 12 Volts? a. Ignition OFF. b. Disconnect ECM J1 connector. 3. c. Check continuity from ECM CKT 121 to negative () terminal of coil. Is Resistance Less Than 1 ohm? a. Ignition OFF. 4. b. Disconnect ECM J1 connector. c. Check resistance from ECM CKT 121 to ground. Is Resistance Less Than 1 ohm? a. Ignition OFF. b. Disconnect ECM J1 connector. 5. c. Check resistance between positive (+) and negative () terminals of coil. Is Resistance Less Than 2 ohms? a. Ignition OFF. b. Disconnect ECM J1 connector. c. Remove secondary ignition wire from coil. 6. d. Measure resistance between secondary coil tower and negative terminal of coil. Is Resistance Greater Than 5 Ohms And Less Than 15 ohms? 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. Locate and repair open or short to ground in CKT 902. Locate and repair open in CKT 121. Locate and repair short to ground in CKT 121. Replace ignition coil. Trouble code 44 is intermittent. Check ignition wires and plugs. Verify Repair Step 11. Step 10. Step 6. Step 10. Step 9. Step 5. Step 4. Step 8. Step 3. Step 7. Yes No PROCEED TO 1. Step 2. OBD
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-81
DIAGNOSTICS
76358
72801
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
This test allows the ECM to check for a calibration failure by comparing the calibration value to a known value stored in the EEPROM. This test is also used as a security measure to prevent improper use of calibrations or changes to these calibrations that may alter the designed function of EFI.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
If DTC 51 failed more than once, but is intermittent, replace the ECM. Step Action Was the On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check Performed? Ignition ON. Clear trouble code 51. Does Code 51 reset? 3. Fault is not present at this time. Replace faulty ECM and verify trouble code 51 does not reset. Step 4. Refer to Diagnostic Aids Verify Repair VALUE YES NO
2.
4.
Index
Page 5I-82 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
76358
72801
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
This test allows the ECM to check for a calibration failure by comparing the calibration value to a known value stored in the EEPROM. This test is also used as a security measure to prevent improper use of calibrations or changes to these calibrations that may alter the designed function of EFI.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
If DTC 52 failed more than once, but is intermittent, replace the ECM. Step Action Was the On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) System Check Performed? a. Clear trouble code 52. 2. b. Ignition ON. Does trouble code 52 reset? 3. Replace faulty ECM and verify trouble code 52 does not reset. Verify Repair Step 3. Yes No
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-83
DIAGNOSTICS
C A
C A
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The fuel pressure (FP) Sensor provides a voltage signal that changes with measured fuel pressure. Signal voltage should be between 2.5 and 3.5 volts. The FP signal provides inputs to the Electronic Control Module (ECM) for fuel control.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage and test by moving the FP connector and harness. The scan tool reads fuel pressure in voltage relative to the pressure regulator setting. With ignition ON, engine OFF, the voltage should be 2.5-3.5 volts. If DTC 62 is also set, check for a short to ground in CKT 416.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
Page 5I-84 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
5.
8.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-85
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
Page 5I-86 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
C A
C A
CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION:
The fuel pressure (FP) Sensor provides a voltage signal that changes with measured fuel pressure. Signal voltage should be between 2.5 and 3.5 volts. The FP signal provides inputs to the Electronic Control Module (ECM) for fuel control.
DIAGNOSTIC AIDS:
Check for the following conditions: Poor connection at ECM. Inspect harness connectors for backed out terminals, improper mating, broken locks, improperly formed or damaged terminals, and poor terminal to wire connection. Damaged harness. Inspect the wiring harness for damage and test by moving the FP connector and harness. The scan tool reads fuel pressure in voltage relative to the pressure regulator setting. With ignition ON, engine OFF, the voltage should be 2.5-3.5 volts. If DTC 61 is also set, check for a short to ground in CKT 416.
After repairs, clear DTC following Clearing Trouble Codes procedure at the front of this section. Failure to do so may result in DTC not properly being cleared.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-87
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
Page 5I-88 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 5I-89
DIAGNOSTICS
Index
Page 5I-90 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
COOLING SYSTEM
Section 6A - Seawater Cooled Models
Table of Contents
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seawater Inlet Recommendations . . . . . Transom Mounted or Through The Hull Seawater Pickups and Hose . . . . . . . Seacock (Seawater Inlet Valve) . . . . . Sea Strainer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seawater Pickups . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Through The Hull Mounted . . . . . . . . . Transom Mounted . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Quicksilver Sea Strainer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seawater Pickup Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Output Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6A-2 6A-2 6A-2 6A-3 6A-3 6A-4 6A-4 6A-4 6A-4 6A-5 6A-5 6A-6 6A-7 6A-7 6A-9 6A-9 6A-11 6A-11 6A-13 6A-14 Seawater Pump Bearing Housing . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Water Circulating Pump . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Drive Belt Tension Adjustment . . . . . . . . Flushing Seawater Cooling System . . . . Thermostat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Auxiliary Hot Water Heater Installation Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Seawater Flow Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Alpha . . . . . . . . . MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Bravo . . . . . . . . . Draining Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Alpha . . . . . . . . . MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Bravo . . . . . . . . . 6A-15 6A-15 6A-16 6A-17 6A-20 6A-20 6A-20 6A-20 6A-21 6A-21 6A-21 6A-21 6A-22 6A-23 6A-24 6A-28 6A-28 6A-29 6A-30 6A-30 6A-31
6
A
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-1
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Alternator Brace to Alternator Alternator Mounting Bracket Alternator Brace to Block Alternator/Power Steering Pump Mounting Bracket Power Steering Pump Bracket Seawater Pump Brace Seawater Pump Bracket To Block Seawater Pump Cover Thermostat Cover Thermostat Housing Thru-Hull Pickup Nut Alternator To Mounting Bracket Water Circulating Pump Seawater Pump Clamping Screw On Casting Bracket Water Temperature Sender Drain Plug (Note) Hose Clamps Petcocks Pulleys NOTE: Coat threads with Quicksilver Perfect Seal before installing. Securely 35 20 48 27 30 41 lb-in. 192 lb-ft Nm 28
Tools
Description Universal Puller Plate Quicksilver Flushing Attachment Part Number 91-37241 44357A2
Special Tools
Description Kent-Moore Tools, Inc. 29784 Little Mack Roseville, MI 48066 Phone: (313) 574-2332 Pulley Puller (Kent Moore) J-25034-C Part Number
index
Page 6A-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Specifications
Cooling System Capacity Thermostat 15 qts (14 l) 160 F (71 C)
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-3
CAUTION
Do not install water pickup directly in line with propeller, as pickup may create turbulence and allow air to flow into the propeller slipstream. This will cause propeller ventilation and will adversely affect boat performance. Water pickup should be located as close to seawater pickup pump inlet as possible and in an area where an uninterrupted, solid stream of water will flow past when boat is underway. Connect water pickup to seawater pickup pump inlet with 1-1/4 in. (32 mm) I.D. wire reinforced hose of adequate wall thickness to prevent it from collapsing from pump suction. Be sure to secure hose connections with hose clamps.
70355
Seacock (With Through The Hull Pickup Shown) a - Hose Connector [1-1/4 in. (32mm) I.D.] to Seawater Pump Inlet b - Seacock [1-1/4 In. (32mm)] Brass Ball or Gate Valve c - Seawater Pickup d - Direction of Seawater Flow
Sea Strainer
If boat is equipped with a sea strainer, it must be of sufficient size to ensure that an adequate supply of water is maintained for engine cooling. Install seawater strainer in an area where it will be easily accessible for inspection and cleaning. Strainer should be installed in water inlet hose after water inlet valve to allow operator to shut off water when cleaning strainer.
index
Page 6A-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Seawater Pickups
NOTICE Refer to manufacturer s instructions for information on removal and installation of other than Quicksilver Seawater Pickups. IMPORTANT: Seal the inside edges of any hole made through the hull with a suitable sealant to prevent water absorption and deterioration.
a
a b c d Seawater Pickup Seawater Inlet Slots - Mounting Screw Holes (If Equipped) - Nut
-
72639
1. Seal inside edges of 1-3/4 in. (44 mm) hole in hull using a suitable sealer. 2. Apply marine caulking (sealer) to mounting surface on seawater pickup where hull contact will occur when installed. IMPORTANT: Seawater inlet slots must face forward - parallel with the flow of water. 3. Ensure slots in seawater pickup are facing forward (toward bow of boat) and install seawater pickup through hull. 4. Fasten pickup with four appropriate mounting screws (if equipped). 5. Apply marine caulking as needed inside boat. Apply Loctite 27131 to threads of nut and install on pickup on inside of boat and torque nut to 35 lb-ft (42 Nm). NOTE: If pickup being installed does not have mounting screws on underside where mounted to hull, be certain, after nut is torqued, that slots are still facing forward.
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-5
Transom Mounted
(Quicksilver Part Number: 88845A1)
i j
Seawater Pickup Installation a - Hose Fitting b - Nuts (4) c - Gasket - Between Pickup and Transom d - O-Ring (4) e - Washer (4) f - Screw (4) g - Plastic Plug h - Pickup i - Screen j - Screw 1. Seal the inside edges of the 1-1/2 in. (38 mm) hole for hose fitting. 2. Be certain hose fitting and plastic plug are in place and threads have been sealed with Loctite Pipe Sealant with Teflon prior to tightening each securely. 3. Position one flat washer and one rubber O-ring on each 5/16 in. x 4 in. (102 mm) long, round head screw as shown. Coat each screw shaft with silicone sealant or equivalent. 4. Place new gasket on pickup housing and hold pickup in place on transom. Install four round head screws (with washers and O-rings in place) into pickup mounting holes and through drilled 21/64 in. (8.5 mm) holes in transom.
72640
index
Page 6A-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
NOTE: Some installations may have 7/32 in. (5.5 mm) holes drilled in transom using four 5/16 in. diameter stainless steel lag bolts in place of round head screws. In any case, flat washers and O-rings are required as outlined.
72641
Water Pickup Installed on Transom a - Diagonal Mount - Leading Edge of Pickup 1/8 in. (3mm) from Boat Bottom b - Vertical Mount - Corner of Leading Edge of Pickup 1/8 in. (3mm) from Boat Bottom 5. Secure water pickup from inside with locknuts and washers (unless using lag bolts). 6. Tighten fasteners securely.
Removal
CAUTION
If boat is in water while working on seawater strainer, close seacock, if so equipped. If boat is not equipped with a seacock, remove and plug seawater inlet hose to prevent a siphoning action that may occur, allowing seawater to flow from the drain holes or removed hoses and enter boat. IMPORTANT: Be certain engine is off and cooling system is cold. 1. Models Equipped with Seacock: a. Close seacock (seawater inlet valve). b. Disconnect seawater inlet hose from seawater strainer.
b
72691
a b
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-7
2. Models without Seacock: a. Disconnect seawater inlet hose from seawater strainer inlet and plug seawater inlet hose.
b
a b c d Seawater Inlet Hose Seawater Strainer - Seawater Strainer Inlet - Plug
-
70062
a b
a b
72643
index
Page 6A-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
b c d e h
f g
72673
Quicksilver Seawater Strainer Shown a - Screws and Washers b - Cover c - Glass d - O-Ring e - Strainer f - Housing g - Drain Plug and Sealing Washer h - Gasket 3. Flush components with clean water.
Installation
IMPORTANT: Mount seawater strainer in a vibration-free location. Never mount it on the engine or transmission. Hoses must not be kinked or allowed to come in contact with hot or moving engine or transmission parts. 1. Mount seawater strainer. Arrow indicates required water flow direction and must point toward seawater pump. Tighten mounting bolts securely.
a c
a b c
-
c
72644
Seawater Strainer Arrow - Mounting Bolt Hole Location (Bolts Not Shown)
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-9
2. Remove plug from seawater inlet hose (if installed previously) and install hose on strainer. Install seawater outlet hose. Use two hose clamps on each hose connection. Tighten clamps securely.
a
72645
a b c
3. Check drain plug and lens cover bolts. Tighten securely. Do not overtighten cover bolts or cover may warp and leak water into boat.
a
72644
a b
Drain Plug - Lens Cover Bolts (2, One Hidden In This View)
-
index
Page 6A-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
1. Models With Engine Mounted Seawater Pump - remove water hose, which runs between pump outlet and engine, and replace with another hose of same diameter, but approximately 3 ft (1 m) longer. Hose should be of adequate wall thickness to prevent it from kinking when performing test. Clamp hose at pump outlet only. Do not clamp hose at engine end.
b a
a b Seawater Inlet Hose - Hose To Cooler
-
75533
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-11
2. Models With Sterndrive (Alpha) Mounted Seawater Pump - remove water inlet hose, which runs between gimbal housing water tube and engine, and replace with another hose of same diameter, but approximately 3 ft (1 m) longer. Hose should be of adequate wall thickness to prevent it from kinking when performing test. Clamp hose at gimbal housing water tube only. Do not clamp hose at engine end.
a
a b c Water Tube Hose Clamp - Water Hose
-
b
72614
3. Place an 8 U.S. qt. (7.6 l) or larger container near unclamped end of hose. 4. With assistance of another person, start engine and adjust speed to exactly 1000 rpm while holding unclamped end of hose on connection on engine. Remove hose from connection on engine and direct water flow into container for exactly 15 seconds. At the end of 15 seconds, direct the water flow overboard, return engine to idle and stop engine. Reconnect hose to engine. 5. Measure quantity of water discharged into container and compare with specifications given in the following chart. 6. Repeat test four times to check repeatability of results. Engine Mounted Seawater Pump Output for a 15 Second Period 7.5 U.S. qt. (7.1 l) Minimum
Alpha Sterndrive Seawater Pump Output for a 15 Second Period Drive Unit Gear Ratio 1.98:1 1.84:1 1.65:1 1.50:1 1.32:1 Minimum Quantity U.S. qts.(l) 3.0 (2.8) 3.3 (3.1) 3.6 (3.4) 4.0 (3.8) 4.5 (4.3)
NOTE: Refer to Alpha Sterndrive Service Manual for repair of seawater pump.
index
Page 6A-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Disassembly
1. Remove the five screws from the seawater pump body.
a
a b
-
75277
2. Remove seawater pump body and wear plate from bearing housing.
c b a
a b c Seawater Pump Body Wear Plate - Bearing Housing
-
75275
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-13
Reassembly
1. Lubricate seawater pump impeller with a water and soap solution. Install impeller into housing by rotating and pushing it into place. Push it down until flush with housing.
71118
71150
Impeller
2. Place wear plate over bearing housing shaft. 3. Place quad ring in groove in seawater pump body.
a b
4. Align flats on impeller and bearing housing shaft, slide seawater pump body on shaft. NOTE: Reassembly of the pump requires the mounting bracket to be installed while performing the following step. 5. Install two screws in seawater pump body holes as shown. Use these two screws to align pump, then install the remaining screws.
75277
index
Page 6A-14
a
a
-
a
72655
72656
2. Press hub off shaft with Universal Puller Plate and an arbor press.
72648
3. Puncture front oil seal with a tool and pry from bearing housing.
72649
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-15
4. Remove snap ring from bearing housing bore and press shaft and bearings out pulley end of housing. Bearings have a slip fit in housing; do not use excessive force.
72657
72658
Snap Ring
5. If bearings require replacement, remove bearings from shaft with Universal Puller Plate and an arbor press. Bearings must be replaced, if removed.
72659
6. If rear seals require replacement, press seals from bearing housing with an appropriate tool.
index
Page 6A-16
Reassembly
1. Apply a thin coat of Loctite 27131 to outside diameter of two new bearing housing rear seals; then install seals in housing with seal lips facing impeller end. Press first seal in until it bottoms out and second seal in until flush with housing.
a b
72660
a b
IMPORTANT: It is recommended that Shell Alvania No. 2 Grease be used when packing seal and bearings in the following steps. If Shell Alvania No. 2 Grease is not available, it is permissible to use Quicksilver 2-4-C With Teflon. However, Quicksilver 2-4-C Marine Lubricant With Teflon is not recommended for applications where continuous high speed heavy-duty operation will be encountered. 2. Pack cavity between seals with Shell Alvania No. 2 Grease or substitute. 3. Using an arbor press and suitable tool, press ball bearings onto shaft until they seat. Press on inner race of bearing only.
a
a
-
72663
Bearings
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-17
4. Pack bearings and cavity between bearings with Shell Alvania No. 2 Grease or substitute. Slide bearings and shaft into bearing housing bore and install snap ring.
72661
72658
Snap Ring
5. Apply a thin coat of Loctite 27131 to outside diameter of new bearing housing front oil seal and press seal into housing (with seal lip facing inward) until it bottoms out.
72662
IMPORTANT: Be sure to support impeller end of pump shaft when installing pulley hub in next step to prevent placing a load on bearings.
index
Page 6A-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
6. Apply Quicksilver Special Lubricant 101 to pump shaft. Using an arbor press and appropriate tool, press pulley hub onto pump shaft to dimension shown.
72664
IMPORTANT: Pulley hub must be pressed onto shaft to exact dimension on pumps with stamped steel mounting bracket as this establishes proper drive belt alignment. 7. Clamp bearing housing in a soft jaw vise with flange end up. 8. Coat quad ring seal with Quicksilver 2-4-C Marine Lubricant With Teflon and install into groove in housing.
a
72655
a
72660
a b
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-19
Installation
1. Coat both sides of new circulating pump gasket with Quicksilver Perfect Seal, then position gaskets and circulating pump on cylinder block. Coat threads of circulating pump attaching bolts with Quicksilver Perfect Seal and install bolts and alternator brace (if applicable). Torque bolts to specifications. 2. Reconnect hoses to pump. 3. Install pump pulley and clamping ring (if used) on pump hub and secure with bolts and lockwashers. Tighten bolts securely. 4. Install drive belts and adjust tension as outlined in Drive Belt Tension Adjustment. 5. Start engine and check for leaks.
index
Page 6A-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Thermostat
Removal
1. Drain water from cylinder block and exhaust manifolds. 2. Remove thermostat housing and related components. 3. Remove thermostat from thermostat housing or cover.
b c d e
71758
a b c d e
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-21
Testing
1. Clean thermostat in soap and water to remove any deposits or debris. 2. Inspect thermostat for corrosion or other visible damage. 3. If thermostat is suspected of producing insufficient engine temperature, check thermostat for leakage by holding it up to a lighted background. Light leakage around the thermostat valve indicates that thermostat is not closing completely and should be replaced. (A small amount of leakage at one or two points around the valve perimeter is acceptable.)
72717
a
a
-
4. Check opening and closing temperature of thermostat (using a tester similar to the one shown) as follows: a. Fill tester to within 1 in. (25 mm) of top with tap water. Do not use distilled water. b. Open thermostat valve and insert nylon string. Position thermostat on string so that it will be just below water level when suspended, then allow valve to close. Suspend thermostat in water. c. Place thermometer in container and position so that bottom of thermometer is even with bottom of thermostat. Do not allow thermometer to touch container.
a b c
72675
a b c
IMPORTANT: When performing procedures d. - f. water must be agitated thoroughly to obtain accurate results. d. Plug in tester and observe temperature at which thermostat opens (thermostat drops off thread). Thermostat must open at specified temperature stamped on thermostat. e. Continue to heat water until a temperature 25F (14C) above temperature specified on thermostat is obtained. Thermostat valve must be completely open at this temperature.
index
Page 6A-22 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
f.
Unplug tester and allow water to cool to a temperature 10F (5C) below specified temperature on thermostat. Thermostat must be completely closed at this temperature.
Installation
1. Clean gasket surfaces on thermostat housing and intake manifold. IMPORTANT: Gasket has continuity rivets. Do not coat with Quicksilver Perfect Seal, or Audio Warning Temperature Switch may not work properly. 2. Place O-ring in the thermostat housing. Be certain it is positioned properly in housing. 3. Place thermostat in thermostat housing with thermostatic element end toward housing bottom, as shown. 4. Align sleeve with groove in thermostat housing bore and install sleeve into housing. 5. Coat both sides of new thermostat housing gasket with Quicksilver Perfect Seal and position on intake manifold. 6. Reinstall thermostat housing and torque screws with lockwashers to 30 lb-ft (41 Nm). 7. Reconnect hose(s) to thermostat housing. Tighten hose clamps securely.
75846
Hoses
b c d e
a b c d e Housing O-Ring - Thermostat (Stainless Steel) - Spacer - Gasket
71758
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-23
1. Hot water heater supply hose can be connected at several different locations. On some models, there may be other accessories and options that are using these hot water supply locations. One of the following should be available for use when connecting the hot water heater system. NOTE: On some models it may be necessary to remove the audio warning heat switch from port side of thermostat housing and reposition to water circulating pump opening as outlined following. a. Starboard side of thermostat housing, unless being used for engine temperature switch.
75846
IMPORTANT: Do not reposition engine temperature switch, it must remain where installed by factory.
index
Page 6A-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
72708
Intake Manifold (If Engine Temperature Sender is Not Installed at This Location)
74973
Engines with Raw Water Cooling - If Location is Available a - Location for Hot Water Supply
a
71758
Raw Water Cooling Models - Alternate Location a - Location for Hot Water Supply (Install Bayonet Fitting Here)
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-25
2. Connect hot water heater SUPPLY hose to desired location following instructions: a. Remove pipe plug. b. Coat threads of fitting(s) (obtained locally) with Quicksilver Perfect Seal and install fitting(s) in threaded hole from which pipe plug was removed. c. Connect hot water heat supply hose to fitting and secure with a hose clamp (not provided).
75480
3. Connect hot water heater return hose into system as follows (refer to figures): a. Cut approximately 3/4 in. (19 mm) out of hose to maintain proper hose configuration.
72587
Cut Here
index
Page 6A-26 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
b. Secure T-fitting in hose with hose clamps (provided in kit) and tighten securely.
75859
Typical a - T-Fitting c. Connect hot water heater return hose to T-fitting and secure with hose clamp (provided). 4. Secure hoses, as required, to ensure they do not rub or chafe against engine components. 5. With boat in water, start engine and check for leaks and overheating.
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-27
10
4 9
8 3 7
5
75854
1 - Seawater Intake (From Sterndrive) 2 - Power Steering Cooler 3 - Fuel Cooler - EFI Models 4 - Thermostat Housing Assembly 5 - Engine Water Circulating Pump 6 - Engine Block and Cylinder Head Assembly 7 - Exhaust Manifold, Typical 8 - Gasket 9 - Exhaust Elbow Assembly, Typical 10 - Water Flow Overboard
index
Page 6A-28 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
7 11
5 10
9 4 8
6
75861
1 - Seawater Intake(From Through The Hull or Through The Transom Pickup) 2 - Seawater Pump 3 - Power Steering Cooler 4 - Fuel Cooler EFI Models 5 - Thermostat Housing Assembly 6 - Engine Water Circulating Pump 7 - Engine Block and Cylinder Head Assembly 8 - Exhaust Manifold, Typical 9 - Gasket 10 - Exhaust Elbow Assembly, Typical 11 - Overboard (Water and Exhaust Discharge)
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-29
Draining Diagrams
MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Alpha
Two Piece Manifold, One Piece Similar
b c
c a
75854
a b
Remove Hoses (Lift, Lower or Bend To Completely Drain). Remove Block Plugs (Repeatedly Clean Out Holes Using A Stiff Wire Until Entire System Is Drained). c - Remove Drain Plugs From Exhaust Exhaust Manifold Drain Elbows and Fuel Cooler or Water Tube (Repeatedly Clean Out Holes Using A Stiff Wire Until Entire System Is Drained)
-
index
Page 6A-30 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
b c a
c
74818
a b
Remove Hoses (Lift, Lower or Bend To Completely Drain). - Remove Block Plugs (Repeatedly Clean Out Holes Using A Stiff Wire Until Entire System Is Drained). c - Remove Drain Plugs From Exhaust Exhaust Manifold Drain Elbows and Fuel Cooler or Water Tube (Repeatedly Clean Out Holes Using A Stiff Wire Until Entire System Is Drained)
-
index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6A-31
index
Page 6A-32 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
COOLING SYSTEM
Section 6B - Closed Cooled Models
Table of Contents
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Closed Cooling System Capacity . . . Coolant Specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Thermostat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Pressure Cap Rating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Coolant Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . Maintaining Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . . Pressure Cap Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . Heat Exchanger Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing Closed Cooling System . . . . . . . Testing Coolant for Alkalinity . . . . . . . Pressure Testing System . . . . . . . . . . Testing for Cylinder Head Gasket Leak . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing Heat Exchanger . . . . . . . . . . . Testing Pressure Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6B-2 6B-2 6B-2 6B-2 6B-2 6B-2 6B-2 6B-3 6B-3 6B-3 6B-4 6B-5 6B-6 6B-6 6B-6 6B-7 6B-8 6B-8 Thermostat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Changing Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Closed Cooling Section . . . . . . . . . . . . Change Intervals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Draining Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Closed Cooling Section . . . . . . . . . . . . Seawater Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Filling Closed Cooling Section . . . . . . . . Auxiliary Hot Water Heater Installation . Heat Exchanger Bracket Hardware . . . . Heat Exchanger Hose Connections . . . . Water Flow Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Alpha . . . . . . . . . MCM 262 cid / 4.3L Bravo . . . . . . . . . 6B-10 6B-10 6B-11 6B-12 6B-13 6B-13 6B-13 6B-13 6B-14 6B-14 6B-15 6B-16 6B-18 6B-19 6B-20 6B-21 6B-21 6B-22
6
B
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6B-1
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Heat Exchanger End Cap Thermostat Cover Heat Exchanger Mounting Brackets Hose Clamps Drain Plugs Securely lb-in. 36-72 30 lb-ft Nm 4-8 41
Specifications
Closed Cooling System Capacity
NOTICE Unit of Measurement: U.S. Quarts (Liters) All Capacities are approximate fluid measures. Model Seawater Cooling System Closed Cooling System All Engines 15 (14.1) 20 (19)
Coolant Specification
All Models Extended Life Coolant 5/100 (Orange Color)
Thermostat
Engine All Engines Specification 160F (71C)
Index
Page 6B-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Description
The cooling system is composed of two separate subsystems: the seawater system and the closed cooling system. The seawater system is similar in function to the fan used in an automobile because it absorbs heat from the closed cooling system as it passes through the heat exchanger. The closed cooling system is similar in function to the rest of the cooling system in an automobile. The coolant recovery system keeps the reservoir full. Normal coolant overflow into recovery bottle is approximately 1/2 pint (230 mL) during warm-up. The coolant recovery system draws coolant back into the reservoir from the recovery bottle as the engine cools. As long as there is coolant in the recovery bottle, the reservoir should remain completely full. If not, there is a vacuum leak, usually at the hose leaving the reservoir or the gasket under the recovery filler cap. IMPORTANT: The coolant (antifreeze) flows around the outside of the cooling tubes while seawater flows through the inside of the cooling tubes in the heat exchanger.
Coolant Recommendations
CAUTION
Alcohol or Methanol base antifreeze or plain water are not recommended for use in fresh water section of cooling system at any time. NOTE: All factory installed closed cooling systems come filled with Extended Life Coolant. This antifreeze requires draining and replacing every five years or 1000 hours of operation, whichever comes first. For best results any top-off fluid used should be Extended Life Coolant. If Extended Life Coolant is unavailable, any type of ethylene glycol based antifreeze may be used, but it will require the draining and replacing of the coolant every two years or 400 hours of operation, whichever comes first. In areas where the possibility of freezing DOES NOT exist, it is permissible to use solution of rust inhibitor and water (mixed to manufacturers recommendations).
72520
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6B-3
Before starting engine each day, ensure that coolant is visible in coolant recovery bottle. If coolant is not visible, check fresh water section of cooling system (including coolant recovery system) for leaks and repair. Refill fresh water section with recommended coolant solution as outlined under Changing Coolant, following. If coolant is visible, start engine and run until it reaches normal operating temperature, then recheck coolant level in coolant recovery bottle. Coolant level MUST be between the ADD and FULL marks (on front of bottle).
WARNING
Allow engine to cool before removing pressure cap. Sudden loss of pressure could cause hot coolant to boil and discharge violently. After engine has cooled, turn cap 1/4 turn to allow any pressure to escape slowly, then push down and remove cap. If level is low, remove fill cap from coolant recovery bottle and add required amount of coolant solution. Refer to Coolant recommendations in this section. IMPORTANT: ALCOHOL OR METHANOL BASE ANTIFREEZE OR PLAIN WATER ARE NOT RECOMMENDED FOR USE IN COOLING SYSTEM AT ANY TIME. In areas where ethylene glycol is not available, and the possibility of freezing does not exist, it is permissible to use a solution of rust inhibitor and pure, soft water (mixed to manufacturers recommendations). Occasionally, ensure that coolant recovery system is functioning properly by removing pressure cap from heat exchanger and checking level. Coolant level should be up to bottom of heat exchanger filler neck. If low, examine entire fresh water section (especially coolant recovery system) for leaks and repair. IMPORTANT: When reinstalling pressure cap, tighten it until it contacts on filler neck.
WARNING
Allow engine to cool before removing pressure cap. Sudden loss of pressure could cause hot coolant to boil and discharge violently. After engine has cooled, turn cap 1/4 turn to allow any pressure to escape slowly, then push down and turn cap all the way off. 1. Remove pressure cap from heat exchanger. 2. Wash cap with clean water to remove any deposits or debris from sealing surfaces. 3. Inspect rubber seal on cap for cuts, cracks or other signs of deterioration. If seal is damaged, cap MUST be replaced. 4. Inspect coolant recovery gasket for deterioration and replace if bad.
Index
Page 6B-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
5. Check condition of locking tabs on cap. Replace cap if tabs are bent or cracked. 6. Check gasket for cracks or other damage. IMPORTANT: Cap MUST be replaced if damaged.
a b
72714
a - Rubber Seal b - Gasket c - Locking Tabs (1 Hidden) 7. Test pressure cap. Refer to Testing Pressure Cap. 8. Clean sealing surfaces on heat exchanger filler neck with a cloth. Inspect surfaces for any damage or deposits that may prevent cap from sealing properly. 9. Clean coolant recovery passage in heat exchanger filler neck with a wire and blow out with compressed air.
b
72715
a - Sealing Surfaces b - Coolant Recovery Passages 10. Reinstall pressure cap. Tighten cap until it contacts filler neck.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6B-5
WARNING
Allow engine to cool before removing pressure cap as sudden loss of pressure could cause hot coolant to boil and discharge violently. After engine has cooled, turn cap 1/4 turn to allow any pressure to escape slowly, then push down and turn cap all the way off. Coolant in fresh water section should be changed per Maintenance Schedule recommendations and should be checked for alkalinity at least once between change intervals. To check coolant for alkalinity, proceed as follows: 1. Obtain pink litmus paper from a local supplier (drug store, pet shop, etc.). 2. Remove pressure cap from heat exchanger and insert one end of litmus paper into coolant. 3. If pink litmus paper turns blue, coolant is alkaline and need not be replaced. 4. If pink litmus paper remains pink, coolant is not alkaline and MUST BE REPLACED, as explained under Changing Coolant.
WARNING
Allow engine to cool before removing pressure cap. Sudden loss of pressure could cause hot coolant to boil and discharge violently. After engine has cooled, turn cap 1/4 turn to allow any pressure to escape slowly, then push down and turn cap all the way off. If coolant section of closed cooling system is suspected of leaking or not holding sufficient pressure, and no visible signs of leakage can be found, perform the following test: 1. Remove pressure cap from heat exchanger or reservoir. 2. Clean, inspect and pressure test pressure cap, as outlined in Testing Pressure Cap. 3. Clean inside of filler neck to remove any deposits or debris. Examine lower inside sealing surface for damage. Surface must be perfectly smooth to achieve a good seal between it and rubber seal on cap. Also check locking cams on sides of filler neck to be sure that they are not bent or damaged. 4. Adjust coolant level in fresh water section to 1 in. (25 mm) below filler neck. 5. Attach an automotive-type cooling system pressure tester to filler neck and pressurize closed cooling section to amount specified in following chart. Pressure Cap Rating 16 psi (110 kPa) Amount of Pressure Applied to Closed Cooling System 20 psi (138 kPa)
6. Observe gauge reading for approximately two minutes; pressure should not drop during this time. If pressure drops, proceed with the following steps until leakage is found. 7. While maintaining specified pressure on closed cooling section, visually inspect external portion of cooling system (hoses, gaskets, drain plugs, petcocks, core plugs, circulating pump seal, etc.) for leakage. Also listen closely for bubbling or hissing. 8. Refer to Testing Heat Exchanger in this section and test as outlined.
Index
Page 6B-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
9. If no leakage could be found in above steps, engine is leaking internally. Leaking may be caused by one or more of the following: loose cylinder head bolts or damaged gasket, loose intake manifold bolts or damaged gasket, loose exhaust elbow or distribution block retaining nuts or damaged gasket, cracked or porous cylinder head or block, or cracked or porous exhaust manifold.
Proceed as follows until location of internal leak is found. a. Start engine. Re-pressurize system to previously specified amount and observe pressure gauge on tester. If needle in gauge vibrates, compression or combustion is leaking into closed cooling section from a leak in the combustion chamber. Exact cylinders where leakage is taking place can sometimes be found by removing spark plug wires (one at a time) while observing pressure gauge. Vibration will decrease or stop when plug wire is removed from leaking cylinder. Stop engine. b. Remove spark plugs (one at a time) from cylinders and examine for presence of coolant. A spark plug that is perfectly clean or milky appearing is a sure indication of a leak. c. Drain oil from engine and examine for coolant. Oil will usually be milky if coolant is present. If coolant is present, remove engine from boat and drop the oil pan. With engine in the upright position, re-pressurize closed cooling section to previously specified amount and examine internal surfaces of engine to locate leak. d. If no leakage can be found in above steps, entire engine must be disassembled and inspected for leakage.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6B-7
Do not confuse normal warm-up expansion with a failed head gasket. Normal warm-up produces an intermittent flow of coolant that will stop within approximately five minutes at a given rpm. A head gasket leak will not stop because the one thing that marks a failed head gasket is the continued passage of air. This may be accompanied by violent, intermittent bursts of coolant leaving the reservoir. If coolant flows evenly from the reservoir at cruising speed, something other than the head gasket is causing the engine to overheat.
WARNING
Allow engine to cool before removing pressure cap. Sudden loss of pressure could cause hot coolant to boil and discharge violently. After engine has cooled, turn cap 1/4 turn to allow any pressure to escape slowly, then push down and turn cap all the way off. 1. Carefully remove pressure cap from reservoir or heat exchanger. 2. Wash cap with clean water to remove any deposits or debris from sealing surfaces. 3. Inspect gasket (if used) and rubber seal on cap for tears, cuts, cracks or other signs of deterioration. Replace gasket, if damaged, or entire cap if rubber seal is damaged. 4. Check condition of locking tabs on cap. Replace cap if tabs are bent or cracked.
Index
Page 6B-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
a b
72714
a - Rubber Seal b - Gasket 5. Using a cooling system pressure tester (similar to one shown), test cap to be sure that it releases at proper pressure and does not leak. (Refer to instructions which accompany tester for correct test procedure.) Cap must relieve pressure at 16 psi (110 kPa), and must hold rated pressure for 30 seconds without going below 11 psi. Replace cap if it fails to fall within these limits.
72716
IMPORTANT: Before reinstalling cap in next step, examine lower inside sealing surface in filler neck to ensure that it is perfectly smooth and free of debris. Also, inspect cam lock flanges on sides of filler neck to be sure that they are not bent.
b
72715
a - Sealing Surfaces b - Coolant Recovery Passages 6. Reinstall cap on reservoir or heat exchanger.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6B-9
Thermostat
Removal
NOTE: If coolant flow is restricted or fails to occur, a wire should be repeatedly inserted into all drain holes to ensure there are no obstructions in passages. Remove fitting, if necessary, to insert wire completely into drain hole. 1. Drain engine block by removing drain plugs. Be sure to drain port and starboard sides.
75052
Starboard Side Shown (Port Side Similar) a - Hose 2. Disconnect hoses from thermostat cover. 3. Remove thermostat cover attaching bolts and lockwashers, then remove cover and gasket. 4. Remove thermostat from thermostat housing.
a b c
75746
d
a b c d - Thermostat Housing - Thermostat - Gasket - Thermostat Housing Cover
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
Page 6B-10
Testing
1. Clean thermostat in soap and water to remove any deposits or debris. 2. Inspect thermostat for corrosion or other visible damage.
75747
3. If thermostat is suspected of producing insufficient engine temperature, check thermostat for leakage by holding it up to lighted background. Light leakage around the thermostat valve indicates that thermostat is not closing completely and should be replaced. (A small amount of leakage at one or two points around the valve perimeter is acceptable.) 4. Check opening and closing temperature of thermostat (using a tester similar to the one shown), as follows: a. Fill tester to within 1 in. (25 mm) of top with tap water. Do not use distilled water. b. Open thermostat valve and insert thread. Position thermostat on nylon string so that it will be just below water level when suspended, then allow valve to close. Suspend thermostat in water.
b a c
72675
a - Thermometer b - Nylon String c - Thermostat (Typical) c. Place thermometer in container and position so that bottom of thermometer is even with bottom of thermostat. Do not allow thermometer to touch container. IMPORTANT: When performing instructions d. and e. water must be agitated thoroughly to obtain accurate results. d. Plug in tester and observe temperature at which thermostat opens (thermostat drops off thread). e. Unplug tester and allow water to cool to a temperature 10F (5C) below specified temperature on thermostat. Thermostat must be completely closed at this temperature. f. Replace a thermostat that fails to meet all of the preceding tests.
Page 6B-11
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Installation
CAUTION
Avoid seawater pickup pump impeller damage. DO NOT operate engine without cooling water being supplied to seawater pickup pump. 1. Remove thermostat housing and gaskets. Discard gaskets. 2. Clean gasket surfaces on thermostat cover, thermostat housing and intake manifold. 3. Position gasket on intake manifold. Place thermostat housing on gasket. IMPORTANT: If gasket has continuity rivets, do not coat with Quicksilver Perfect Seal, or audio warning temperature switch may not work properly. 4. Install thermostat, as previously shown, into thermostat housing. 5. Position gasket on thermostat and reinstall thermostat cover. Torque bolts to 30 lb-ft (41 Nm).
a b c
75746
d
a b c d - Thermostat Housing - Thermostat - Gasket - Thermostat Housing Cover
6. Connect hoses to thermostat cover. Tighten hose clamps securely. 7. With boat in the water and/or cooling water properly supplied to seawater pickup pump, start engine and inspect for leaks.
Index
Page 6B-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Changing Coolant
NOTICE For information and procedures on draining the seawater cooling system of Seawater Cooled (Rawwater) Models, refer to SECTION 6A. For information and procedures on draining the Seawater Section of Closed Cooling (Coolant) Models refer to SECTION 1B. For cold weather or extended storage, refer to SECTION 1B.
Change Intervals
If the closed cooling system is factory installed, drain and flush coolant from the closed cooling system at least every five years or 1000 hours of operation, whichever comes first. It should also be changed whenever exhaust gases have entered the system. If the system is not factory installed or has had anti-freeze other than Extended Life Coolant added, it must be changed every two years or 400 hours of operation, whichever comes first.
Draining Instructions
WARNING
Allow engine to cool before removing pressure cap. Sudden loss of pressure could cause hot coolant to boil and discharge violently. After engine has cooled, turn cap 1/4 turn to allow any pressure to escape slowly, then push down and turn cap all the way off. IMPORTANT: A wire should be inserted into drain holes to ensure that foreign material is not obstructing the drain holes. On some models with two piece petcock, removal of petcock may be required so that wire can be inserted completely into drain hole. IMPORTANT: Engine must be as level as possible to ensure complete draining of cooling system. IMPORTANT: Closed cooling section must be kept filled year round with recommended coolant. If engine will be exposed to freezing temperatures, make sure closed cooling section is filled with Extended Life Coolant or an ethylene glycol antifreeze and water solution properly mixed to protect engine to lowest temperature to which it will be exposed.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6B-13
The following draining instructions apply to all engines equipped with closed cooling. The location of petcocks that require opening and hoses that require removal are represented on the following pages for the individual engines. IMPORTANT: Observe precautions previously outlined before proceeding. 1. Remove pressure cap from coolant tank. 2. Drain coolant from locations as shown in the Draining Diagram. 3. After coolant has drained completely, reinstall petcocks and hoses. Tighten clamps and petcocks securely. 4. Remove coolant recovery bottle from mounting bracket and pour out coolant. 5. Clean system as outlined in Cleaning System. 6. Fill system as outlined in Filling Closed Cooling Section.
Cleaning System
Closed Cooling Section
Closed cooling section of closed cooling system should be cleaned at least once every two years or whenever decreased cooling efficiency is experienced. A good grade automotive cooling system cleaning solution may be used to remove rust, scale or other foreign material. Always follow manufacturer s instructions for the cleaner. If closed cooling section is extremely dirty, a pressure flushing device may be used to flush out remaining deposits. Flushing should be done in direction opposite normal coolant flow to allow water to get behind deposits and force them out. Refer to instructions that accompany flushing device for proper hookup and flushing procedure. NOTICE For information and procedures on draining and flushing Seawater Section of Closed Cooling (Coolant) Models, refer to SECTION 1B. For cold weather or extended storage, refer to SECTION 1B.
Index
Page 6B-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Seawater Section
Cooling efficiency of an engine with closed cooling is greatly dependent upon heat transfer through the tubes within the heat exchanger. During engine operation, contaminants within the seawater (such as salt, silt, lime, etc.) collect on the inside of the tubes, thus reducing heat transfer and greatly decreasing heat exchanger efficiency. It is, therefore, recommended that the seawater section of the heat exchanger be cleaned as specified in SECTION 1B Scheduled Maintenance or whenever decreased cooling efficiency is suspected. 1. Remove bolts securing end plates to heat exchanger. 2. Then remove end plates, seal washers and gaskets. 3. Discard seal washers and gaskets. 4. Clean gasket material from end plates and heat exchanger.
a b c d
a b c d - Heat Exchanger - Sealing Washer - End Cap - Gasket
71515
5. Clean water passages in heat exchanger by inserting a suitable size wire brush into each passage. Use compressed air to blow loose particles out of water passages. 6. Apply Quicksilver Perfect Seal to both sides of new end plate gaskets. 7. Reinstall end plates, using new gaskets and seal washers. (Be sure to install seal washers between end plates and gaskets.) 8. Torque end plate bolts to specifications.
CAUTION
Avoid seawater pickup pump impeller damage. DO NOT operate engine without water being supplied to seawater pickup pump. 9. With boat in the water and/or cooling water properly supplied to seawater pickup pump, start engine and inspect for leaks.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6B-15
75598
a - Hex Head Bleeder Valve b. Fill with coolant mixture through heat exchanger fill neck until coolant appears at bleeder valve opening. c. Close bleeder valve securely. d. Continue filling until coolant level is into filler neck and begins to flow into coolant recovery bottle plastic tubing.
CAUTION
Avoid seawater pickup pump impeller damage. DO NOT operate engine without water being supplied to seawater pickup pump.
CAUTION
Front of engine should be higher than rear to purge trapped air out of the system during initial filling. This will minimize the possibility of air being trapped in the closed cooling section which can cause engine to overheat. IMPORTANT: Coolant flows rapidly. Higher idle speeds increase dispersion of trapped air into system making it more difficult to purge trapped air. Operate at idle during filling and air purging when specified. 2. Start engine and run at IDLE.
Index
Page 6B-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
3. Add coolant solution to heat exchanger, as required, to maintain coolant level at filler neck. 4. After engine has reached normal operating temperature thermostat is fully open and coolant level remains constant, fill heat exchanger until coolant level is into filler neck and begins to flow into coolant recovery bottle plastic tubing. 5. Remove cap from coolant recovery reservoir and fill to FULL mark with coolant solution. 6. Reinstall cap. 7. Lift recovery bottle and plastic tubing above heat exchanger filler neck. Allow coolant to flow down through tubing to purge air through filler neck fitting. 8. Install pressure cap on heat exchanger. 9. With engine still running, check hose connections, fittings and gaskets for leaks. Also observe engine temperature gauge to make sure that engine operating temperature is normal. If gauge indicates excessive temperature, stop engine immediately and examine for cause.
WARNING
Allow engine to cool down before removing pressure cap. Sudden loss of pressure could cause hot coolant to boil and discharge violently. After engine has cooled, turn cap 1/4-turn to allow any pressure to escape slowly, then push down and remove cap. 10. Recheck coolant level after first boat test and add coolant, if necessary. 11. Maintain coolant level in coolant recovery reservoir between ADD and FULL marks with engine at normal operating temperature. Coolant section of Closed Cooling System should be kept filled year around with recommended coolant solution. DO NOT drain coolant from fresh water section for storage, as this will promote rusting of internal surfaces. If engine will be exposed to freezing temperatures, make sure that coolant section is filled with Extended Life Coolant and water solution, mixed to manufacturer s recommended proportion, to protect engine to lowest temperature to which it will be exposed.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6B-17
CAUTION
On closed cooling models, the heater must be mounted lower than the fill cap on the heat exchanger. If the heater is higher than the fill cap on the heat exchanger and some coolant is lost from system, an air pocket may form in the closed cooling system. This can cause the engine to overheat.
75503
Supply Hose Connection a - Location For Hot Water Supply Hose (Thermostat Housing As Viewed From Above)
75480
Index
Page 6B-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
c a f
g h i
74745
k
75598
75213
74988
Typical Engine Shown a - Gasket b - Heat Exchanger Bracket and Pads c - Thermostat Housing d - Screws, Stainless Steel e - Bleeder Valve f - Thermostat g - Quad-Ring Seal h - Outer Diameter of Thermostat i - Thermostat Cover j - Screws with Lockwashers k - Engine Temperature Gauge Sender l - ECT Sender
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6B-19
g
b b
c
74073
c d e
75209 75212
Typical Engine Shown a - Heat Exchanger b - Large Hose Clamps c - Starboard Heat Exchanger-to-Exhaust Manifold Hose d - Water Circulating Pump Hose e - Port Heat Exchanger-to-Exhaust Manifold Hose (MCM) f - Cool Fuel System (or Seawater Pipe, if equipped)-to-Heat Exchanger Hose g - Coolant Identification Decal h - Fuel Lines Aligned to Avoid Starboard Water Hose
Index
Page 6B-20 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
11 10 9 8 1
2 7
4 6
75855
3 1 2 3 4 5 6 - Seawater Intake (From Sterndrive) - Power Steering Cooler - Fuel Cooler - EFI Models - Heat Exchanger, Typical - Thermostat Housing Assembly - Engine Water Circulating Pump 7 - Engine Block And Cylinder Head Assembly 8 - Exhaust Manifold, Typical 9 - Gasket 10 - Exhaust Elbow Assembly, Typical 11 - Overboard (Water and Exhaust Discharge)
Page 6B-21
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
11 10 9
12
6 8
75860
4 1 - Seawater Intake (From Through The Hull or Through The Transom Pickup) 2 - Seawater Pump 3 - Power Steering Cooler 4 - Fuel Cooler, If Equipped 5 - Heat Exchanger, Typical 6 - Thermostat Housing and Cover Assembly 7 - Engine Water Circulating Pump 8 - Engine Block and Cylinder Head Assembly 9 - Exhaust Manifold, Typical 10 - Gasket 11 - Exhaust Elbow Assembly, Typical 12 - Overboard (Water and Exhaust Discharge)
Index
Page 6B-22 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 6B-23
Index
Page 6B-24 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
GENERAL
EXHAUST SYSTEM
Section 7A - General
Table of Contents
Exhaust System Requirements . . . . . . . . Exhaust Elbow Risers . . . . . . . . . . . . . Through The Transom Exhaust . . . . . 7A-2 7A-2 7A-3
7
A
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 7A-1
GENERAL
b
72700
Exhaust Elbow Measurement a - From Waterline To Top Of Transom b - From Highest Point On Exhaust Elbow To Top Of Transom Model All (a) Minus (b) Must Be at Least 13 in. (330 mm)
Index
Page 7A-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
GENERAL
1. Exhaust flanges must be of proper size to accommodate 4 in. (102 mm) I.D. exhaust hoses. They must also be equipped with internal water shutters, and use an exhaust flapper over each outlet. 2. The exhaust hoses and pipes must not be higher than exhaust elbows at any point. 3. The exhaust outlet must be located so that a minimum of 1/2 in. (13 mm) drop per foot (305 mm) downward pitch exists in the exhaust hose from the engine exhaust elbow to the outlet. (This is an American Boat & Yacht Council recommendation.) The drop must be constant so that a low spot does not exist at any point in the exhaust hose. 4. Exhaust outlet must be slightly above the waterline with boat at rest in the water and full load aboard. 5. Back pressure must not exceed 4 in. (102 mm) of mercury when measured with a mercury manometer to exhaust elbow outlets. There are no kits to convert these engines from through the drive to through the transom exhaust. By using block off plates, inboard exhaust elbows, exhaust hoses and transom outlet fittings, some engines have been converted to through the transom exhaust. In addition to the preceding information, the following should be adhered to: Exhaust Elbow Measurement (as previously outlined) must be checked. Block-off plates (for thru drive exhaust system) must be able to prevent water from entering boat (Quicksilver Block-Off Plate Part Number 97350T--1). Refer to appropriate Sterndrive Manual. Exhaust bellows (between gimbal housing and bell housing) should be removed to allow propeller to draw air. Refer to appropriate Sterndrive Manual.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 7A-3
GENERAL
Index
Page 7A-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
EXHAUST SYSTEM
Section 7B - Manifolds, Elbows and Risers
7
B
Table of Contents
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Exhaust Riser (Kit) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cleaning and Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7B-2 7B-2 7B-2 7B-2 7B-4 Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Gaskets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Manifold . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Sterndrive Exhaust Extension . . . . . . 7B-6 7B-6 7B-7 7B-9
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 7B-1
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Hose Clamps Exhaust Elbow or Risers to Manifold Exhaust Manifold 33 25 lb-in. lb-ft Securely 45 34 Nm
Disassembly
WARNING
Avoid possible injury or damage to equipment should wires be accidentally shorted. Disconnect BOTH battery cables from battery before proceeding. 1. Disconnect battery cables from battery.
CAUTION
To avoid severe engine damage. Exhaust elbows and manifolds MUST BE drained to prevent water from entering combustion chambers when exhaust elbows are removed. 2. Drain water from manifold, elbow and riser, if equipped. 3. Disconnect exhaust and cooling hoses. 4. Remove any other components that are mounted to the manifold, elbow and riser, if equipped.
Index
Page 7B-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
5. Remove elbow and riser, if equipped. 6. Remove exhaust manifold fasteners. Remove manifold assembly and discard gaskets.
c b d e
72991
MCM 4.3L / 4.3LH / 4.3L EFI Two Piece Cast Iron Manifold a - Exhaust Elbow b - Restrictor Gasket c - Open Gasket (Later Models and Service) d - Exhaust Manifold e - Bolts (6)
75865
MCM 4.3L / 4.3LH / 4.3L EFI Seawater Cooled With One Piece Cast Iron Manifold
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 7B-3
76341
a - Inspect Area Around Exhaust Outlet 9. Check the fire ring gasket fit on the manifold gasket surface. Place a new gasket on the surface. Thread 4 short 3/8-16 bolts into the bolt holes. Move the gasket fore and aft, then side to side to make sure the gaskets fire ring has manifold gasket surface under it in all 4 positions. NOTE: If the gaskets fire ring does not have a solid gasket surface in all 4 positions, the manifold should be replaced.
Index
Page 7B-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
76355
a - Gaskets Fire Ring has Manifold Gasket Surface Under It in All 4 Positions b - Manifold Gasket Surface
a
76359
a - Gaskets Fire Ring Does Not have Manifold Gasket Surface Under It in All 4 Positions b - Manifold Gasket Surface
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 7B-5
Installation
Gaskets
NOTE: The service replacement gasket may not be the same type of gasket that was used in production. The fire ring gasket with 4 slots is used between all manifolds, risers and exhaust elbows. IMPORTANT: After applying Loctite 510 to the gasket, assemble components immediately. 1. Apply a 1/8 in. (3 mm) bead of LOCTITE 510 Sealant around all holes on both sides of a new fire ring gasket.
76360
a - 1/8 in. (3 mm) Bead of LOCTITE 510 Sealant 2. Assemble parts immediately and torque fasteners to specifications. 3. Allow sealant to cure 2-3 hours before starting the engine.
Index
Page 7B-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Manifold
1. Using new gasket, install exhaust manifold to cylinder head. Torque fasteners to 25 lb-ft (34Nm). 2. Using a new gasket, install exhaust elbow to exhaust manifold. Torque fasteners to 25 lb-ft (34Nm).
3 IN. RISERS e h a c d c d b j c b c g f g i i
76510 76511
e a h
k c
j f
Models Without Mufflers Models With Mufflers a - Exhaust Elbow b - 3 in. (76 mm) Exhaust Riser c - Open Gasket d - Restrictor Gasket e - Nut (8) f - Stud (8) 9-3/8 in. (238 mm) g - Stud (8) 10-3/8 in. (264 mm) Used With Remote Oil Filter h - Washer (8) i - Exhaust Manifold j - Separator Gasket - See Notice k - Muffler Spacer 1-1/4 in. (32 mm)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 7B-7
6 IN. RISERS a b c e d i h i j g l k i o n m f l i h g d j m e f a
b c
k n
76506 76507
Models With Mufflers Models Without Mufflers a - Screws [Supplied With Muffler Kit] b - Exhaust Elbow c - Spacer (3) [Supplied With Engine] d - Riser Bracket e - Restrictor Gasket (2) f - Fasteners (3) [Supplied With Engine] g - Spacers or Phenolic Washers in Step 5. h - 1-1/4 Inch (32 mm) Muffler Spacer i - Open Gasket (2) j - Nut (6) k - Screw (4) l - 6 Inch (152 mm) Riser m - Screw (4) n - Exhaust Manifold o - Separator Gasket (Used On Models With Exhaust Manifolds In The Closed Cooling System) 3. Port Manifold: a. Install remote oil filter and bracket. b. Install components on exhaust elbow (if necessary).
Index
Page 7B-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
4. Starboard Manifold: a. Install bolt to secure water separating fuel filter bracket to exhaust manifold. b. Install shift plate assembly on exhaust elbow (MCM only). c. Connect instrument harness plug to engine harness, if disconnected previously. d. Connect both shift cables (MCM only). 5. Install exhaust elbows and cooling hoses. 6. On Closed Cooled Models: Refill closed cooling system to operating level with properly mixed coolant. Refer to SECTION 6B. 7. Reconnect battery cables to battery. Tighten securely. 8. Start engine and check for fuel, exhaust and water leaks.
a
50930
Typical Exhaust Extension a - Bottom Edge Of Raised Bead 3. Tighten hose clamps securely. 4. Upon first start-up of engine, check for leaks.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 7B-9
Index
Page 7B-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
COLLECTORS
EXHAUST SYSTEM
Section 7C - Collectors
Table of Contents
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Bullhorn Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Shutter Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Component Replacement . . . . . . . . . . 7C-2 7C-2 7C-3 7C-3 7C-4
7
C
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 7C-1
COLLECTORS
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Block-Off Plate Exhaust Pipe to Gimbal Housing Exhaust Pipe to T-Pipe T-Pipe to Gimbal Housing Upper Exhaust Pipe to Lower Exhaust Pipe Exhaust Elbow Air Pump Mount Muffler End Plate Mode Switch Hose Clamps Water Shutter Bolt/Nut Securely 20-25 27-34 lb-in. lb-ft Nm
Index
Page 7C-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
COLLECTORS
Bullhorn Exhaust
Shutter Replacement
IMPORTANT: Engine does not have to be removed to change shutters. 1. Loosen clamps and remove exhaust pipe elbow and exhaust hose. 2. Replace water shutter as shown. 3. Reinstall pipe elbow and hose. Tighten clamps securely.
b
75760
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 7C-3
COLLECTORS
Component Replacement
To replace any components in exhaust system, the following must be adhered to: All mating joint surfaces must be clean. O-ring must remain in groove to properly seal joints to prevent leakage. Torque all bolts to 20-25 lb-ft (27-34 Nm). Tighten all clamps securely.
72736
c d
c e
c f g
72737
a b c d e f g h
- Mating Surface - O-Ring - Clamps - Exhaust Pipe Elbow - Exhaust Hose - Water Shutters - Bolts and Lockwashers - Exhaust Pipe
Index
Page 7C-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
COLLECTORS
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 7C-5
COLLECTORS
Index
Page 7C-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DRIVE SHAFT
DRIVES
Section 8A - Drive Shaft
Table of Contents
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Flywheel Housing / Output Shaft Housing Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Exploded View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal and Installation . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Drive Shaft Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8A-2 8A-2 8A-2 8A-3 8A-3 8A-4 8A-4 8A-5 8A-5 8A-5 8A-7 Replacement Drive Shafts . . . . . . . . . Drive Shafts Modified to Shorter Lengths . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bearing Support Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Reassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8A-7 8A-8 8A-8 8A-10 8A-10 8A-10 8A-11 8A-12
8
A
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 8A-1
DRIVE SHAFT
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Drive Shaft To Bearing Support Flange (MCM Models) Drive Shaft To Output Shaft (MCM Models) Flywheel Housing To Block (MCM Models) Output Shaft Housing To Flywheel Housing (MCM Models) Engine Coupling Bearing Support Housing Attaching Bolts Coupling Set Screws (If Equipped) NOTE: Safety wire set screws. lb-in. lb-ft 50 30 35 35-54 Nm 68 41 48 47-73
Tools
Description Quicksilver Alignment Tool Quicksilver Slide Hammer Puller Part Number 91-805475A1 91-34569A1
Index
Page 8A-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DRIVE SHAFT
Exploded View
1 2 3 5 9 15 14 13 8 12 8 16 18 23 19 17 11 7 8 4 10 8
20
21
22
Flywheel Housing/Output Shaft Housing 1 - Output Shaft 2 - O-Rings 3 - Ball Bearing Snap Ring 4 - Ball Bearing 5 - Shaft Bearing 6 - Output Shaft Snap Ring 7 - Rear Engine Mount 8 - Lockwasher 9 - Screw (4) 10 - Screw (6) 11 - Flywheel Housing 12 - Plate 13 - Screw (2) 14 - Nut (1) 15 - Bolt (4) 16 - Washer (1) 17 - Clamp (1) 18 - Stud (1) 19 - Gasket 20 - Flywheel Cover 21 - Screw (7) 22 - Engine Coupling 23 - Bushing
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 8A-3
DRIVE SHAFT
Disassembly
IMPORTANT: This disassembly procedure, beginning with Step 1. assumes that engine does not require removal from boat. If engine removal is required, refer to SECTION 2 for removal and installation instructions. With engine removed from boat, proceed with disassembly, beginning with Step 3. 1. If Engine Is Removed From Boat, Go To Step 3. If Engine Is In Boat: Support rear of engine with overhead hoist or wooden blocks under the rear of the engine. 2. Remove stringer bolts (rear engine mounts). 3. Remove output shaft housing attaching screws, then remove housing. 4. Remove snap ring, then pull output shaft out of housing. 5. Remove snap ring from housing. 6. Using Quicksilver Slide Hammer Puller, remove bearing from housing. 7. Remove flywheel cover. 8. Remove flywheel housing. 9. Remove engine coupling. 10. Clean and inspect all parts. Replace any damaged parts.
Index
Page 8A-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DRIVE SHAFT
Reassembly
1. Install engine coupling. Torque to 35 lb-ft (48 Nm). 2. Install flywheel housing. Torque to 30 lb-ft (41 Nm). 3. Using new gasket, install flywheel cover. Tighten screws securely. IMPORTANT: Groove in outside diameter of ball bearing must align with grease fitting hole. 4. Install ball bearing into output shaft housing, then install snap ring. 5. Apply Quicksilver 2-4-C Marine Lubricant With Teflon to O-rings (on output shaft), then slide shaft through bearing. Secure shaft with snap ring. 6. Apply Quicksilver Engine Coupler Spline Grease to splines on output shaft. 7. Install output shaft housing to flywheel housing. Torque screws to 30 lb-ft (48 Nm). 8. Secure rear engine mounts to stringer with bolts. Tighten securely. 9. Remove hoist (or wooden blocks). 10. Install drive shaft and check alignment. (Refer to SECTION 2B for engine and drive shaft alignment if engine was removed.) 11. Using Quicksilver U-Joint and Gimbal Bearing Grease, grease ball bearing through grease fitting.
e d b
70245
Top Shield and Bottom Shield at Transom End (Engine End Similar) a - Top Shield b - Bottom Shield c - Bolt 3/3-16 x 7/8 In. (22.2 mm); 4 Used d - Nut 3/8 16: 4 Used e - Screws (3 Used Hidden In This View)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 8A-5
DRIVE SHAFT
2. Suitably mark drive shaft U-joint yokes / flange connections (engine output and drive unit input) to assist in exact same positioning during assembly at engine and transom end.
a
70237
Engine End Shown (Transom End Similar) a - Suitable Mark On Flange and Drive Shaft Connection b - Extension Drive Shaft U-Joint Yoke c - Flange 3. Remove drive shaft fasteners and drive shaft. a
c b Engine End Shown (Transom End Similar) a - Output Shaft Flange b - Drive Shaft c - Bolt With Nut (4 Total)
70237
Index
Page 8A-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DRIVE SHAFT
Repair
CAUTION
Be sure U-joint locking rings are seated properly after replacing U-joints. 1. Replace U-joints, if required. 2. Replace flange, if required. c
c a b c d e
c d
- Tube - Yoke - Tube - Flange - Universal Joint - Sound Deadener (Cardboard Tube)
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 8A-7
DRIVE SHAFT
Installation
IMPORTANT: The following instructions are to be used if ONLY the drive shaft was removed for service. Refer to appropriate sections for installation of other components which require special alignment. 1. Grease both drive shaft universal joints with Quicksilver U-Joint and Gimbal Bearing Grease.
CAUTION
When attaching shaft in next step, BE SURE that the pilot on drive shaft flanges are engaged in input shaft and output shaft flanges. Flanges MUST BE flush with each other prior to tightening screws or screws may come loose during operation.
CAUTION
Failure to properly align shaft flanges with matching marks made on disassembly may cause improperly aligned drive unit and extension drive shaft U-joint centerlines resulting in a severe vibration problem.
Index
Page 8A-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DRIVE SHAFT
2. As shown, attach drive shaft output flange and input shaft flange exactly as marked upon disassembly. Torque fasteners to 50 lb-ft (68 Nm).
a e d
c b
Engine End Shown (Transom End Similar) a - Output Shaft Flange b - Drive Shaft c - Bolt 7/16-20 x 1-1/2 In. (38 mm) Long (4 Used) d - Nut 7/16-20 (4 Used) e - Suitable Matching Marks Made Upon Disassembly - Aligned 3. Apply Loctite 27131 to threads of bottom drive shaft shield retaining screws and install bottom shields on engine and transom end. Then install both top shields as shown. Torque all fasteners to 30 lb-ft (41 Nm).
70237
c e d
Top Shield and Bottom Shield at Transom End (Engine End Similar) a - Top Shield b - Bottom Shield c - Bolt 3/8-16 x 7/8 in. (22 mm); 4 Used d - Nut 3/8-16; 4 Used e - Screws (3 Used - Hidden In This View)
b
70245
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 8A-9
DRIVE SHAFT
CAUTION
If bearing support is removed, you must remove the sterndrive unit so you can properly align drive unit U-joint centerline with extension drive shaft U-joint centerline. Lack of alignment will cause a severe vibration problem. 1. Remove drive shaft as previously outlined. 2. Remove sterndrive unit. Refer to appropriate Sterndrive Service Manual. 3. Remove bearing support and retain hardware. a b c
d e a b c d e - Bolt, Bearing Support (2) - Flat Washer (2) - Spherical Washer (4) - Bearing Support (Tailstock) - Nut (2)
75279
Disassembly
1. Remove snap ring, then remove input shaft. 2. Remove larger snap ring. 3. Using Quicksilver Slide Hammer Puller, remove ball bearing. 4. Remove oil seal. 5. If required, remove plug from end of input shaft. 6. Clean and inspect all parts. 7. Replace any damaged parts.
Index
Page 8A-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DRIVE SHAFT
Reassembly
1. If removed, install new plug in end of input shaft. 2. Apply Quicksilver Loctite 27131 to outer diameter of new oil seal. 3. Press oil seal into bearing support. Lip of seal faces away from ball bearing. 4. Apply Loctite 290 to outer diameter of ball bearing and inner diameter of bearing support. 5. Install bearing (with sealed side toward snap ring) by using a press. After installation, wipe up excessive Loctite. Install snap ring. 6. Apply Loctite 290 to outer diameter of input shaft (bearing area) and inside diameter of bearing race. 7. Install input shaft, then install snap ring. Wipe up excessive Loctite. IMPORTANT: Do not let Loctite get into ball bearing. 8. Fill bearing area with Quicksilver U-Joint and Gimbal Bearing Grease through grease fitting. 9. Apply Quicksilver Engine Coupler Spline Grease to splines of input shaft before installing drive unit.
e f g h i
75281
a b c d e f g h i
- Snap Ring - Input Shaft - Snap Ring - Ball Bearing - Ball Bearing - Bearing Support - Grease Fitting - Oil Seal - Grease Fitting - Input Shaft - Plug - Input Shaft
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 8A-11
DRIVE SHAFT
Installation
1. Install bearing support assembly (tailstock) on transom plate using hardware as shown. Tighten bolts until they contact. DO NOT TORQUE BOLTS AT THIS TIME. IMPORTANT: The spherical washers MUST be positioned so that the rounded side of the washers are toward the bearing support assembly as shown.
h b
a c
e f
a b c d e f g h - Bolts 1/2-20 x 4 In. (102 mm) - Steel Washer (Flat) - Spherical Washer (Rounded On One Side) - Bearing Support - Spherical Washer (Rounded On One Side) - Nut 1/2-20 - Transom Plate - Bearing Support (Tailstock)
75279
2. Insert solid end of Quicksilver Alignment Tool through bearing in gimbal housing and into input shaft splines of bearing support.
71401
Typical Sterndrive Unit Shown a - Quicksilver Alignment Tool b - Insert This End Of Alignment Tool Through Gimbal Housing Assembly 3. DO NOT remove alignment tool from gimbal housing.
Index
Page 8A-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
DRIVE SHAFT
CAUTION
Both attaching bolts MUST be struck firmly in the following step to properly seat spherical washers. If procedure is not followed, difficulty in the installation of the sterndrive unit may be experienced and subsequent damage to the input bearing may result. 4. Strike the head of BOTH bearing support attaching bolts firmly with a hammer.
71098
71099
6. Refer to appropriate Sterndrive Service Manual and install drive unit. 7. Refer to appropriate SECTION 2 - Removal and Installation Engine Installation/Alignment, if engine was removed.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 8A-13
DRIVE SHAFT
Index
Page 8A-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Table of Contents
Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Special Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Lubricants / Sealants / Adhesives . . . . . Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Steering Pump and Components (Exploded View) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Serpentine Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S/N 0L618999 and Below . . . . . . . . . . S/N 0L619000 and Above . . . . . . . . . Serpentine Belt Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Important Service Information . . . . . . . . . Pump Pulley Replacement . . . . . . . . . 9A-2 9A-2 9A-2 9A-2 9A-3 9A-3 9A-4 9A-4 9A-5 9A-6 9A-6 9A-6 9A-7 9A-7 Testing and Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Checking Pump Fluid Level . . . . . . . . . . . Filling and Air Bleeding System . . . . . . . Pump Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hydraulic Hoses and Fluid Cooler . . . . . High Pressure Hose (Pump-to-Control Valve) . . . . . . . . . . Low Pressure Hose (Cooler-to-Pump) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Low Pressure Hose (Control Valve-to-Cooler) . . . . . . . . . . 9A-8 9A-8 9A-8 9A-8 9A-8 9A-10 9A-11 9A-11 9A-13 9A-15
9
A
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 9A-1
Torque Specifications
Fastener Location Crankshaft Pulley To Torsional Damper Torsional Damper To Crankshaft Pump Mounting Bracket To Engine Power Steering Hose Fittings lb-in. lb-ft 35 60 30 23 Nm 42 81 41 31
Tools
Description Pulley Installer Part Number 91-93656A1
Special Tools
Description Kent-Moore Special Tools 29784 Little Mack Roseville, MI 48066 (313) 574-2332 Pulley Removal Tool Description Snap-On Special Puller Tool J-25034 Part Number CJ124A Part Number
Index
Page 9A-2 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Precautions
CAUTION
Do not operate engine without cooling water being supplied to water pickup pump or water pump impeller will be damaged and subsequent overheating damage to engine may result.
WARNING
Always disconnect battery cables from battery before working on engine to prevent fire or explosion.
CAUTION
Do not pry on power steering pump or alternator when adjusting belt tension. Serious damage may result.
11 1 - Power Steering Pump Assembly 2 - Stud 3 - Cap 4 - Pulley 5 - Serpentine Belt 6 - O-Ring, High Pressure Hose Fitting 7 - Hose, High Pressure (Fittings on Both Ends) 8 - Hose, Low Pressure 9 - Clamp 10 - Hose, Control Valve To Fluid Cooler (Fitting On One End) 11 - Power Steering Cooler
72951
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 9A-3
Index
Page 9A-4 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
76503
76502
76445
76463
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 9A-5
Removal
1. Remove drive belt as follows: NOTE: The upper, starboard idler pulley is the belt adjustment pulley. a. Loosen 5/8 in. locking nut on adjustment stud. b. Turn adjustment stud and loosen belt. Remove belt.
75483
Installation
1. Install drive belt on pulleys. 2. Adjust tension as follows: a. Loosen 5/8 in. locking nut on adjustment stud. Leave wrench on adjustment stud locking nut. NOTE: Belt deflection is to be measured on the belt at the location that has the longest distance between two (2) pulleys. Normally this location is between the power steering pump and the belt adjustment pulley. This location will be different on engines with closed cooling or models without power steering. b. Use 5/16 in. socket and tighten adjusting stud until the correct deflection of the belt is obtained at location specified above. c. While holding adjustment stud at the correct belt tension, tighten 5/8 in. locking nut.
Index
Page 9A-6 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
72821
INSTALLATION
Install pulley, using appropriate pulley installation tool as follows: 1. Place pulley on pump shaft. 2. Thread stud all the way into pump shaft. Place bearing over stud. 3. Thread nut onto shaft. Thread tool shaft (and nut) all the way onto stud (threaded into pump shaft). 4. Turn large pusher nut until face of pulley is even with edge of shaft. c b d e
a Typical Installation Tool Shown a - Power Steering Pump Pulley b - Stud c - Bearing d - Nut e - Tool Shaft
75751
Index
Page 9A-7
Pump Assembly
Removal
1. Loosen the adjusting stud and remove the serpentine belt from the power steering pulley.
a
75483
a - Adjusting Nut NOTE: Use a suitable container catch ant power steering fluid when removing the power steering hoses.
Index
Page 9A-8 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
2. Remove the high pressure hose and return hose from the power steering pump.
a
75228
Power Steering Pump Typical Location a - Return Hose b - High Pressure Hose 3. Remove mounting fasteners from pump.
75798 75228
Power Steering Pump Typical Location a - Nut b - Bolts 4. Remove the power steering pump from the bracket. 5. Refer to appropriate Sterndrive Service Manual for power steering pump repair procedures.
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 9A-9
Installation
IMPORTANT: Be careful to not cross-thread or overtighten hose fittings. 1. Place the power steering pump on the bracket and install the screws and nut. Torque to 30 lb-ft (41 Nm).
75798 75228
Power Steering Pump Typical Location a - Nut b - Bolts 2. Be certain a new high pressure hose O-ring is present. Install threaded fitting in back of pump assembly. Tighten fitting securely. Connect low pressure hose on back of pump. Tighten hose clamp securely.
75228
Power Steering Pump Typical Location a - Return Hose b - High Pressure Hose 3. Install mounting hardware and fasteners to retain pump to bracket. (Refer to Exploded View for specific details on your engine.) 4. Install drive belt and adjust tension. Refer to Pump Drive Belt Adjustment as previously outlined. 5. Fill and air bleed system. Refer to SECTION 1B - Maintenance.
Index
Page 9A-10 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
a
75228
Power Steering Pump Typical Location a - High Pressure Hose Fitting (With O-Ring - Not Visible In This View) b - Pump Fitting 2. Remove hose where routed and secured (port or starboard side), across top of engine, near valve cover. 3. Remove fitting from control valve at transom. Remove hose.
73860
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 9A-11
INSTALLATION
CAUTION
Route hoses exactly as shown below. This will help avoid stress on the hose fittings and will help avoid kinks in the hoses. IMPORTANT: Be careful to not cross-thread or overtighten hose fittings. 1. Position hose properly (as it was prior to removal). Install fitting and torque to 23 lb-ft (31 Nm). Do not cross-thread or overtighten.
73860
a - Power Steering Hose Fitting 2. Route hose along valve cover and secure with J-clamp(s) provided. 3. Be certain a new high pressure hose O-ring is present. Install threaded hose fitting in back of pump assembly fitting. Tighten hose fitting securely. Do not cross-thread or overtighten.
a
75228
Power Steering Pump Typical Location a - High Pressure Hose Fitting (With O-Ring - Not Visible In This View) b - Pump Fitting 4. Fill and air bleed system. Refer to SECTION 1B.
Index
Page 9A-12 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
76403 a - Hose 2. Loosen hose clamp and remove hose from back of pump.
b
75228
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 9A-13
INSTALLATION
1. Using hose clamp, install new hose on back of pump. Tighten clamp securely.
b
75228
Power Steering Pump Typical Location a - Hose Clamp b - Hose 2. Using hose clamp, install hose on fluid cooler. Tighten clamp securely.
a
75595
Index
Page 9A-14 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
75595
73860
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 9A-15
INSTALLATION
CAUTION
Route hoses exactly as shown below. This will help avoid stress on the hose fittings and will help avoid kinks in the hoses. IMPORTANT: Be careful to not cross-thread or overtighten hose fittings. 1. Position hose properly (as prior to removal). Install fitting and torque to 23 lb-ft (31 Nm). Do not cross-thread or overtighten.
73860
a - Power Steering Hose Fitting IMPORTANT: Be careful to not cross-thread or overtighten hose fittings. 2. Route hose along flywheel housing and secure with J-clamp(s) provided. 3. Using hose clamp, install hose on fluid cooler. Tighten clamp securely.
a
75595
Index
Page 9A-16 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999
Index
90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999 Page 9A-17
Index
Page 9A-18 90-861328--1 NOVEMBER 1999